• . • • , - • • g . •• . LT) m t-n o o PRESENTED The Trustees THE BRITISH MUSEUM. • • .. • ; NATIONAL ANTARCTIC EXPEDITION 1901-1904 NATURAL HISTORY VOL. IV. ZOOLOGY (VARIOUS INVERTEBRATA) LONDON PRINTED BY ORDER OF THE TRUSTEES OF THE BRITISH MUSEUM [908 I.-/// A'ig/ifs SOLD BY LONGMANS AND Co., 39 PATERNOSTER Row, E.G. ; BERNARD QUARITCH, 15 PICCADILLY, W. ; DULAU AND Co., 37 SOHO SQUARE, \V. ; AND AT THE BRITISH MUSEUM (NATURAL HISTORY), CROMWELL ROAD, LONDON, S.W. PREFACE. WHEN, in 1901, the Expedition of the S.S. 'Discovery,' under Captain Scott, R.X.. was sent to the Antarctic Regions, the Trustees of the British Museum gave their assistance to this national enterprise by allowing the cases containing the natural history specimens which might be obtained by the Expedition to be sent to the Natural History Museum for unpacking and sorting. They further undertook to publish a detailed report on the collections so obtained, under the superintendence of the Director of the Natural History Departments. Some of the most important collections have been dealt with by naturalists who were members of the Expedition. Thus, the Mammals* and Birds* are described by Dr. Edward A. Wilson, the Isopoda and Pycnogonida* by Mr. T. V. Hodgson, and the Rocks* (in relation to Field Geology) by Mr. H. T. Ferrar. Other groups have been dealt with by members of the staff of the Natural History Departments of the British Museum : Mr. Boulenger describes the Fishes* ; Mr. E. A. Smith, tin- Gastropoda,* Lam*llibranchia,';:: and Brachiopoda* ; Mr. Jeffrey Bell, the Echinoderma* ; Dr. Caiman, the Crustacea Decapoda,* and the Cumacea* ; Mr. Kirkpatrick, the nmi- calcareous Sponges* ; whilst Dr. G. T. Prior has prepared a petrographical description of .the Rock-specimens.* It has been necessary to obtain the assistance of other specialists in order to deal with the rest of the collections. So far as the latter group of contributors is concerned, the following is a list of the subject-matters, together with the name of the naturalist who has undertaken the work in each case :— EMBRYOS *OF SEALS *ANATOMY OF EMPEROR PENGUIN TUNICATA . • *CEPHALODISUUS . *CEPHALOPODA *NUDIBRAN('HS AND PxEROPODS POLYZOA .... *EGGS AND YOUNG OF ASTERIAS :i;. \MPHIPODA *S(JHIZOPODA *NEBALI.E . *OSTRACODA *COPEPODA Di;. MARRETT TIMS. Mi:. \V. 1'. I'v.'KAKT. PROF. HERMMAX. DR. RIDEWOOD. Di:. HOYLE. Sn; CHAKI.KS ELIOT, K.C.M.G. MR. II. W. BURROWS. PROF. MAC-BRIDE. MR. A. <>. WALKER. Mi;. HOLT. DR. J. THIEI.K. PROF. BRADY. I>|;. WoLKKXIiEX. iv PREFACE. *CIRRIPEDIA ...... PROF. GRUVEL. *MYZOSTOMA ...... PROF. v. GRAFF. *ACARI ....... DR. TROUESSART. *COLLEMBOLA ...... PROF. CARPENTER. POLYCH^TA ...... PROF. EHLERS. *GEPHYRIA ...... MR. A. E. SHIPLEY. *CH.ETOGNATHA ...... DR. FOWLER. NEMERTINES ...... PROF. HUBRECHT. FREE PLATYHELMINTHES .... MR. F. F. LAIDLAW. *CESTODA ....... MR. A. E. SHIPLEY. *NEMATODA ...... DR. v. LINSTOW. *ZOANTHARIA . . . . . .MR. CLUBB. *ALCYONARIA AND PENNATULIDA . . . PROF. HICKSON. HYDROMEDUS.E ...... MR. E. T. BROWNE. *CALCAREOUS SPONGES ..... MR. FREWEN JENKIN. • RADIOLARIA ...... MR. LEWIS H. GOUGH. * MOSSES ....... M. JULES CARDOT. LICHENS ....... MR. DARBISHIRE. *ALG.E (MARINE) ...... MRS. GEPP. ALG/E (FRESH-WATER) ..... DR. FRITSCH. *A.LGJE (CALCAREOUS) . ... DR. FOSLIE. PHYTOPLANKTON ...... DR. LEWIS H. GOUGH. The work of securing the assistance of these specialists and of distributing the collections has been performed by Mr. .Jeffrey Bell, of the Zoological Department, who has also acted as sub-editor of the Zoological and Botanical portions of the reports. The Keeper of Minerals, Mr. Fletcher, has superintended the reports in the subjects belonging to his department. The Director desires to acknowledge the ability and energy which have been brought to bear on the preparation of the Zoological reports by Mr. Jeffrey Bell. Owing to his care, the reports have been got ready by the various contributors and published within a reasonable time after the return of the ' Discovery ' from the Antarctic Regions. Neither trouble nor expense has been spared in order to render the illustration and presentation of the Natural History of the Expedition worthy of the generous efforts both of Captain Scott and his fellow-explorers and of those who provided the funds for that enterprise. E. RAY LANKESTER. October, 1906. * Have been or are now published. — 1/3/1908. CONTENTS OF VOL IV. MOLLUSCA. VII. — SOLENOGASTRES. By DR. H. F. NlERSTRASZ . . (13 pp., 2 Pis.) ARTHROPOD A. (A) IXSECTA. APTERA. By G. H. CARPENTER, B.Sc., M.R.I.A. (5pp., 1 PI.) (B) CRUSTACEA. VII. — SCHIZOPODA. By \Y. ]\1. TATTKKSALL, .M.Sc. . . (42 pp., 8 Pis.) VIII. — COPEPODA. By R. NORRIS WOLFENDEN, M.D. . . (44 pp., 7 Pis.) ECHINODERMA. I. — ECHINODERMA. By F. JEFFREY BELL, M.A. . . (1(5 pp., 5 Pis.) II.— ECHIXODERM LARV.E. By E. W. MACBBIDK, M.A., F.R.S.. and J. 0. SIMPSON, B.Sr . (9 pp^ i pj.) MYZOSTOMIDAE. By DR. RUDOLF RITTER v. STUMMER-TRAUNFKLS (-<; pp., 1 I'D SIPUNCULOEDEA. 1!\ \\'. V. LAN< HESTKI:. .M.A. . . . (•'• pp. i COELENTERA. IV.— ACTINI.P.. By J. A. ('LI;I:I:. M.S.. (12 pp.. :j Pis.) PORIFERA. II.— TETRAXMNIDA. By R. KIRKPATRK K . . . (56 pp., 19 Pis.) III.- »'AI.CAI:KA. By ( '. F. JKNKIN. B.A. . (50 pp., 12 Pis.) ' MOLLUSCA. VII. SOLENOGASTEES. By Dr. II. F. NIEKSTRA--/. (2 Plates.) THE 'Discovery' expedition brought back one specimen of Soleuogastres from 77° 50' 30" S., 165° 40' 5" E., 100 fathoms, of which Fig. 1, A gives a representation. The length is 23 mm., the diameter 2 '25 mm., the index therefore about 10. Proximally the animal is blunt, slightly broadened, with a slit-like mouth (Fig. 1, B). The distal part terminates in a dorsal prolongation. On the ventral side the rhomboid opening of the cloaca is distinctly visible, as also the ventral groove, which runs as far as that opening (Fig. 1, C). The opening of the ciliated groove (" Flimmcrhohle " of Wiivn) is also visible. The animal has no lustre. When slightly enlarged, spicules arc seen crossing each other at obtuse angles. The colour of the animal in alcohol is a yellowish brown. After being decalcified in nitric acid (1 per cent, in alcohol 90 per cent.) and being stained in iron carmalum for twenty-four hours, transverse sections were made of the proximal and distal portions for the study of the internal organs. The spicules of the different parts of the body were isolated in Eau de Javelle. They ;uv small, but strictly uniform. They belong to the true Proneomenia type : hollow, straight, or more or less curved or S-shaped calcareous tubes, which end either sharply or bluntly (Fig. 2). In some cases the base is slightly broadened. I have not succeeded in finding spicules of different shapes along the ventral groove, nor at the proximal and distal portions. At the proximal end, however, they are somewhat more curved. The spicules arc arranged indifferent layers upon each other. The whole of the strong cuticle is pierced by numerous papillae. The greater part of these are oval, pear- or dub-shapcd, sometimes round, and they show some transparent cells (Fig. 4). They are placed on strong multiuuclear stalks, the cells of which are more or less fibrous. Amongst the transparent cells granular supporting cells are found. It is worthy of note that these papillae are often branched. The side-branch never readies the length of the stalk, though ending also in a papilla. In most cases these epidermal papillae do not open on to the exterior, but remain closed. Thielc believes the papillae to be sensitive, an opinion which I share (13, p. 280). In the stalk a thin thread may occur, arising from the circular muscular layer. Whether this thread is of a nervous character or not remains undecided. There is. however, no penetration into the circular H. F. NIERSTRASZ. muscular layer by nervous threads. I am also inclined to ascribe to the epidermal papillae, and more especially to the granular cells amongst the transparent ones, a secretory function, if not an excretory function as well. The purpose of such a secretion is doubtful. Perhaps it prevents the cuticle from damage by causing small particles to adhere to its surface. In any case, it is remarkable that the cuticle of the Soleuogastres is nearly always covered with a thin layer of mud firmly sticking to it. The spicules are formed in small cellular accumulations in the epidermis. Such accumulations frequently occur, and consist of a few transparent cells (Fig. 3, A). In one of the cells the spicule is formed. This cell often has two nuclei, a fact which may give rise to the supposition that there are two cells that form the spicule. The spicules are pushed to the periphery of the cuticle, and are connected with the epidermis by short stalks. The older spicules lose their connection with these stalks, but preserve the mother-cells, which surround their base like a cap (Fig. 3, B). In the case of the oldest spicules, however, this cap has also disappeared. Nowhere did I meet with a formation of the spicules such as Thiele described in Amphimenia neapolitana, Thiele (13, p. 246). Thiele is also of the opinion that it is one cell only that produces a spicule. The ventral groove is distinct and deep. In it three folds of the epidermis are found, a large and broad median fold and two small lateral ones. All three run as far as the opening of the cloaca. Close before the latter the groove and the median fold broaden considerably. The folds are formed of a single layer of epithelial cells. All along the median fold the ventral glands open between its cells. These glands (" hintere Bauchdriise," of Wiren) are strongly developed, especially at the proximal end of the body, where they entirely surround the digestive tract (Figs. 6-11, vg). They are conspicuous by their more or less distinct vesicular structure and granular contents, which stain intensely. At the proximal part of the body, amongst the strongly developed ventral glands, voluminous anterior glands (" vordere Bauchdriise," of Wire'n) are also found. They are of a more delicate structure, and stain much less intensely (Fig. 6, ag). They open out between the epithelial cells which invest the ciliated cavity ("Flimmerhohle," Fig. 6, /). The latter is large, and divided by a median dorsal fold. The wall carries strong cilia. There are two dorso-ternimal sense organs situated on the distal lip behind the cloaca. Fig. 5 shows three sections through the more proximal of these organs. The epithelium (ty) shows an evagination (Fig. 5, C) into which the muscular layers and the connective tissue continue (TO). This evagination separates ventrally from the epidermis and pierces the thick cuticle (cut. Fig. 5, B). It forms a pedicle (pcd.), upon which a round knob is resting, the sense organ visible at the surface of the cuticle (Fig. 5, A, dtn). The external layer of this knob consists of high epithelial cells, amongst which slender, fine, easily staining cells are found, which I believe to be sense-organs. The mouth-slit is terminal and vertical. It leads into a spacious mouth-cavity, provided with numerous ramified cirri, as is the case in other forms. A horseshoe- SOLENOGASTRES. 3 shaped sense-organ is wanting, though usually present in other species. The digestive tract opens to the exterior at the same place as the mouth-cavity, with which it has, however, no communication (cf. Dinomenia, 6, p. 12, PI. 2, Fig. 43). I share Thiele's opinion, who does not regard the so-called mouth-cavity as a part of the digestive tract, but considers it an independent ectodermal sense-cavity (17, pp. 308 and 314). A proper mouth-cavity occurs in the proximal part of the digestive tract, which is slightly dilated, and the wall of which presents numerous folds. The epithelial cells of which the wall of this part is composed are very transparent and have large oval nuclei. The wall is surrounded by a thin circular muscular layer. The folds, as it appears to me, allow this portion of the digestive tract to extend considerably after the taking of food. I do not believe them to be sensitive (Figs. G and 7, /'//). Gradually this portion passes into the following part of the alimentary canal. The latter is much wider, and likewise provided with a strongly folded wall (Fig. 8, ves). Its cells are taller than those of the first portion, and have elongated nuclei ; they arc covered with a cuticle. Consequently these two parts of the digestive tract are easilv distinguished from one another. More distally, however, between these slender cells there occur broader ones with more oval nuclei, the cuticle no longer being easily discerned throughout. Finally the spacious intestine unites \vith the proximal caecum (Fig. 8, c). In the second portion of the digestive tract the radula, which is of a very peculiar structure, is found. In the digestive tract a proximally directed cone appeals with a strong ventral fold (Fig. 8, en). This cone is beset throughout with radula- teeth (Fig. 12, c). For its further structure compare figures 12-14 and 8-11. An epithelial layer appears («), which covers the radula. The ventral wall of the digestive tract (l>) unites with the ventral wall of the cone (c) ; the epithelial layer a with the side-walls of the cone. The two lateral walls of the proximal part of the alimentary canal unite dorsal from the cone. By this complicated process the cone, which on the outside is beset with small teeth, is divided into two closed pouches ; the latter are on the inner side closely beset with teeth and are situated outside the alimentary canal. The dorsal pouch is the radula-sac, the ventral contains adult radula-teeth and, distally, ends blindly. Consequently the ventral pouch is but a ventral caecum of the proximal part of the digestive tract, directed distally ; icrili on the ventral wall are wanting, in the distal part teeth only occur on the dnr.sil wall. The radular teeth are well developed (Fig. 10). They are triangular, with a broad base, and more or less strongly curved, often recurved at the point (Fig. 17, B). Frequently forms occur as represented in Fig. 17, A ; often other forms are met with, which, however, I consider fragments of whole teeth. Fig. 17, C shows a tooth as seen from the ventral side : the base appears to be broader than the curved part. The teeth are placed in irregular rows, and rest in crypts of the epithelium (Fig. Ifi). A basal membrane is present. This is remarkable ; Thiele lays stress on the absence of such a membrane B 2 4 H. F. NIERRTRASZ. in different forms and doubts its existence (17, pp. 268 and 315). As has been indicated by me elsewhere, the existence of a basal membrane has to be accepted for several forms (9). The membrane is stained red with carmalum, consequently its structure differs from that of the chitinous teeth. Probably it must be considered as a cuticle, and so its origin is entirely different from that of the radula-teeth, which • are formed in the distal portion of the radula-sac by large odontoblasts. In this respect Proneomenia Jixcoveri/i resembles those forms, already described by me elsewhere (9). So we have to do here with a multiserial radula with basal membrane. Of any double character of the radula, viz., of the existence of a right and a left half, no trace is to be found. The distal portion of the radula-sac, however, is divided into two parts, a right and a left one (Figs. 10, 20) ; in both parts radula- teeth are formed by a thick cushion of odontoblasts. Here also the radula originates from the coalescence of a right and a left portion. The wall of the cone and the dorsal wall of the ventral pouch consist of epithelial cells with round nuclei, between which numerous extremely slender supporting cells occur with elongated nuclei (Fig. 16). On the ventral wall of the ventral pouch and on the dorsal wall of its distal end supporting cells are absent ; this ventral wall is formed by cylindrical epithelium with oval nuclei, whilst the constituent cells of the dorsal wall of the distal portion are higher and more cylindrical. One part of this dorsal wall more especially deserves notice ; the distal and median part is invaginated and of an entirely different structure. Here very long and slender cells are found, with pointed nuclei and granular contents. It leaves the impression that these cells have pushed themselves wedgewise between the epithelial cells; yet no sharp line can be drawn between these two elements (Fig. 18). Upon this wedge-shaped part the proximal rows of the radula-teeth are resting ; the basal membrane, however, fails here. As to the significance of this wedge I am at a loss. There seems to be a connection between the wedge and the layer of muscular and connective tissue surrounding the radula-sac, numerous fibrils pushing themselves between the cells of the wedge. I am bound to mention its existence, having found in a similar ventral pouch containing the proximal portion of the radula in Proneomenia weberi, a regeneration either of the cuticle or of the radula (6, p. 4). But in this new form I do not believe we have to do with a regeneration ; its significance remains undecided. Still, in another respect the ventral pouch is of great importance, as the salivary glands open into it (Figs. 11 and 15 sg). These are tube-shaped, and extend a long way distally ; they merge separately into the ventral wall of the ventral pouch. The connective tissue and the muscles, which are in connection with the radular apparatus, are strongly developed. Ventrally and laterally from the radula-sac numerous crystal-clear cells occur ; usually those are small, sometimes, however, of large size (Fig. 10 <•<•). They serve as a support for the surrounding connective SOLENOGASTRES. 5 tissue and muscles. The course of these muscles is difficult to trace ; they surround the radula-sac and the distal portion of the ventral pouch ; a very broad transverse muscle takes its course between the radula-sac and the ventral pouch (Fig. 10, ?»). Around the salivary glands a thin muscular layer likewise occurs. I do not know how to explain the mechanism of the radular movement. No doubt, the diverse muscles allow of movement in various directions. A subradular organ, as found by Heath (1) in Proneomenia and Rhopalomenia, is wanting. The spacious intestine is formed by the coalescence of the already described portion of the digestive tract with the dorsal caecum (Fig. 8). I have avoided making use of the names pharynx and oesophagus, as there cannot be question here of any sharp separation between the two, even though the proximal part is of a different structure from the following portion. Thiele mentions a strong fold in which the salivarv glands open out, and which separates pharynx from oesophagus (13, p. 288). A similar condition does not exist here. An cesophagus, in the sense Thiele ascribes to it, fails entirely. The spacious intestine shows strongly folded walls, with the exception of the dorsal wall, which remains smooth, except in the median line, where a small fold occurs. The dorsal wall carries cilia ; the ventral and lateral walls show glandular epithelium. Lateral caeca are met with as usual ; the transverse sections do not teach much in regard to their relative situation. The rectum has strong cilia (Fig. 21, r). The cloaca with its strongly folded wall opens to the exterior through a wide longitudinal slit. Gills are entirely wanting. The wall of the cloaca is very thick and consists of several layers of small transparent cells with small nuclei, between which slender ciliated supporting cells occur with narrow long nuclei, which stain well (Fig. 19). As it seems to me, the wall of the cloaca does not perform any respiratory function, it being too thick. A secretory function must not be excluded. Oftentimes in the cloaca and against its wall little feebly staining globules an- found, which I believe to be formed by the wall-cells of the cloaca. Yet we must take into consideration that the cloaca is surrounded by extremely loose connective tissue with large spaces, filled with blood-corpuscles. This arrangement more especially obtains in that part of the cloaca which is contiguous with the dorsal lip ; this part is entirely surrounded by blood-corpuscles, ami. as it is only clothed by a single layer of epithelial cells, a respiratory function may be ascribed to it. The lateral walls of the ventral slit, by which the cloaca communicates with the exterior, are coated with ciliated cylindrical epithelial cells (Fig. 19). Properly speaking, the praecloacal organ does not open into the cloaca, but into the ventral slit, as well as both cloacal spicules (Figs. 19, 20). The latter (Kloaken- spicula of Thiele) are well developed, and consist of small bars of about • 75 mm. length. These bars are probably calcareous. Around the liars a strong envelope is found, which is not dissolved in nitric acid, but Mains easily with carnialuni. Probably G H. F. NIERSTRASZ. this envelope is of cbitinous character (Fig. 24). The two extremities of the envelope are tube-shaped (Fig. 24, B) ; it is open in the middle portion (Fig. 24, A), which may have been caused by damage. Around the proper spicule a cellular envelope is found, consisting of transparent epithelial cells with round nuclei, between which there are long supporting cells with oblong nuclei (Fig. 24). Between the cellular envelope and the spicule an almost homogeneous mass occurs, staining pale-red with carmalum, which I believe to be a secretion of the cells of the envelope, though perfect certainty cannot be obtained. In this ease the envelope might perform the duty of a poison gland, the spicule having consequently the power of attack and defence. At the proximal end of the 'spicules numerous small muscles are attached, which enable the animal to move the spicules in various directions. The nervous system does not furnish much worthy of note. The cerebral ganglion is large (Fig. G, ctj) ; the latero-ventral ganglia are large also (Fig. 7, r/r), whereas the latero-dorsal ones are very small (Fig. 6,« or Dinomenia. The same holds good for Rhopalomenia itself. This genus was created by Simroth on account of the presence of club-shaped epidermal papillae (12, p. 229). It is with good reason that Thiele observes, that the absence of a radula is more typical of. Rhopalomenia than the presence of the said papillae (13, p. 272). In this sense the genus Rhopalomenia was enlarged by me, some years ago, to contain new species (6, p. 22). As to the geographical distribution, nothing confirmative is given. An-tn- arc xliiiti'r! and //////- //*/*; both forms arc most certainly not closely rclaled (14, p. 115). Antarctic forms: gerlachei and discoveryi. Between these two forms there exist great differences (dimensions, radula, dorsal spicules, buccal gland of _//.r//, rfni'/i, i resembles sluiferi ; for the rest, according to Pelseneer (10, p. 34), these two forms do not correspond in many respects. Mediterranean forms : neapolitana, goryonophila, desiderata, riii//» /'/, /7, gerlachei and discoveryi, by the structure of the radula ; on the other hand, a relation with thulensis is very well possible (radula, salivary glands, abdominal spicules), though in the latter form cloacal spicules arc wanting. Indo-pacific forms: webtri. /7\. Of these forms /lawaiensis is insufficiently known ; only the nervous system has been accurately studied by Heath (1). IIW> divide the genus into a number of smaller c 10 H. F. NIEKSTRASZ. ones, considering in the first place the exact structure of the radula and salivary glands. I propose the following division :— FAMILY PRONEOMENIIDAE. Index — at least — fi. Cuticle thick, with many layers of spicules, by far the greater part of which is pointed and hollow. Epidermal papillae present. One or more dorse-terminal sense-organs. Radtila and salivary glands present. Gills are wanting. A. Radula multiserial. Salivary glands tube- or bag-shaped. Proneomenia Hubrecht. a. Radula with basal membrane. Salivary glands tube-shaped, uniting before opening out into the digestive tract. Receptacula seminis strongly folded, glandular. The spicules remain connected with the epidermis by multinuclear stems. Abdominal spicules present. Index 9-14. Proneomenia sluiteri Hubr. (4.) (= lanrji Heuscher), Barent's Sea, Spitzbergen. 70-160 fathoms. b. Radula with basal membrane. Salivary glands tube-shaped, opening out separately. Receptacula seminis vesicular or tube-shaped. a. With abdominal 'and cloacal spicules. Receptacula seminis vesicular. One dorso-terminal sense-organ. Index 22-50. Proneomenia weberi Nierstr. (6, p. 2.) East-Indian Archipelago, 22-1633 M. Proneomenia longa Nierstr. (6, p. 7.) Saleyer, East Indian Archipelago, 1158 M. /3. Without abdominal, with cloacal spicules. Receptacula seminis vesicular. Two dorso-terminal sense-organs. Index 10. Proneomenia discoveryi Nierstr. 77° 50' 30" S., 165° 40' 5" E. 100 fathoms. •y. Without abdominal or cloaca! spicules. One dorso-terminal sense-organ. Receptacula seminis vesicular or tube-shaped. Index 9-18 '5. Proneomenia valdiviae Thiele (16.) 3° 7' S., 40° 45' 8" E. 748 M. Proneomenia acuminata Wiren (18, p. 6s.) West India. 300 fathoms. Proneomenia hawaiensis Heath (1.) (? insufficiently known.) Hawaian Islands. Proneomenia gerlachei Pels. (10, p. 16.) 70° S., 80° 48' W. 500 M. c. Radula without basal membrane. Salivary glands tube- or bag-shaped, opening out separately. Receptacula seminis vesicular. a. With abdominal and cloacal spicules. Salivary glands tube-shaped. 1-3 dorso-terminal sense-organs. Index 6. Proneomenia vai/ans Kow. a. Mar. (5, p. 29.) Mediterranean. /3. With abdominal, without cloacal spicules. Salivary glands bag-shaped. Receptacula seminis numerous, often lobate. One dorso-terminal sense- organ. Index 11. Proneomenia Ihulensis Thiele (14.) so •/ilix, thoroughly known to us, probably is closely related to ff/injiitfuiiii'iiiit im/icit. ( >nr knowledge of the stnu'ture of the internal organs of Rhopalomenia w. ciliated bands. (See text.) cd. cloacal duct. cl. cloaca. rx. cloacal-spicule. !/ps. ganglion posterius superius with commissure. i. intestine. //(. lateral nerve. n. distal nerves. p. pericardium. po. praecloacal organ. r. rectum. v. ventricle. /•//. ventral nerve. FIG. 21. — Transverse section through a cloacal-spicule. (x 330.) FIG. 25. — Genital products in the pericardium. (See text.) ( x 480.) FIG. 26.— Blood-corpuscles. (See text.) (x 780.) 6. i INSECTA APTEBA. By GEORGE H. CARPENTER, B.Sc. (Loxo.), M.R.I.A., Professor of Zoology in the Royal College of Science, Dublin. (1 Plate.) THE explorations of the National Antarctic Expedition have established the presence of a wingless insect of exceptional interest, far south in the Continent of \ ictoria Land. From Granite Harbour, 77° S. hit. and 162° E. long., on the south-trending continental coast-line, almost opposite Ross Island, on which stand .Mounts Erelius and Terror, and about 100 miles N.W. of the AVinter (Quarters of the ' Discovery,' a jar-full of moss believed to contain Collembola was secured. Examination of this material has resulted in the detection of half-a-dozen very imperfect specimens of a small dark-blue spriugtail. Unfortunately, these insects are in a poor state of preservation ; cither the spirit in which the moss was placed was too strong, or the insects had died and shrivelled before the moss was collected. The result, however, is that no really good example of the species can be obtained, and the following descriptions with the accompanying figures have been made from various fragments. Under these circumstances the descriptions are necessarily imperfect. It is hoped that the account will not require correction by the discovery of further and more satisfactory specimens bv some future expedition, but it will assuredly need supplementing. The remoteness of the locality, and the difficulty with which the insects must have been obtained, render it a duty to make the best possible use even of such unpromising material. At tirst I spent many hours pulling the leaves of the moss _ plants asunder with the help of a dissecting microscope, and this labour was rewarded by the discovery of one or two shrivelled specimens, almost useless for study. Afterwards it was found that the bases of the shoots afforded a better hunting-ground, and several more days' work resulted in the unearthing of a few specimens in a less shrivelled state. From these, when cleared in potash and mounted in glycerine jelly, it was possible to make out various details of structure, and the systematic- position of the insect has bn-n gradually traced. All the specimens seen arc referable to the same species. Unfortunately, the general shape of the body can only be surmised, and the segmentation of thorax and abdomen cannot be clearly distinguished in any specimen. On the other hand, the delicate sense-organs on the feelers and head, and some details of the jaws, can lie plainly seen in one or two examples. A large quantity of the moss still remains unexamined, so that further light may yet be thro\\n on the species G. E. CARPENTER. by the collection already in hand ; but I think it unlikely that any specimens more satisfactory than those here described and figured will be found in it. This is the second species of Collembola known from the Antarctic Continent of South Victoria Land. The first, described five years ago (Carpenter, 1902) was brought home by the ' Southern Cross ' Expedition from Geikie Land, on the shores of Robertson Bay near Cape Adare, some 380 miles north of Granite Harbour. That species was an Isotoma, a member of the family Entomobryidae. The present insect belongs to the family Poduridae, so that the two largest families of Collembola are both represented on the Antarctic Continent. A summary of the distribution of the known species of Antarctic and sub-Antarctic Collembola will be found in Wahlgren's recent paper (1906) on the insects of this order collected by the Swedish Expedition. To the species that he enumerates have now to be added the insect here described and the two new species brought from the South Orkney Islands by the ' Scotia ' Expedition (Carpenter, 1906). The last-named paper contains arguments, from the distribution of Antarctic springtails, in favour of a former wide extension of the Antarctic Continent. The present species, having no near allies, does not throw any additional light on such geographical problems. COLLEMBOLA. FAMILY PODURIDAE. GOMPHIO.CEPHALUS, gen. nov.* Cuticle very finely granulate. Abdomen with two anal spines. Spring and catch vestigial. Empodium of foot without appendix (" inferior claw "). Feeler four-segmented ; sensory setae on the third segment ; a sub-apical, depressed sense- organ, and a protrusible apical sense-organ on the fourth. On each side of head a simple post-antennal organ surrounded by a single ovate or cordiform rim ; and a stout sensory tooth-like spine behind the post-autenual organ. Mandible with molar surface close to base. Maxillula with apical teeth and a feeble but distinct molar area. This genus will probably require a new sub-family (Gomphiocephalinae) to express its peculiar affinities. On the whole it comes nearest to the Hypogastrurinae in the recent classification of Borner (1906). But the dentiform sense-organ on the head, the shortened mandibles, and the mandibuliform maxillulae appear to be absolutely distinctive characters ; while the feeble granulation of the cuticle, and especially the simple post-anteunal organ, show an approach to the Anurophorini, a tribe of the Isotominae which belong to the Eutomobryidae. Indeed the genus Gomphiocephalus * From yofifjjios, a back-tooth, and KetjtaX!]. I have to thank the Editor, Prof. F. .1. Bell, for kindly proposing this name to replace my suggestion Odontocephalus, which is pre-occupied. The allusion is to the peculiar dentiform sense-organ on the head (tig. 1,/J. I.NSKCTA AI'THK\. seems ,-i I'odurid, with affinities to (lie Entomobryidae, just ;is the Anurophorinae —\vhidi include that remarkable Antarctic genus Cryptopygus (Willem, I'.HfJ) -arc I'jutomobryids, with affinities to the I'odtiridae. The presence of such ancient connecting links on the Antarctic Continent and islands might reasonably have Keen expected. I have pleasure in naming the type-species of Gomphiocephalus after Mr. T. V. Hodgson, of the ' Discovery.' GOMPHIOCEPHALUS ILOHHSUNI. Length, 1 nun. Colour dark blue-violet. Feelers rather shorter than head; proportional length of segments 8 : 11 : 12 : 15. Foot with three long, slender tenent hairs; daw simple without teeth; empodium vestigial. Anal spines nearly as long as foot-claw, on short contiguous papillae. Habitat. In moss (Bryum algens, Cardot *), Granite Harbour, South Victoria Land. (Types in British Museum.) The whole insect is of a very deep blue-violet colour. The cuticle is finely rugose, and bears numerous bristles, many of which, especially on the terminal abdominal segments, are elongate, but none are feathered. The general aspect of the species and the form of the foot are suggestive of a \~i-n >/lla. Feelers. The feelers (figs. 1, -2) have characteristic sense-oriians both on the third and fourth segments. On the dorsal- aspect of the extremity of the third segment is a group of four short, sharp spines arising from large circular depressions in the cuticle, and surrounded by a sinuous ridge (fig. 1, '/)• The two outer spines of this organ are stronger than the two central. At the tip of the fourth .Moment is a O O L long tapering sensory bristle (tig. 1, It), and near it is a sub-apical sense-organ (fig. 1, ri. ]'. ."i. I' 4 G. II. CARPENTER. The labrum (tig. 8) is narrow and rounded in front, and bears a proximal row of four and a distal row of three long bristles. The jaws are in many respects highly remarkable. The mandibles (figs. 3,4) have four strong teeth at the apex, and a very well-developed molar area, the teeth at its distal region being especially strong. At the proximal end of the molar area are two prominent recurved hooks directed dorsalwards. On the outer edge of the mandible is a strong " shoulder," and just proximal to this a rounded " boss." The large basal extension of the mandible so characteristic of the Collembola generally is entirely wanting in the present genus. At first I could not believe this to be so, supposing that the basal region had somehow got destroyed in the specimens that I was examining. But on finding the mandibles in all the specimens in exactly the same condition, I can only conclude that this insect shows a modification of the jaws unique in the Collembola, As the muscles are usually attached to this missing basal part of the mandible, fresh specimens of the present genus would be especially welcome subjects for anatomical research. The maxillulae (fig. 5) are also very remarkable on account of their likeness to the mandibles. I have not succeeded in isolating these appendages, but one of the heads is so transparent that their shape can be easily seen. At its apex the maxillula has three delicate pointed teeth, while the inner edge of the base carries, not, as is usual, one row of spines, but four rows of short denticles, forming a molar area analogous to that of the mandible. I have not succeeded in seeing the tongue (hypopharynx) so that I cannot state whether the relation of the maxillulae to that structure is of the usual nature or not. In this genus they are more unmistakably a pair of jaws than in any Collembolau that I have examined. Each maxilla (fig. 6) has a " head " of the usual Collembolau form with a two- toothed galea (//) and three internal lamellae (/) ; on account of their delicate texture these latter structures are somewhat shrivelled, and the shape given to them in the figure may be inaccurate. The base of the maxilla (fig. 6, st) can only be traced a short distance into the head capsule, but I cannot satisfy myself that the cardo, with its usual associated sclerites, is absent. There is a blunt palp (fig. 6, ]>} carrying three or four bristles at its tip. The second maxillae combine, as is usual in the Collembola, to form a transverse liiliiiiin (fig. 7) with alternating narrower and broader lobes, carrying long bristles. Legs. The legs (fig. 9) are of the usual Collembolan form. The tibio-tarsus cariies a simple pointed claw without trace of tunica, and a small rounded empodiuni without appendix. There are three elongate teneut hairs, without terminal club, springing from large circular depressions of the cuticle. Ventral Tube. The ventral tube (fig. 10) on the first abdominal segment is abrupt on its front and rounded on its hinder face, beset with numerous bristles like those of the cuticle generally. It appears to be in the undeveloped state characteristic of the section l<> which this genus belongs. INSKCTA AI'TKRA. 5 Spring and Catch. .Most of lh<> specimens examined show no trace ot' these structures, hut in two the appearance drawn in Jig. 11 can he plainly seen. Tin- s|nin- (fig. I 1, .«) is clearly in a vestigial condition, its niannliriiini hcinu; merged in the ventral region of the fourth ahdoniiual segment, while the combined dens and miicio terminate in a blunt, rounded knoh. The catch (retinaculum) is represented by a pair of .small rugose prominences (fig. 11 /•) on the third abdominal segment. Anal Spines. The anal spines are nearly as long as the foot-daw, slightly and evenly curved (figs. 11, 12). They are situated on short, contiguous papillae. In all the specimens examined the spines are slightly asymmetrical (fig. 12). bur this is probably due to the position of one having been slightly shifted. linn', linn;. I'.ioi;. I'.ni2. REFERENCES. ('. BORXER. Das System der Collembolen ncbst Beschreibong nener Collembolen dee Hamburger Datnrb.iBtoriflcb.en Museums. 2 IViheft zum Jnln-h. ., xxvi., I'.ini;, pp. 1 7:;- Is:;, pis. 1-2. E. WAIIIJIUKX. Antarktische und Bubantarktiflche Collembollen jrcsamnielt von dcT sclnvc(li>rln-ii Siidpolarexpedition. Wix*e/ti«'/t. Enjclm. ilrr s'/vv/yy/y/^/-c.;. ."). — Kight maxillula. showing teeth and molar area. Fid. (!. — Left maxilla ; .v. siipes : //, galea : /, lamellae ; //. palp. Fir,. 7. — Second pair of maxillae forming labium. Fiii. s. — Labnuii. FlG. 0. — Right hind leg, showing claw, vestigial empndiuni, and leiieni hairs mi foot. Fin. lo.. — -Ventral tube on first aMi'initial seiiiin/nt, seen from right side. Fn:. 11.— Part of bind abdominal segments, showing anal spines, and vestigial spring (.«) and raidi lateral view. Fn:. 12. — Tip of abdomen, witli papilhe and anal spines ; postern-ventral view. All figures are magnified Coo diainet'T>. I. 2 . Antarctic (Discover. ii'" jsoni. north, >c. C E U S T A C E A. VII.-SCHIZOPODA. By AV. M. TATTERSALL, M.Sc. (8 Plates.) TIIK colleeiion of ' Discovery ' Schixopoda is a large one from the point of vir\v of the ninnber of specimens it contains, considerably over ten thousand, including larva-, having been collected. By 1'ar the majority of the-e -peciinens. nearly ten thousand. however, belong to one species, and the total number of species reaches thirteen. The collection is in a generally excellent state of preservation, though many specimens have undoubtedlv suffered from being frozen after coming out of the water and from the subsequent thawing before preservation. In the preliminary notice of this collection (Holt and Tattcrsall, 1906(1)*) ten species were noted, of which five were absolutely new, two were only known under manuscript names given to them by Dr. Hansen from the collections of the ' Brlgira Antarctic Expedition, while the remaining three were already described forms. Since the publication of that notice further material has come to hand, collected on the homeward journey of the 'Discovery.' It contained two species of En/ >li. Sars), but which Dr. Hansen has kindly informed me is distinct, and will be described by him in a forthcoming paper. A re-examination of the two specimens which in the preliminary note were referred to .l///x/.-- maxima, Ihmseii (MS.), has shown that they represent in reality two very closely allied species, the second of which will also be described by Dr. llansen in a future work. Previous to the recent activity in South Polar exploration only three expeditious to the Antarctic had brought back zoological material from which Schizopoda were recorded. Dana (185:2) in his great work <>n Crustacea records two species from Antarctic waters (/>., south of lat. '',() S. ) vix., Eitj>/tv //-.•/•//./ and /-jn'o/'ln tui»trs. W. M. TATTERSALL. JVIr. Hodgson (1902) described two species as new, Euphausia glacialis and E. australis, collected by the ' Southern ( 'ross ' South Polar Expedition. Both species arc synonymous with E. xuperbti, Dana, so that previous to 1903 only four Antarctic, species of Schizopoda were known, viz., Eucopia aust rails, Dana, Euphausia superba, 1 )ann, Thysanoessa macrura, G. 0. Sars, and Pseudomma x/trxi, Will.-Suhm. Of the recent expeditions to the South Pole, which number seven, the results of the Schizopoda of the French Antarctic Expedition have been published in full, and of the ' Valdivia ' Expedition in part only. M. Coutiere (1906) notes from the French Antarctic collections, Enphaasia superba, Dana, E. similis, G. 0. Sars, Thysanoessa macrura, G. 0. Sars, and Antarctomysis maxima (Hansen, MS.), a species also recorded in the preliminary note on the present collection. Preliminary descriptions have been published of two Antarctic Mysidse collected by the. ' Valdivia ' (Illig, 190G), Dactylerythrops arcuala and Echinomysis chum. The first of these is synonymous with a species Dactylamblyops hodr/soni, described below. This completes the bibliography as regards purely Antarctic Schizopoda, though a number of sub-Antarctic species are known. Ten of the thirteen species collected by the •' Discovery ' were taken in Antarctic waters, and when, as we have seen above, the total previously recorded species number seven, it will be recognised that the present collection has added considerably to our knowledge of South Polar species of this group. The most abundant species in the collection is a small Euphausia, E. crystal- lorophias, H. and T., which evidently has its head-quarters under the ice, since all the specimens were collected from ice-holes at Winter Quarters, and none were met with in the open sea. On the other hand, the dominant species of the collections from open Antarctic waters are Eupliauxia xuperba, Dana, and Thysanoessa macrura, G. 0. Sars. The abundant material of the first-named species has afforded opportunity for some observations on the sexual characters and life history of the species, with the' result that four other species, hitherto regarded as distinct from E. superba, must now be allocated to its synonymy, having been founded either on characters which are sexual and not specific," or else from immature specimens. The scarcity of fully grown males of E. superba seems worthy of note. This fact seems to be established by the results of the various collections of which we' have knowledge, since, so far as I am aware, the only one recorded is Sars' ' Challenger ' specimen. M. Coutiere (1906), it is true, notes that male specimens were more numerous than females in the collection he examined, but it is equally clear that none were fully grown, since the largest measured only 45 mm., and was in the stage pre- vious to the last moult into completely grown specimens. There are no fully-grown males in the ' Discovery ' collections, but to judge from the development of the copulatory apparatus on the first pleopods, many of them must be sexually mature at any rate. Thysanoessa macrura, G. 0. Sars, too, seems never to have been previously met with in full-grown condition, and but very few of the ' Discovery ' specimens can be 8CHIZOPODA. said to have reached that state. Still, they afford material for a re-description and figures of the species in the adult state, with some notes on the growth change-. The Mvsidacea consist of eleven specimens, referable to six species. The most interesting of these species is Hansenomysis inifnn4fii-,i, an Antarctic representative of a genus hitherto known from hut three specimens from Arctic and Itoival waters. The chief interest of the collection lies in the evidence which it may afford as to the similarity or dissimilarity of the fauna at the two poles. There are no species common to the fauna of both polar regions in the collection : but, on the other hand, all the genera save one, Antarctomysis, are represented in northern waters bv species which are quite distinct from their southern allies. Exploration of the bottom fauna of the, deep waters of the nlolic. especially in tropical and sub-tropical regions, is as yet only in its infancy, and it is therefore extremely probable that what are now known to be bipolar genera and species will in future be found to be cosmopolitan in their distribution. The«8chizopoda were long thought to have in Lophogaster fj/jiicux a stock instance of a bipolar form, but tin- gaps in its distribution have been almost completely filled up as a result of recent deep- sea work, and, with the exception of the tropical Atlantic, its range is known to be complete from Norway to the < 'ape. Two bipolar species of Mysidse are known, however — Boreomysis scyphops, C,. < ). Sars, from Arctic waters, and Lat. 50° S. , near the Crozet Islands, and Ani/>/>/t>jix crozetti, from the seas of Ureeuland and Ian Mayeu in the north and the Crozct Islands in the south. They are not known from the intermediate waters. Of the genera of Antarctic Schixopoda, EH-II/KIHX/H, Tlii/xini<>;:»xel\- related in structure to the northern species Michtheimysis mixta (Lilljeboig), a species inhabiting chiefly the colder waters of the northern hemisphere. The two genera are separated only in the characters of the male pleopods. which arc more primitive in the Antarctic form, and neither genus is likelv to be found to have a distribution which extends very far from the poles they frequent. In the preparation of this report 1 have received miicli valuable help from manv sources. The authorities of the British .Museum kindly allowed me to examine and dissect two specimens from the •Challenger' collections in their charge. To 1 'r. (',-ilman, of the British Museum, I have been much indebted for information on manv points connected with the •Challenger' material, and he has. also, at my reqiu-.-t. furnished me with drawings of various species. Mr. Iv \V. 1,. HO|I kindly examined 4 W. M. TATTERSALL. the British Museum material, and provided me with valuable notes as a result, which I have freely used in this report. The Eev. T. R. R. Stebbing, F.R.S., placed two of the type specimens of Euphausia vu/l< ////'/// at my disposal, with full permission to dissect them if found to tie necessary, while Prof. D'Arcy W. Thompson, C.B., allowed me to examine and retain for some time a small collection of Antarctic Schizopoda from the collections of the Museum at University College, Dundee. I am specially indebted to Dr. Han sen, of Copenhagen, for the most generous and valuable assistance. Not only did he kindly confirm or modify my determinations of the more subtle species of Euphausia, but he placed at my disposal his notes and drawings of the male copulatory apparatus of the species of this genus, of which he has made a special study. Without his help I should have failed to recognise that the two specimens of Antarctomysis belonged to two distinct species, while I should have recorded as E. liict'tix the new Antarctic species which Dr. Haiisen will himself describe. For all this assistance, I wish to express my best thanks. ORDER EUPHAUSIACEA. FAMILY EUPHAUSIID.E. SUB-FAMILY EUPHAUSIN.E, Holt and Tattersall. GENUS EUPHAUSIA, Dana. EUPHAUSIA SUPERBA. (Plate L, Figs. 1-12.) Kii.li/iin/xi/i xiijiir/nf, Dana, is.'c'. K/ijifiii.ii.xia st/perlni, G. 0. Sars, INS:-; and iss.V Ei/pliaiiaia nuirrfiyi, G-. 0. Sars, 1883 and 18s:.. Kiipl/anxifi an/af/i/ni, G. 0. Sars, 18X3 and INN:>. Enphaiinfa t/lan'ulix, Hodgson, 1902. Kiipliai/^in ni/sf ralis, Hodgson, I'.lni'. Eii]}lian.$i/i Kiiprla, Holt and Tattersall. I'.ioi; (1). EnpIi/tnxi/1 xii/>/'rl/ri, Coutim-, I'.iftf!. L<>c<>n carcinophaga, 3. 1. 02, eleven specimens, 43-47 mm. Lat. 72' 5' S., long. 172° 23' E.? 10. 1. 02, eleven specimens, 15-47 mm. Lat. 72° 10' 33" S., long. 172° 26' 2" E., 11. 1. 02, ninety specimens, 35-48 mm. From River Koettlitx, 2. 1. 0::J, sixty-nine specimens, 13-27 mm. Lat. 70' 29' 27" S., long. 168° 51' 46" E., 26. 2. 04. live specimens, 45-47 mm. None were taken at Winter (Quarters from the holes dug in the ice. The synonymy given here, whereby five suppo.-ed distinct species of En)>l«m*i) Small blunt .•>•/- outer h«- I'll tli,' outer //*f tin- mil' nmil >/- <>/ t/m j><'iinltin> the three shown by Sar> being frequently noticed. In all VOL. IV. K 6 AV. M. TATTERSALL. other respects the 'Discovery' material arid the 'Challenger' types are in perfect agreement, and the facts noted above establish the identity of the females here referred to E. superba, with the species described by Sars as E. murrayi. It now remains to show that the differences between E. murrayi and E. superba are only sexual. Male. — Under the name E. superba Sars has described and figured this sex adequately. The only point in which his description is deficient is the structure and armature of the telsou. He figures no dorsal spiuules on the telson, and both describes and figures the apex as slightly produced and obtusely pointed. Examination of Sars' type shows that the apex of the telson is clearly broken, so that Sars' figure is in this respect entirely imaginary. In the present material the apex of the telson is much produced and acutely pointed, and the number of dorsal spinules is usually three pairs, but may be four or two, placed as in Sars' figure of the telson of E. murrayi. One pair of spinules still remains in Sars' type of E. superba, but the others had probably been broken off (or obsolete ?). The most conspicuous difference between E. superba and E. murrayi, as described by Sars, is the presence in the latter and absence in the former of a lateral denticle on the carapace. But both Sars' E. murrayi were females, and his single specimen of E. superba a male, In all the females in the present collection, the largest of which is 47 mm. in length, the spine on the lateral margin is large and prominent, and even in a female, 50 mm. in length, in the collection from University College, Dundee, the spine is equally well-developed. I have figured the spine of the latter specimen on PI. I., Fig. 10. In male specimens, on the other hand, only those which are less than 42 mm. in length have the spine well-developed (cf. PI. I., Fig. 12, taken from a male, 39 mm. in length). In males above 42 mm. up to 47 mm. in length the lateral spine on the carapace is nearly obsolete and persists only as a blunt protuberance (cf. PL I, Fig. 11, taken from a specimen 45 mm. long, and also Coutiere (1906), PI. II., Fig. 22, taken from a male of the same size). The ' Discovery ' collection contains no male specimens exceeding 47 mm. in length, but the ' Challenger ' type measures 48 mm. It is well preserved and shows no trace of the lateral spine at all. Obviously, then, the absence of a spine is a sexual character confined to absolutely full-grown males only. The remaining differences between E. superba and E. murrayi given by Sars are as follows : — (l) E. superba has the antenuules considerably more robust than in E. murrayi and the lobe from the second joint almost -obsolete. This difference is, I think, a purely sexual one, affording a parallel instance to that seen in the northern species, Nyctiphanes couch). PI. I., Figs. 1 and ~2 are taken respectively from male and female specimens of the same size, viz.. 45 mm., and from the same bottle. They indicate, clearly, the difference in relative stoutness in the two sexes, and that of the male shows the lobe from the second antenuular joint in an intermediate stage of reduction between that of the female and that shown by Sars in his figure of the male E. xiiperliti, 48 mm. in length. SCHIZOPODA. 7 (•J) In A'. xtijii-rfxi the rostrum is shorter and blunter tlian in A'. ninrriii/i. and lias the margins less deeply concave. This, again, is dearly shown to lie a sexual difference in PI. I., Figs. 1 and 2. The rostrum of the male figured (Fig. 2) is shorter than that of the female, but is still rather more acute than in Bars' figure of K. .v//y/et. \veeu the two sexes is brought out by the figures here given, namely, the reduction in the male of the spine 011 the outer distal corner of the basal joint of the auteuuular peduncle. It is not visible in dorsal view, being hidden by the slightly projecting anterior margin of the joint, but it still persists as a small blunt protuberance. In the female, on the contrary, it is well-developed, distinctly visible in dorsal view, and acutely pointed throughout life. A fourth distinction shown in the figures, the absence in the female of the curved setse on the dorsal surface of the basal joint of the antennules, is due to the accident that in the female from which the figure was taken, these setse had become broken off. They are, in reality, present, and equally developed in both sexes. The above detailed description proves, I think, dearly, that E. >////»/•/«/ and E. murrayi are the adult male and female, respectively, of one species which must I/ear the name E. superba Dana. I also give (Plate I., Figs. 5-9), figures of the mouth organs and endopods of the first two thoracic limbs, to show two characters in which E. >////.//«/ differs from all other Euphausia yet described. The first of these points is the narrow and elongate form of the terminal joint of the mandibular palp, with its peculiar armature of four or five terminal strong plumose setse. In all the other species of the genus (with the exception of E. untarctica, Sars, and E. i/lncial!*, Hodgson), the terminal joint of the mandibular palp is much shorter and stouter. In the two exceptions just mentioned the mandibular palp is figured by Sars and Hodgson respectively, almost exactly as here given for E. superba. This fact first suggested to me that these (wo species were only developmental stages of E. superba, a suggestion fully borne out by the evidence derived from a study of the present collection. The second distinctive character of the appendages is found in the great length of the setaj arming the joints of the thoracic limbs. They are very much longer than in any other species of the genus, and with the character of the mandibular palp serve for recognition of E. supei/m \\\ aiiv sta^v in its development. E/i/i/iit/ixiit Kiij><-rlni is the giant of the genus, and the only one of Dana's original four species which is now retained by Hanseu (1905 (2)), the other three having been cancelled by that author as unrecognisable. Some Notes «n ///* development <>f A'. These notes were made chiefly with a view to confirming the suspicion, aroused by the similarity in mouth organs, that E/i/>/i•///>./•/»/. ami must therefore lie regarded as synonymous with that species. It should be mentioned that Hodgson's types of E. australis differ in no \vav from E. sujn'rfni (females), except in being considerably damaged. EUPHAUSIA CRYSTALLOROPHIAS. (Plate II., Figs. 1-10 ; Plate IV., Fig. 10.) i-fi/vtal/uni/i/iiitf:, Holland T;itti/rs:ill, I'.MMi (1). of O'y/^/v.x : Winter (Quarters. 26. 1. 02-8. 3. 02, 1 specimen, 24 mm. ,, ,, 216 specimens, larval. No. 3 Hole, 52 specimens, larval to 25 mm. No. 4 Hole, 4572 specimens, larval to 32 mm. No. G Hole, 13 specimens, larval to 25 mm. No. 8 Hole, 4642 specimens, larval to 32 nun. No. 13 Hole, 50 specimens, larval. No specimens were captured either on the outward or homeward journey. Form, moderately robust. ( 'it/'uj'iii-t' (Plate II., Figs. I and 2), with a prominent, rather long and acute spine on its lateral margins, a little anterior to the middle, and just above the insertion of the second thoracic limb ; antero-lateral angles terminating in an acute spine ; anterior margins inflated above the eyestalks and produced into a long acute rostrum extending to the visual part of the eye and about half-way along the basal joint of the anteuuular peduncle; there is a faint gastro-hepatic groove and a distinct keel runs forward medio-dorsally from the latter into the rostrum. Pli'nn (Plate II., Fig. 1) without ridges or dorsal spines ; none of the epimeral plates much produced ; sixth segment about one and a half times as long as the fifth ; preanal spine well developed and usually simple, but in large examples bifid. A//'.y (Plate II., Fig. 1) globose and rather large ; greatest diameter of the cornea exceeding half the length of the last pleon segment ; pigment black. Aittt'iunilai- /ifi/in/i-li- (Plate II., Fig. 2), with the basal joint as long as the second and third joints combined and much wider; no lobe or lappet; a row of about twelve long curved plumose setae set cu a ridge on the distal pan of its length; a short stout spine on the outer distal corner, which is more or less concealed by the numerous setse which arm the outer half of the anterior margin and the Ji-lal 10 W. M. TATTERSALL. lialf of the exterior margin; a bunch of coupling seta? on the inner distal corner; second joint slightly longer than the third and without a lobe, its anterior margin a little oblique. Antennal peduncle about equal in length to the basal two joints of the antennular peduncle, the third joint only very slightly shorter than the second. Antennal scale reaching the centre of the third joint of the antennular peduncle, about three times as long as broad, outer margin entire and terminating in a spine, apex broadly rounded ; spine on the outer corner of the basal joint long and slender, extending one-third of the way along the scale, plumose at least on the proximal part. The mouth parts (Plate II., Figs. 3, 4, 5) are figured for comparison with those of other species. They do not appear to present any striking peculiarities. Firxt thoracic limb (Plate II., Fig. 6), has the penultimate joint of the endopod longer than either the preceding or ultimate joints ; the latter has the lower margin armed with a row of short fine setae in addition to the longer ones at the apex. Second thoracic limb (Plate II., Fig. 7), with the terminal joint armed with a row of three (sometimes four) short, rather stout and curved spines on the inner face. The remaining thoracic limbs have the penultimate joint in all cases longer than the ultimate and slightly longer than the antepenultimate. The following table gives the lengths of the joints of the first six thoracic limbs in millimetres and the total length of the limbs from a specimen 27 mm. long. Thoracic limb. Lengths of the joints in min Total length of linih in mm. 1234 5 G 1 •50 I'll I -50 •77 1-00 •66 5 • :, (. 2 •50 1-22 1-77 I'll 1-22 • 50 6'32 3 •66 1-50 1-88 1-22 1-28 •72 7 • 21; 4 •66 1 • 83 2-05 1-28 1-83 •83 7'98 5 •61 2-00 2-11 1-00 1 ' 05 •66 7-43 <; • 5;-, 2 '(HI 2' Illl •72 • S3 •44 6-54 First pleopod of the male (Plate IV., Fig. 10) with both movable processes on the inner plate of the eudopod shorter than the plate itself; distal process feebly curved, bifid at the tip ; proximal process expanded at the tip into two lobes not in the same plane, the outer lobe the larger, and wider than long, the inner lobe but little expanded ; uncinus of the inner plate of the endopod without secondary spiuule. Telson about one and a half times as long as the last segment of the pleon ; apex acutely pointed ; sub-apical spines extending for half their length beyond the apex of the telsou and hearing a few minute spinules on their inner margins ; dorsal denticles usually in two pairs, the first aliout half-way towards, tin- second at the base of, the sub-apical spines. Uropixh reaching to the level of the insertion of the sub-apical spines, (lie inner very slightly longer than the inner, with a prominent denticle at its outer extremity. Length of the largest adult specimens of both sexes, 32 mm. Eupliiiuxin crystollorophios approaches most nearly among the species uf the genus to E. 'x'nniti*, G. 0. Sars, but differs (1) in the different shape of the rostral projection, (2) in the shape of the epimeral plates of the fourth and fifth se^mem.- of the pleou, (3) in the absence of antenuular lobes and lappets. From E. spti-inli'iift. G. < >. Sars (E. Inci'iis, Hausen) the present species is dis- tinguished by the greater length of the rostrum and by the absence of antenuular lobes and leaflets, the types of E. splendens, G. 0. Sars, being possessed of a small but distinct antenuular lobe. E. crystallorophios is an enormously abundant species under the ice, some ten thousand specimens having been taken. None, however, were met with in any other locality except Winter Quarters. Larva; of E. CRYSTALLOROPHIAS. The collection contains individuals in all stages of development from the M<-liiiiniil>rms to the adult condition. The Calyptopi* larvze (Plate II., Fig. 8) first appear at the beginning of January and continue in the tow-nettings till nearly the end of February. The 1 1 of the carapace is very obtusely pointed in front and has the margins quite smooth. There is no posterior median spine on the carapace, while the telson has the apical margin lightly emarginate. I can see the beginning of the lateral spine of the carapace at this stage. The largest Calyptopis larva measures .".•<) mm. The Furi-Hiii stages (Plate II., Km. '.0 first appear during the last week of Fehruarv and are abundant all through March. Thev cease after the (\\-^\ week in April. The emaruinatioii of the apex of the telson is most marked during this stage and serves readily to connect it with the early CW/// "'"/"'•'•' larva-. The .-pine on the lateral margin of the carapace is now well developed. The size of the Furciim larva- Is from 4- 5 mm. to 8 mm. The Cyrtopin larva- (Plate II.. Kig. LO) first occur about the last week in March, and late post-larval stage- are still to be had at the beginning of August. The size of this stage is from 8 to II mm. The rostral projection is now an acutely pointed triangular plate, but the sides are still bin little concave. The final shape of the rostrum is not assumed till the animal is in all other respects like the adult. At a size of 11 mm. the telson assumes its adult shape, but the pair of spines immediately anterior to the sub-apical spines are -till lon^ ami plumose. Tliev linallv become reduced to adult size when a length of I:; mm. i> readied. At this 12 W. M. TATTEKSALL. latter size the species has all the adult characters, except perhaps the rostrum, which has the margins hardly as concave as fully adult specimens. Examples of 13 mm. in length are to be met with in January, and so were presumedly larv;u of the preceding season, from which it would appear that the species takes at least one year, and very probably longer, to reach the final adult size of 32 mm. EUPHAUSIA TRIACANTHA. (Plate IV., Figs. 1-3.) !:'n.jiJiausia triacantha. Holt and Tattersall, 100(5 (1). Locality of capture -.—Lai. 66° 52' 09" S., long. 178° 08' 15" E., 2030 fathoms; one specimen, immature male, 23 mm. Carapace (Plate IV., Fig. 1), with a single lateral denticle posterior to the centre of the lower margin of the carapace ; antero-lateral margins somewhat inflated over the eyestalks, and then produced into a long and very acute rostrum, which extends beyond the eyes and almost to the distal end of the basal joint of the antennular peduncle ; a faint keel is present on the carapace behind the rostrum. Picon (Plate IV., Fig. l) with the posterior dorsal margin of the terga of the third, fourth, and fifth segments produced into rather long, slender, very acute and slightly curved median spines ; sixth segment rather long, nearly twice as long- as the fifth segment without the spine. Eyes somewhat damaged in the single specimen, but apparently rather small, pyriform in shape. Antennular peduncle (Plate IV., Fig. 2) bearing on the inner distal corner of the basal joint a well-developed bifid leaflet, the lappets of the leaflet of about equal size ; outer corner of the basal joint rounded and adorned with numerous rather long plumose setae ; a row of six curved plumose setae on the dorsal surface of the basal joint ; second joint with a simple acutely spiuiform lappet arising from the median anterior margin : third joint slightly narrower and shorter than the second. Antennal peduncle shorter than the scale, the third joint a little shorter than the second. Antennal scale reaching very slightly beyond the distal extremity of the second joint of antenuular peduncle, broadly oval in shape, about three times as long as broad, apex broadly and obtusely rounded, spine at the distal end of the outer margin small but distinct ; spine on the outer distal corner of the basal joint long, slender and smooth. First pleopods of the male (Plate IV., Fig. 3) obviously not fully metamorphosed, since both the proximal and distal movable processes on the endopod are small and simple, and the uncinus on the middle lobe is without a secondary spinule. Telson with the portion between and posterior to the sub-apical spines acutely produced and smooth; sub-apical spines extending beyond the apex of the telsun. SCHIZOPODA. 13 smooth ; dorsal denticles in two pairs, the first situated at about two-thirds of the distance from the base of the telson to the insertion of the sub-apical spines, second pair just above the spines. I 'nijiiiils sub-equal in length, rather slender, extending to the level of the insertion of the sub-apical spines of the telson. Preanal spine small and simple. A fuller description of this species is not possible, since the single specimen is in bad condition and dissection was not desirable. The species belongs to that group of the genus with a posterior median dorsal spine on the third segment of the pleon, and is distinguished from the other members of the group by having an equally developed spine on the fourth and fifth segments of the pleon in addition. It presents no very near kinship with any described species of the genus, and from the depth at which it was captured is probably a deep- water form. E U P H A U S I A V A L L E X T I N I. (Plate IV., Figs. 4-6.) Eitphavsia splendens (pars), G. 0. Sars, 1885. En/ihai/«tnxitt .«/(/fWc//.v by Sars. They were from the second of the localities given by Sars on p. 82 of his " ' Challenger ' Report," viz., " October 21, 1875, South Pacific." It became at once apparent on examination that one of these specimens did not agree with Sars' description, since the antennule was furnished with a large evenly rounded lappet on the basal joint, very conspicuous in lateral view.* Further examination showed that it probably, indeed almost certainly, belongs to the present species. It is true that 1 could not see the spine on the third pleon segment, but the specimen is in very poor condition, and if, as I suspect to be the case, the spine has been broken off, the scar would be difficult to detect. I give (Plate IV., Fig. 5) an outline sketch of the rostrum and the basal joint * Examination of the ' Challenger ' types of E. splcndens shows that this species possesses a small antonnular lobe, but it is nothing like so well developed and conspicuous as in F.. fulli-ntini (are Hansen (1900 (2) ), Holt and Tattersall U906 ^ ana below, p. 14.) VOL. IV. [,' 14 AV. M. TATTERSALL. of the antennule of the 'Challenger' specimen and (Plate IV., Fig. 4) a sketch of the antennule of one of the ' Discovery ' examples for comparison with those given by Stebbing (1900). This shows clearly, in my opinion, that all three specimens belong to one species, and that the absence of the spine on the third pleou segment of the ' Challenger ' example is the result of accident or possibly an abnormality. The peculiar shape of the antennular lobe is practically the same in the ' Discovery ' and ' Challenger ' individuals, and only differs from Stebbing's types in degree, a result of more complete growth. The rostrum of E. vallentini is very like that of E. splendens, G. 0. Sars, but is slightly longer, and the angle formed by its margins a little more acute. Sars may have been misled by the resemblance between the rostra of the two species, which caused him to overlook the marked differences which exist in the antennulfe. Dr. Hansen has seen the ' Challenger ' specimen referred to, and agrees with my interpretation of its specific identity. One of the 'Discovery' E. vallentini is a male, but unfortunately the copulatory apparatus on the first pleopods is considerably damaged, so that I am obliged to refer to the ' Challenger ' example, which is likewise an adult male, for a description and figure of this apparatus (Plate IV., Fig. 6). The figure represents the inner lobe of the endopodite of the first pleopod of the male. This inner lobe bears internally two movable processes, the inner and more distal of which is feebly curved, slightly over- reaching the inner lobe and bifid at the tip. The external and more proximal of the two processes has the distal extremity greatly expanded, the expansion very much broader than long, oblique, and divided into two lobes, the more distal of which is the larger. On the under side of the expansion of the proximal process as viewed in the figure there is a small spine-like process. The inner lobe of the endopodite itself bears a strongly curved uucinus with a small secondary spine near the tip. Distribution. — Southern Pacific, between New Zealand and Chili (' Challenger ') ; Falkland Islands (Stebbing]. EUPHAUSIA, sp. Locality »f capture. — Lat. 57° 25' 30" S., long. 151° 43' E., nineteen specimens, 10-18 mm. On first looking over these specimens I identified them with Euphausia splemlens, G. 0. Sars (1885), a species which Hansen (1905 (2)) considers to be different from E. splendens, Dana, and which he has re-named E. lucens. Hansen, in the same paper, notes that E. splendens, G. 0. Sars, has the first joint of the anteunular peduncle without a leaflet, but distally produced above. Holt and Tattersall (1906 (1)) have confirmed this statement by an examination of Sars' type specimens of E. splendent, in which they found that in the female type the lobe is quite conspicuous both in lateral and dorsal view ; while in the male type, which is considerably smaller than the female, the lobe is less developed, but still easily seen in lateral view. Sars SCHIZOPODA. 15 was therefore in error when he .described the antennular peduncle of his E, splendens as " more particularly distinguished by the total absence of any dorsal leaflet or lobe." Moreover, it is apparent from what has already been written above in dealing with Euphausia vallentini that Sars confused at least two distinct species under the name E. splendens. It was subsequent to the publication of the preliminary notice of the ' Discovery ' collection that the present specimens came to hand. I therefore appealed to Dr. Caiman for further information with regard to the 'Challenger' .species, and he very kindly sent me a sketch of the dorsal aspect of the anterior end <>f both types. From these sketches and Sars' description in the ' Challenger' report I identified the 'Discovery' specimens as Euphausia splendens, G. 0. Sars = E. lucens, II. J. Ilansen. Wishing, however, to have confirmation of my identification, I submitted the specimens to Dr. Hansen, who at first was inclined to agree with me that they belonged to E. xj>I< ///<>•//* side by side, and a careful comparison, character by character. There are no specimens of the true E. lucens in the ' Discovery ' collection, so I leave the descriptions of the two species to Dr. Hansen, who has abundant material for the purpose. I may mention here that some specimens of an 7v >; ».-/'" (labelled E. xpli'ml, us, G. 0. Sars) in the small collection of Antarctic Schizopods kindly lent me by Prof. ^1 F 2 16 W. M. TATTERSALL. D'Arcy W. Thompson, from the collections of the University College, Dundee, appear to belong to this species. They were collected in the Antarctic Ocean, the exact locality being uncertain, but it is believed to be in the neighbourhood of the South Shetland Islands. E U P H A TJ S I A, Sp. ?, JUV. (PL IV., Figs. 7-9.) Localities of captures :— Lat. 49° 40' S., long. 172° 18' 30" W., five specimens, immature, 8-9 mm. Lat. 58° 49' 45" S., long. 154° 48' W., three specimens, immature, 10 mm. The specimens from the above two localities all belong to the same species. They were submitted to Dr. H. J. Hansen of Copenhagen, who agreed with my suggestion that they were too young for absolute specific determination. I give here only a brief description, pointing out a few of the characteristic features. Carapace with a prominent slender denticle on lateral margins just over the base of the third thoracic limbs; antero-lateral margins- slightly undulate, only partially concealing the eyestalks and produced into a long, narrowly acute rostrum (Fig. 7) extending almost to the anterior end of the eye and about half-way along the basal joint of the autennules. Pleon having the third segment provided dorsally on the median posterior margin of the tergum with a slender spine (Fig. 9) ; sixth segment long and slender, about twice as long as the fifth. Antennular peduncle (Figs. 7 and 8), with a minute bluntly pointed simple lobe on the inner distal corner of the basal joint ; a thin oblique lamella-like ridge running across the third joint from the inner proximal to the outer distal corner and partly continued down the inner side of the second joint. Antennal scale reaching to about half-way along the terminal • joint of the antennular peduncle. Telson having the portion beyond the sub-apical spines produced into an acute apex with smooth margins ; two pairs of spinules present. Uropods reaching to the level of the insertion of the sub-apical spines. This species belongs to that section of the genus provided with a spine on the dorsal surface of the third segment of the pleou. Among members of this section it approaches most nearly to E. gibboides, Ortmann (1893), but Dr. Hansen has kindly pointed out to me that it differs from that species in the much greater length of the rostrum and its different shape. The smallest of the specimens, i.e. all under 9 mm. in length, have the spine on the third pleon segment still undeveloped, only the two largest ones, 9 • 5 mm. and 10 mm. in length, showing it fully formed. We have here slight evidence as to the stage in development at which this spine appears. None of the specimens present any larval characters in the form of the telson or antennules. It would appear, then, that SCIII/.oi'ODA. 17 the spine, at any rate in this species, developes late in life, only after the final adult form is reached. The species was taken on the homeward voyage of the ' Discovery,' in the extreme southern part of the Pacific Ocean between New Zealand and Cape Horn. SUB-FAMILY NEMATOSCELIN.E, Holt and Tattersall. GENUS THYSANOESSA, Brandt. THYSANOESSA MACRURA. (PI. III., Figs. 1-12). Thysanoessa macrura, G. 0. Sars, 1883 ; id. (1885) ; Ortmanu, 1893 ; Stebbing, 1900 ; Holt and Tattersall, 190(5 (l) ; Coutierc, 19m;. Localities of captures : — Winter Quarters. No. 4 Hole, 47 specimens, 7-18 mm. No. 8 Hole, 40 „ 8-21 mm. No. 12 Hole, 2 „ 7 and 20 mm. From River Koettlitz, 2. 1. 03, 6 specimens, 9-14 mm. Outward or Homeward Journey. Lat. 61° 46' S., long. 141° 12' K, 16. 11. 01, 18 specimens, 14-20 mm. Lat. 57° 25' 30" S., long. 151° 43' E., 20. 11. 01, 35 specimens, 12-22 mm. Lat. 54° 1' 15" S., long. 170° 49' K, 27. 12. 01, 1 specimen, 6 mm. Lat. 61° 13' 30" S., long. 173° 33' K, 31. 12. 01, 30 specimens, 12-19 mm. Lat. 66° 52' 9" S., long. 178° 8' 15" K, 3. 1. 02, 3 specimens, 8-9 mm. Lat. 70° 29' 27" S., long. 168° 51' 46" E., 26. 2. 04, 1 specimen, 28 mm. Lat. 49° 40' S., long. 172° 18' 30" W., 12. 6. 04, 2 specimens, 8-12 mm. Lat. 58° 49' 45" S., long. 154° 48' W., 24. 6. 04, 4 specimens, 10 mm. Lat. 59° 34' 30" S., long. 106° 28' 12" W., 28. 6. 04, 3 specimens, 7 mm. Lat, 55° 44' S., long. 95° 43' 30" W., 1. 7. 04, 3 specimens, 6-8 mm. Form. (Fig. 1) of the body rather slender. Carapace (Fig. 1) with a single rather long slender spine on the lower lateral margin posterior to the middle, just above the origin of the sixth thoracic limb ; antero-lateral corners acute and somewhat produced ; anterior margins very concave and produced forwards into a long, slender, acute rostrum which reaches beyond the eyes and far beyond the middle of the basal joint of the autenuules ; there is a low keel on the anterior part of the carapace behind the rostrum, and a very faint gastro-hepatic groove. Pleon (Fig. l) rather elongate, narrow and attenuate; segments unarmed; sixth segment equal to or slightly less than the combined lengths of the preceding two ; 18 TV. M. TATTERSALL. preanal spine well developed, provided with au external strong tooth and a comb-like row of finer teeth up to twelve in number. Antennular peduncle (Fig. 2) rather long and slender, considerably longer than half the carapace ; basal joint rather flattened, considerably wider than the remaining two joints, bearing on its outer distal corner a rather long and slender spine, its anterior margin somewhat overlapping the basal part of the second joint, fringed with numerous setae and exhibiting near the inner side a shallow fissure : terminal two joints very long and slender, subequal in length, their combined lengths slightly exceeding that of the basal joint. Antenna! peduncle (Fig. 3) very long and slender, nearly as long as the scale, third joint less than half as long as the second. Antenna! scale (Fig. 3) extending to about midway along the terminal joint of the anteunular peduncle, almost five times as long as broad, outer margin terminating in a well-marked spine, inner margin sloping away obliquely towards the apex ; spine on the basal joint moderately long, slender and smooth. Mouth parts (Figs. 4-6) do not offer any marked differences from those of Thysanoessa gregaria as figured by Sars (1885, PL XXII). Second thoracic limbs (Fig. 8), with the endopod remarkably long and well developed, in full-grown specimens equalling nearly three-quarters of the total length of the body from the eyes to the telson ; meral joint the longest, extending beyond the tip of the antennular peduncle ; carpal joint a little shorter than the meral and more slender, nearly four times the length of the propodal joint, armed with four slender spiniform setae on the outer margin at the distal extremity, and five similar setse on the inner distal margin ; propodal joint with five long spiniform setse on the outer and six on the inner margin ; terminal joint small, tipped with six spiniform setse. The remaining thoracic limbs (figs. 7, 9, 10) not differing greatly from the same limbs in T. gregaria. Copulatary apparatus (Fig. 11) on the first pleopod of the male exhibits a structure very similar to that figured by Sars for T. gregaria, except that the distal extremities of the two movable processes on the inner lobe do not seem to be serrate. Telson slender, apex acutely produced and smooth ; sub-apical spines smooth ; dorsal denticles two pairs, the first pair just anterior to the centre pf the telson, the second pair a little anterior to the insertion of the sub-apical spines. Uropocl.s exceedingly slender, inner one reaching the apex of the telson, outer slightly shorter. Length of the largest specimen, 28 mm. I have thought it well to describe and re-figure this species, since Sars' original description was taken from admittedly young forms, and I cannot find that mature specimens have ever been described and figured. The changes that take place during growth affect principally the rostrum, the second thoracic (or elongate) limb and the preanal spine. XMIIZOPODA. 19 The rostrum is figured correctly by Sars from a specimen, 13 mm. iu length. At that stage iu development the rostrum is an acutely triangular projection, the sides of the triangle very nearly straight and but little concave. As growth proceeds, however, the sides of the triangular plate become deeply concave and the rostrum assumes the form of a long narrow acutely spiuiform projection, as shown in Fig. 2. This gives it something of the form as seen in T. grei/aria, but it is much longer and more slender than in that species. Sars describes and figures the preanal spine in his 13 mm. specimen as armed with only two teeth. This is correctly stated for a specimen that size, but increase in size is also accompanied by an increase in the number of teeth in the preanal spine, till in a specimen 28 mm. iu length I found the teeth to number twelve in addition to the strong external one. The teeth are, moreover, fine and comb-like, and the whole spine closely resembles that figured by Sars for T. gregaria. I have noticed all intermediate stages in the present material. This clearly undermines the value of the preanal spine as a specific character, since the number of teeth is dependent first of all upon age, while individual variation must also be taken considerably into account. The most considerable changes due to growth are, however, exhibited by the second thoracic limbs. Sars describes them as much smaller than in T. y/vfopis, and Furcilia, larvae. All these are apparently stages of one species. The largest Calyptopis larva measures 3 mm. and is without a posterior median spine on the carapace. The anterior margin of the hood is smooth ; there is a lateral spine on the carapace, and the apex of the telson is very lightly convex. The largest Furcilia measures 4 • 5 mm. Lat. 61° 13' 30" S., long. 173° 33' E., 31. 12. 01, one Furcilm larva, 5 mm., apparently the same species as the following larvse. Lat. 63° 4' 24" S., long. 175° 47' 57" E., 1. 1. 02 ; numerous Furcilia larvse from 4 mm. to 5*25 mm. in length, and apparently the same species as the preceding larva. Wood Bay, 22. 2. 04, numerous small Mctmnniplii and ('ia larva. 9 mm. in length, which, from its size, is probably Euphnuxi specimens of any of VOL. IV. ( ' 22 W. M. TATTERSALL. the genera of the family before him, but drew up his definition from the descriptions and figures of Willemoes-Suhm (1875). He includes in the family the single type genus, Petalophthalmus, Will.-Suhm, with two species — P. armtger, Will.-Suhm, and P. willemoesii, a new species which he founds for the reception of the female ascribed by Suhm to P. armiger. Faxon and Hansen, however, have since pointed out that the female specimen described by AVill.-Suhm is in reality a Boreomysis, probably B. scyphops, G. 0. Sars, so that if this latter view of its identity be adopted, P. willemoesii becomes a synonym of B. scyphops. Czerniavsky's definition of the family is inadequate, inasmuch as no reference is made therein to the remarkable characters of the carapace, and the first and second thoracic limbs, while the importance which is given to the supposed characters of the exopods of the thoracic limbs is exaggerated, the difference in development as compared with those of the Mysidse being very slight. The definition given by Holt and Tattersall, 1906 (2), may, therefore, be adopted with some slight alteration in the characters ascribed to the eyes, rendered necessary by recent discoveries. Examination of British specimens of Hansenomysis fyllse (Hanseu, 1887) has revealed the fact that eyes are, in reality, present in this species. They resemble those described below for the Antarctic species, except that the lappets are much reduced and almost obsolete. Further, in a new species of Petalophthalmus, P. oculatus, recently defined by Illig (1906), the eyes are described, as well developed, with the cornea bright brown in colour and distinctly facetted. In the amended definition of the family, therefore, the description of the eyes would read : — Eyes (first cephalic appendages) small, either imperfectly developed as lamellar or spiniform organs, without visual elements, or furnished with a distinct cornea in which visual elements are clearly defined and functional. GENUS HANSENOMYSIS, Stebbing. Arctomysis, Hansen, 1887 (HOW Czerniavsky, 1883). Hansenomysis, Stebbing, 1893. Hansenomysis, Holt and Tattersall, 190C (1 and 2) ; Tattersall, 1907. The name Arctomysis, given to this genus by Hansen (1887), having been already used by Czerniavsky (1883) for an entirely different form, was changed to Hansenomysis by Stebbing (1893). Arctomysis Czerniavsky is itself a synonym of Boreomysis G. 0. Sars. Of the other three genera belonging to the Petalophthalmidse — Petalophthalmus, Ceratomysis and Scolophthalmus, Hansenomysis comes nearest to the last. Both agree in having the first thoracic limbs devoid of exopods and lacking the internal lamelliform moral lobe, and in the presence of well-developed exopods to the second SCHIZOPODA. 23 thoracic limbs. Whereas, however, in Scolophthalmus the rostrum is prominent and the eyes are modified into sharp spiniform organs, Hansenomysis has the rostrum obsolete and the eyes more or less lean1 ike. Males of this genus have not yet been noted, but specimens of that sex of the northern species, H. fyllse (Hansen, 1887), have come into my hands. Detailed examination and description are reserved for a future occasion, but it may be mentioned here that, besides having the pleopods biramous, males also have the basal portion of the inner flagellum of the antennule considerably thickened and adorned with rings of setae. HANSENOMYSIS ANTARCTICA. (PI. V., Figs. 1-19.) ffanseiiomysis antarctica, Holt and Tattersall, 1900 (1). Locality of capture. — Off Coulman Island, 100 fathoms, two specimens, females, 20 mm. Form (Fig. l) compact, rather slender, tapering considerably towards the posterior end. Carapace (Figs. 1 and 3) short, sub-membranous, leaving the last two thoracic segments completely exposed, and part of a third visible behind its posterior emargination ; anterior border produced, but very slightly, into a broadly and evenly- rounded but somewhat strongly upturned rostrum ; antero-lateral angles evenly rounded and extending forwards as much as the rostrum ; cervical sulcus well marked and rather deep, the posterior margin bounded by a conspicuous and rather sharp ridge formed by the carapace. Behind the cervical sulcus is a shield-shaped dorsal area, indicating the attachment of the carapace to the thorax, behind, and on either side of which the wings of the carapace are free. A slight ridge runs from the antero-lateral angles, first downwards and then -posteriorly, to meet the cervical sulcus, while a shallow groove runs forward on each side from the dorsal shield-shaped area, thus marking off a hepatic area, on which is a prominent forwardly-directed spine with a broad base. A shallow depression follows the base of the rostrum, and merges on either side into the groove formed by the ridge from the antero-lateral angles. A small blunt and rounded spine is present on the gastric aiv;i. Picon (Fig. 1)9 mm. in length, a little longer than the thorax, which measures 8 nun. from the eyes to the posterior margin of the last free segment ; segments cylindrical, postero-lateral inferior margins not at all produced as cpimera ; first segment arcuate in dorsal contour, its anterior margin slightly raised above the level of that of the last thoracic segment, its posterior margin broadly produced, so as to partly cover the second segment, the whole forming a sort of " cap " over the junction of the thorax and pleon ; second to fifth segments sub-equal in length and succeediogly narrower ; sixth segment narrower than any of the preceding ones, and nearly twice as long. a 2 24 AY. M. TATTERSALL. (Figs. 1, 2 and 3) small, united at their base into a thick flattened pad, from the anterior part of which proceed two thin, short, sub-triangular, slightly-diverging lappets, which do not reach the middle of the basal joint of the antennular peduncle ; visual elements entirely absent. Antennular peduncle (Fig. 2) short and stout, its three joints sub-equal in length and quadrangular in outline ; basal joint, with a single long seta on its internal distal corner, and a more or less continuous submarginal row of setae across the anterior dorsal region ; second joint with about seven long stout plumose setse on its inner margin and two or three long setae on the outer distal corner ; third joint with about eleven long stout plumose setse on the inner margin. On the dorsal surface of the basal joint, partly concealed by the eye in dorsal view, is an organ of rather problematical function (Figs. 2, 4 and 5). It appears to consist of a shallow depression bounded by a raised ridge marked with pigment, and overhung by a membranous flap, which apparently rises from its posterior border. The flap only imperfectly covers the depression. In the preliminary notice of this collection it was suggested that this organ might prove to be auditory in function, but under moderately high powers of the microscope no otoliths or even sensory hairs could be distinguished in the shallow pit. Antcnnal peduncle longer than the antennular, and considerably more slender ; distal joint shorter than the preceding. Antennal scale (Fig. 2) lanceolate in shape, about three-and-a-half times as long as broad, apex evenly rounded, the whole of the inner margin and distal third of the outer margin setose ; proximal two-thirds of the outer margin devoid of setae, but armed with eleven strong spines, the proximal one of which is the shortest, and is situated at the end of the proximal quarter of the outer margin, the spines increasing in size distally ; spine on the outer distal corner of the basal joint short, but prominent. Mandibles (Fig. 6) with the cutting edge prominent and molar process well- developed and rather long ; between the cutting edge and the molar process is a single spine-like seta, and in the left mandible a lacinin mobilis in addition; palp (Fig. 7) rather long and powerfully developed, terminal joint shorter than the penultimate, both joints armed on both outer and inner margin with numerous long and rather stout setse. First maxilla (Fig. 8) having the outer lobe much larger than the inner, and armed at its apex with about thirteen spines, behind which is a row of five plumose setae ; inner lobe armed at its tip with four long plumose setae. Second maxilla (Fig. 9) consisting of the usual three lobes, a two-jointed palp and outer setiferous plate, the setae arming the appendage being numerous and rather strong. First thoracic limb (Fig. 10) short and stout, devoid of exopod, but with well- developed epipod ; third joint small ; fourth joint with numerous setre and a row of snuzopom. 25 six short stout spines on its inner margin ; fifth joint with three, sixth j'>iut two, and seventh joint four rather long, strong plumose spines on their inner margins as well as numerous setae. Second thomcic //////<* (Fig. 11) with the endopods longer and rather more slender than the first, exopods well developed ; fourth or meral joint produced internally into a large setiferous lamelliform lobe nearly as long as the iiftli joint ; the latter, the longest joint of the limb, longer than the combined length of the sixth and seventh joints, its outer margin armed with a single seta, the distal half of the inner margin slightly excavate with a row of eight short, closely-set plumose spines and a single long plumose seta on the emarginate portion, and a few long simple seta', set widely apart, on the proximal portion of the inner margin ; sixth joint longer than the seventh, its outer margin armed with a few long setae, the proximal portion of the inner margin bearing a row of about nine short closely-set plumose spines and a single long plumose seta, the distal portion of the inner margin with a few long simple seta) ; seventh joint small, armed with numerous long and rather stout simple set;e. Third in jiff It thoracic limbs (Fig. 12) with the endopods feeble, long and slender; sixth joint slightly longer and more slender than the fifth ; seventh joint very small, forming with two strong spines a very minute chela, densely clothed with short fine set;e ; the rest of the endopod armed with a few short scattered sct.-r. Sixth to I'ii/hlh thoracic //infix (Fig. 13) with the endopods slightly longer and stouter than those of the three preceding pairs ; sixth joint shorter than the fifth ; seventh joint small and bearing a long slightly-curved nail, the junction between the nail and seventh joint being indicated by a seta on the inner margin ; rest of the endopod feebly armed with short setae. Exopods of the second to eighth thoracic limbs well-developed ; basal joint long and rather narrow, the outer distal corner rounded : rlagelliforin part composed of from ten to thirteen joints. Incubatory lamellse, seven pairs, situated on the second to eighth thoracic limbs. Pleopods (Figs. 14 to 18) in the female uniramous, the first pair small, succeeding pairs increasing in size to the fifth pair, which are slightly longer than the sixth segment of the pleon ; first four pairs one-jointed; fifth pair two-jointed, I he second joint longer than the first ; all the pleopods bearing long >(•(;>• at the apex. T< l*nn (Fig. 19) rather massive, longer and a little wider than the last segment of the pleon, dorsally grooved, oblong in shape, slightly wider at the apex than at the base, its margins lightly arcuate ; apex truncate or very lightly emarginate, bearing a single median spine with six or seven long spines on either side ; lateral margins armed with from twenty-five to thirty fairly long spines arranged more or less in series. Iiunr nrojtotl* broken in both specimens. Outer uropud* (Fig. 19) nearly twice as long as the sixth segment of the pleon, two-jointed, the terminal joint about one-seventh as long as the basal ; outer margin 26 W. II. TATTERSALL. of the basal joint without setae, but armed with twenty-one stout spines increasing in size posteriorly. Length of adult and ovigerous female, 20 mm. from the eyes to the tip of the telson. Colour of preserved specimens light brown, with a broad band of dark brown pigment across the dorsal surface of the first segment of the pleon and scattered patches of dark pigment on the lateral parts of the carapace, basal joints of the anteunules arid antennas and the basal membranous pad of the eyes. One of the specimens has young, considerably advaiiced in development, in the incubatory lamellae. In both specimens the telson is considerably damaged, and the description and figures have been drawn up from both specimens and fragments of the telsons found along with them. This fact must be borne in mind in dealing with specimens of this species which may be found by future expeditions. It was a matter of considerable surprise and no little interest to find in this collection two specimens belonging to a genus hitherto known only from a single specimen from Greenland and two taken off the cost of Ireland. There can be no doubt that H. antarctica is co-generic with //. fyllse (Hansen, 1887). All the distinctive characters of generic importance in the mouth parts and thoracic limbs of the latter are reproduced in H. antarctica down to the minutest detail. The points of difference between the two species are, however, sufficiently well-marked and numerous enough to justify specific separation. They may be pointed out as follows :— H. antarctica is in general build a more robust and less fragile species than H. fylb*. Antennae. — In H. fyllse the terminal joint of the peduncle is longer than the penultimate, whereas in H. antarctica the reverse obtains. Antennal scale. — In H. fyllse the outer margin bears only five spines, between which are numerous setae. In H. antarctica, on the other hand, there are eleven spines on the outer margin and no setae between them. Telson. — The telson in Hansen's type-specimen was broken, but so much of it as remained showed that the armature consisted of both spines and setae. In H. antarctica the telson is armed with spines only, which are probably more numerous than in //. fyllse. The shape of the telson in both species is also somewhat divergent. That of //. antarctica recalls rather markedly the telson of Petalophthalmus armiger as figured by Sars in the ' Challenger ' Report. Outer uropods. — //. fyllce has the outer uropods armed with both spines and setae, whereas in //. antarctica there are spines only present. The spines in H. fi/llce number six, while in H. antarctica there are twenty-one. Pleopods. — The type specimen of H. fyllce had only one pleopod remaining. This was one of the third pair, and is described by Hansen as biarticulate. Presumably, 8CHIZOPODA. 27 therefore, the fourth and fifth pleopods will likewise be found to be biarticulate when perfect specimens are examined. In //. unfuri-tica only the fifth pleopods are biarticulate, the remaining pairs consisting of a single joint only. The eyes in the genus are described for the first time. They are remarkable chiefly for their small size and degenerate structure, for the complete absence of visual elements, and the subservience, either entirely or in great part, of ophthalmic functions to those of probably a tactile nature. The cap-like form of the tergum of the first segment of the pleon recalls the somewhat similar form of the third pleon segment in many Carida, and suggests that the posterior part of the body is capable of great ventral flexure. The ' Discovery ' expedition is to be congratulated on the finding of this species, by far the most interesting Schizopod in the collection. FAMILY MYSID^E. SUB-FAMILY LEPTOMYSIX.E, Norman. GENUS PSEUDOMMA, G. 0. Sars. PSEUDOMMA BELGICjE. (Plate VI, Figs. 1-8.) Pseudomma belgicse, Holt and Tattersall, 1006 (1). Locality of capture.— Lat. 78° 25' 40" S., long. 185° 39' 6" E., 300 fathoms, one specimen, immature female, 23 mm. Fi.inn (Fig. l) compact and moderately stoutly built, Carapace (Fig. 1) large, less than half the total length of the body, covering laterally all the segments of the thorax, but dorsally exposing the last one behind its posterior emargination ; its anterior margin very slightly produced into a blunt, very broadly rounded rostrum ; antero-lateral angles rounded; cervical sulcus well marked. Pleon (Fig. 1), excluding the telson, about half the total length of the body from the eye to the tip of the telson ; first four segments subequal in length and slightly longer than the fifth ; sixth segment twice as long as the fifth. Eye plates (Fig. 1) contiguous, exhibiting only a very slight anterior median cleft ; each plate subquadrangular or rhomboidal in shape, nearly twice as broad as long, antero-lateral angles rounded, anterior margin nearly straight, no serrations or armature of any kind ; no pigment present in preserved specimens ; corneal lenses absent, but the ramifications of the optic nerve are clearly visible in dorsal view. Antennular peduncle (Fig. l) short and stout, not extending beyond half the length of the autennal scale ; basal joint almost entirely covered by the ocular laminae, a few plumose setse on each anterior corner ; second joint very short, more than twice as broad as long, a few short seta; on the outer distal corner, inner margin with a few longer plumose sehe ; third joint longer than either of the other two and .-lightly W. M. TATTEKSALL. narrower, rectangular in shape, outer margin unarmed, inner margin beset with a few plumose setae. Antenna! peduncle (Fig. 1) equal in length to the autennular, but more slender; last two joints subequal in length. Antennal scale (Fig. l) slightly longer than the last segment of the pleon and twice as long as the antennular peduncle, about three and a half times as long as broad, outer margin entire and terminating in a very strong spine, beyond which the apex of the scale is but slightly produced ; spine on the basal joint short and acute. Mmitli, parts (Figs. 2, 3, 4, and 5) exhibit no salient points of difference from those of the type species of the genus P. roseuin, G. 0. Sars. First tun I xi'ivi/il tlii'i-iiclc limbs (Figs. 6 and 7) agreeing in the main with those figured by Sars for P. roseum, but a dactylus is distinctly visible among the dense mass of plumose setfe arming the terminal joints, though it is smaller and shorter than the terminal joint ; exopods having the outer distal corner of the basal joint round, though produced, and the flagelliform part composed of ten to twelve joints. Telson (Fig. 8) slightly shorter than the last segment of the pleou, tapering to an evenly rounded apex which is one-third as wide as the base ; apex armed with a median pair of plumose setae and four pairs of strong smooth spines, the innermost and largest of which equals one-sixth of the telson in length ; distal half of the lateral margins armed with five shorter spines. Inner uropods half as long again as the telson, armed with a single long spine in the region of the inner posterior corner of the otocyst. Outer uropods about twice as long as the telson. Length of an immature female, 23 mm. By an error the specimen was described in the preliminary report as adult. This is scarcely correct, since the incubatory lamella; are still only about half developed, so that the adult female probably reaches to nearly 30 mm. The specimen is badly mutilated, the third to the eighth thoracic limbs being entirely absent. P. beljicce is far and away the largest species of the genus yet described, none of the other ten known species exceeding 15 mm., whereas adult specimens of this species must reach to nearly 30 mm. It is most nearly related to P. sarsi Will.- Suhm, described by Sars (1885) from the ' Challenger ' collections for specimens taken at Kerguelen Island. Besides the great difference in size (P. sarsi measures only 14 mm., adult specimens), the only other conspicuous difference is in the ocular lamiuse. In P. sarsi the antero-lateral angles of the eye-plates are serrate, whereas in P. In'lijica1 they are quite smooth. Minor differences in the shape of the antennal scale and telson may also be noted. The antennal scale in P. sarsi has the spine terminating the outer margin less strong than in P. belgicce, while the apex of the scale is more produced. The telson in P. sarsi has the apex more truncate than P. fn'ft/ii'tr and the lateral margins, according to Sars, bear eight short spines. Mr. Holt, however, who has kindly examined the types of P. xarsi in the British SCIIIZOI'ODA. '-".I Museum, informs me that only five spines are present on the lateral margins, so that the armature of the telson of P. fmrni approximates closelv to that of P. belgicce. The only other species of Pseudomma having smooth ocular lamina- is P. australe, G. 0. Sar* (1885), from Bass Straits, Australia. The vastly different form of the antennal scale in the latter, however, abundantly distinguishes it from /'. fi't'/icce. Besides the single ' Discovery ' specimen, this species is also known from the ' Belgica' collections, and has been described by Hansen in ^\IS. under the name which is here used. It is possible that the mutilated specimen noted by Bars (1885, p. I'.n ) from 1675 fathoms in the Antarctic Ocean may have belonged to this species rather than to P. air*!. Sars notes that it was much larger than the latter. ( !f)ius I).M i vi.AMDLVors. Holt and Tattersall. /ti/r/i/litmd/i/iijix. Holt and TattiTsall, I'.iml (1). />,i,-li///r//t/ii-x, Illiir, I'.HK;, linn Holt and Tattursall, l'.M»5. ? Amlli/ops (/«//•«), Ohliu, i:i"l. Dactylamblyops, Tattersall, I'.lnT. This genus was established for the reception of the single rather mutilated specimen of D. /iiiili/xi'/i! in the present collection. Since the publication of the preliminary notice of the 'Discovery1 Schizopoda, however, two closelv allied species have Keen discovered off the west coast of Ireland (Tattersall, 1907). A clearer idea of the exact relationships of the genus has thus been gained, and while the species referred thereto appear, in the present state of our knowledge, to form a natural group, it is undeniably very nearly allied to Dactylerytkrops, Holt and Tattersall (1905), to which genus, indeed, the present species was referred by Illig (1906). The definition of the genus given by Holt and Tattersall, 1900 (1), may therefore be amended as follows : DACTYLAMBLYOPS, Holt and Tattt-rsall. Characters generally as in Airiblyops, G. 0. Sars, except :— /v/.'.v placed close together, but not contiguous, more or less pyriform in shape, furnished with distinct and definite peduncles ; visual elements imperfectly developed. numerous, reaching to the surface of the eye, and probably directly functional as organs of sight; outer distal corner rounded, and not produced into a digitifonn process ; a short blunt process always present on the inner and upper surface. Second thoracic limb* with the eiidopods not noticeably short, but well developed, and considerably longer than the endopods of the first thoracic limbs. Telson not very long, triangular in shape, the distal parts of its margins armed with more or fewer spines ; median set?e absent. Type species, D. hodgsoni, Holt and Tattersall. VOL. IV. II 30 W. M. TATTEBSALL. The absence of median setaj from the apex of the telson is not necessarily of generic importance, since the genera Pseudomma and Dactylerythrops both contain species in some of which these setae are present, and others in which they are wanting. As, however, all three species at present referred to this genus are without median apical setae, it is convenient to retain this character in the generic definition. DACTYLAMBLYOP.S HODGSONI. (PI. VI., Figs. 9- 16.) Dactylamblyops hocljsoni. Holt and Tattersall, 1906 (1). Durtylerythrops areiiata, Illig, 1000. Locality of capture :— Lat. 66° 52' 09" S., long. 178° 08' 15" E., 2030 fathoms, one specimen, male, 13 mm. The single specimen in the collection is considerably damaged, the antenuules, autennal scales, and the third to the eighth thoracic limbs being missing. A complete description is therefore not possible, but it is hoped that as many of the characters as can be made out with certainty will suffice for future recognition of the species in collections. Carapace submembrauaceous, covering all the thoracic segments except the last one, anterior margin produced into a blunt, broadly but evenly rounded rostrum projecting between the eyes ; cervical sulcus well marked ; antero-lateral angles rounded. Picon slightly longer than the carapace ; first five segments subequal in length ; sixth nearly twice as long as the fifth. Eyes (Fig. 9) small, placed- on definite peduncles, not in any way contiguous, pyriform in shape, external angle evenly rounded, a short digitate process arising from the inner dorsal face ; visual elements imperfectly developed, apparently represented by numerous minute granular bodies with a refractive centre ; a large opaque gaugliouic mass, probably the optic nerve, visible in the peduncle, from which a nerve fibre proceeds to the cornea. Antennal peduncle short, composed of three subequal quadrangular joints. Antennal scale broken on both sides, but there does not appear to be a spine on the outer corner of the basal joint. Mouth parts (Figs. 10-13) not differing markedly from those figured by Sars for AmUyops abbreviata (1870-79). First thoracic limbs (Fig. 14) with the eudopod substantially of the same form as in A. abbreviata. Secund thoracic limbs (Fig. 15) of essentially the same structure as in A. abbreviata, but with the endopod apparently much longer, being nearly twice as long as the endopod of the first thoracic limbs. Genital appendix to the last thoracic limbs of the male terminating in two lobes, the larger of which bears six long setre, the smaller one being devoid of seta;, but apparently having a covering of very fine hairs. SCIIIZOPODA. :! I in the male agreeing in all points with those of males of tin- genus Arriblyops. 7i-/.\-nn (Fig. 1G) not unite as long as the last segment of the pleon, triangular in shape, tapering evenly to a narrowly rounded apex, nearly twice as long as broad a1 its base; distal half of each lateral margin armed with nineteen spines, increasing in length towards the apex, the terminal ones about one-tenth of the total length of the telson ; median setae absent. f nyW.v broken on both sides, but the inner one possesses a single strong .-pini- on the ventral surface at the inner posterior angle of the otocyst. Length of the single specimen, an apparently adult male, 1:1 mm. There can be little doubt, I think, that Dactylerythmps nn'mitn, Illig (190G), is the same species as the present one. Minor differences, it is true, are to lie IK it iced. For instance, the visual elements of the eye in Illig's species are represented as larger and less numerous than in D. ln>(l/jsj'.« it is of quite peculiar form, with an outer equatorial membranous ridge, while in D. goniops the eye is quadrangular rather than pyrilbrm in shape. Otherwise the four species are rather closely allied and form quite a distinct generic group to themselves. D. hodgsoni is at present only known from very deep water in the Antarctic Ocean. Illig's specimens were collected over a depth of 4000-5000 metres, while the present specimen was dredged in 2030 fathoms (,-,i. :;7o<) metres). ii 2 W. M. TATTERSALL. SUB-FAMILY MYSIDETIN^E, Holt and Tattersall. GENUS MYSIDETES, Holt and Tattersall. ? Mi/sMiysis, G. 0. Sars, 1883 aud 1885, -non G. 0. Sars, 1804. Mysideis (pars), Holt and Tattersall, 1905, non G. 0. Sars, LSI;;). Myxidttes, Holt and Tattersall, 190(5 (1) and (2). Jfi't), lanceolate in shape; between four and five times as long as broad ; setose all round ; a minute second joint at the apex ; a spine on the outer distal corner of the basal joint. ^fllndinl^'s (Fig. 4) with a well-developed molar process and cutting edge ; palp (Fig. 5) with the second joint somewhat expanded and armed with lung seta: on both margins ; third joint not much expanded, a row of strong plumose setoe on the lower edge, and two very strong simple spine-like seta; at the tip. Second iiuu'illni' (Fig. 7) with the setiferous expansion of the basal joint well developed. Endopods of the first thoracic limbs (Fig. 8) of about the same build as in the genus Mysidopsis, but seven-jointed ; masticatory lobe well developed : inner margins of the proximal four joints armed with numerous plumose setae ; sixth joint bearing a well-developed nail and beset with numerous plumose setae. Eiidopods of the second thoracic limbs (Fig. 9) very similar to those of Mysidupsis ; longer than the first ; sixth joint armed with numerous plumose seta:, but in the specimen dissected I was unable to detect a nail, though it may have been broken oti. 34 W. M. TATTERSALL. Endopods of the third thoracic limbs (Fig. 10) with the merus longer than the tarsus; latter composed of six joints; nail well developed and Linger than the last joint of the tarsus. Endopods of the remaining thoracic limbs become successively longer and more slender from the fourth to the eighth ; the increase in length takes place chiefly in the ischial joint ; the number of joints in the tarsus of the endopods also increases in the more posterior limbs ; in one specimen there were six joints in the tarsus of the third limb, six in the tarsus of the fourth, ten in the tarsus of the seventh, ami twelve in the tarsus of the last limb. Genital appendix (Fig. 11) on the last thoracic limb of the male exceedingly long and slender, equal in length to the first three joints of the limb to which it is attached. Pleopods (Fig. 1'2) similar in both sexes, consisting of a single ramus bearing proximally and externally a rather large process tipped with setse. Tdson (Fig. 13) a little longer than the last segment of the pleon, and more than twice as long as broad at its base ; cleft at the apex for nearly a quarter of its length, cleft rather wide, its margins armed with about eighteen teeth on each side ; the apex of each lobe of the cleft armed with a pair of spines, the inner one the shorter ; lateral margins armed throughout their whole length with about seventy spines, which become arranged in series towards the apex. Inner wopods slightly longer than the telson, with a row of moderately slender and long spines on its inner ventral margin, varying in number from twenty-six to twenty-eight, and extending from the otocyst to near the apex ; spines not arranged in series, but increasing in size distally. In some specimens the spines extend further down the uropod than in others. Outer uropods about half as long again as the inner. Length of an adult female with embryos in the brood pouch, 21 mm. ; of an apparently adult male, 25 mm. A second female with embryos in the brood pouch measured 23 mm. It is not a little interesting that this genus should have been discovered almost simultaneously in the northern and southern hemispheres, M. farrani, Holt and Tattersall (1906 (2)) having just been described when the 'Discovery' collections came to hand. M. posthon is a more stoutly built form than M. farrani, and is further distinguished from the latter in the following characters : — Antennules. — M. farrani has not the outer corner of the basal joint of the peduncle produced nearly as much as in M. post/ton. Thoracic limbs. — The tarsus of the endopods in M. posthon is composed of six to twelve joints, while in M. farrani there are only four. (.< rii i tttl appendix to the last thoracic limb of the male is much longer and more slender in Hf. posthon than in ]\f. farrani. SOHIZOPODA. Pltopods. — The lateral lobe is less developed in M. farrani than in M. [ Telson. — In M. farrani the cleft is armed with only about thirteen spines. whereas in M. postlion there are about thirty-six. In the former, moreover, the lateral margins of the telson are armed with not more than twenty-six spines, not arranged in series, and situated only on the distal two-thirds of the margin. In 3[. posthon the lateral margins are armed throughout the entire length with about seventy spines, arranged, at any rate, distally in series. The whole telsoii in ^^. farrani is more slender than in M. posthmi. The spines on the inner nropods of M. posthon appear to be somewhat longer than in M. farrani I have already expressed the opinion that the genus Metamysidella of Illig is .synonymous with Mysidetes. The type species of the former, ^f. kerguelensis, Illig (190G), is, however, a much smaller species than M. /><>*f/i<'ii. measuring onlv 10 mm. in length. It is otherwise closely allied to the latter, but differs in having the antennular peduncle almost equal in length to the antennal scale and in the details of the armature of the telson. If .l///.v/rAyw.v incisn, G. O. Sars (1885), should in future be found referable t<> the genus Mysidetes, as seems probable, it differs from the present species in size, in having fewer joints in the tarsus of the thoracic limbs, and in the details of (he armature of the telson. I should mention here that I do not attach too great an importance to i In- difference in size between M. kerguelensis and Mysidopsis incisa as compared with JA poxtlton as a specific character, for I have found both males and females of M. farrani quite sexually mature at 15 mm. (judging from the characters of the antennular brush in the male and the incubatory lamella- in the female), while the species, fully grown, reaches to 28 mm. in total length. SUB-FAMILY ^ OKNUS ANTAKCTO.MYSIS, ('mitiere. .l/y.s/.s, Holt ami TattLTsall, I'.H'i; (1). Antarctomysis, Cnntir-rc, I'.ioi;. This genus has been recently established by Coutiere for the reception of the species briefly noted as J ///*/* ii/ii.r!in Mysis (sens, stricto). The genus //«/////////.< /'.v has the fifth pair of pleopods in the male liiramoiis and natatorv. but the third pair are only imperfectly liirannnis. the outer ramus being very minute and single-jointed, whereas in . l;//i//r/.i//,_//.v/'x the third pair resemble the fifth in having both rami multiarticulate and setose. 36 AV. M. TATTBRSALL. 1 became aware, only after the plates illustrating this report had been printed, that the two specimens of Antarctomysis in the ' Discovery ' collections, referred in the preliminary note to one species A. maxima, in reality belong to two distinct but very closely allied species. On my appealing to Dr. Hausen, he very kindly sent me some notes and sketches of .4. maxima, and a second species of the genus discovered by him in a collection which he is engaged in working out. These notes and drawings placed the matter beyond doubt, the larger of my two specimens clearly belonging to Hansen's second species. I note the species here, and give the points of distinction, but leave a full description and name to Dr. Hansen. The drawing on PI. VIII. , Fig. 1, was taken from the real A. maxima, but the remaining figures on the plate represent the appendages of the second species, which, at the time, I took to be A. maxima also. They will probably be of use, however, in illustrating how closely allied the two species are when they are compared with the figures given by Coutiere (1906) of the true A. maxima. ANTARCTOMYSIS MAXIMA. (PI. VIII., Fig. 1.) Mysis maxima (pars), Holt and Tattersall, 190G (1). Antarctomysis maxima, Coutiere, 1!)06. Locality of capture. — AVinter quarters, 5. 6. 02, D-uet hole, 56 fathoms, one specimen, immature male, 33 mm. Coutiere (1906) has recently described this species in great detail from mature examples collected by the French Antarctic Expedition. I have practically nothing to add to his description, but since no figure of the entire animal was given by him, my drawing on PL VIII., Fig. 1 may be useful. Coutiere does not mention the spines arming the inner ventral edge of the inner uropod. They extend from the posterior inner corner of the otocyst to the extreme tip of the uropod, and posteriorly, at least, are arranged in series of twos, threes and occasionally fours. The species would appear to be circumpolar in distribution, since, besides the single specimen in the ' Discovery ' collection, it has been taken by the French, Swedish and Belgian Antarctic expeditions ; by the two former, in considerable numbers. ANTARCTOMYSIS sp. (PL VIII. , Figs. 2-12.) M>jsis maxima (pars), Holt ami Tattersall, I'.KiG (1). Locality of capture :— Lat. 78° 25' 40" S., long. 185° 39' 6" E., 300 fathoms, one specimen, immature male, 40 mm. This species is so closely allied to A maxima that I only became aware that it was distinct when too late to properly illustrate it. The figures 2-12 on Plate VIII. were taken from the appendages of this specimen. DA. .".7 The species will lie fully described and named by Dr. Hanson, so here 1 will merely note the points of distinction between it and A. maxima. (1) Eye. — In .1. maxima (I'l. A' 111., tig. I) the eye is largo and the visual elements occupy a large part of -the outer side of the eye-stalk, so that in dorsal view the inner eye-stalk proper is much longer than the outer, and in external lateral view verv little of the latter is visible. In the present form the eye is smaller and narrower than in A. maxima, the visual elements occupy the terminal part of the eye-stalk only, so that the inner and outer margins of the latter are snboqiial in length, and in external lateral view practically the whole of the eye-stalk is visible. (2) Rostrum. — In A. maxima the angle contained by the antero-lateral margins of the carapace which form the rostrum is equal to or slightly greater than a right angle, so that in lateral view the antero-lateral margins are not very oblique. The tip of the rostrum is produced into a very small spine. In the new species the angle of the rostrum is considerably less than a riglit angle, so that the antero-lateral margins of the carapace in lateral view are very oblique. The apex of the rostrum is bluntly rounded. (3) Aiifi'i/i/ii. — In A. maxima the basal joint of the antenna, from which the antennal scale and peduncle arise, bears two spines vcntrallv. one at each of the outer and inner distal corners. In the new form, only the one on the outer distal corner is present, the inner corner being rounded. (4) In ^1. maxima the tarsus of the third to the eighth thoracic limbs is seven to eight-jointed (excluding the nail); in the present species the tarsus is six to seven-jointed, so that the two distal joints before the nail are proportionately longer than in A. maxima (cf. PL VIII., Fig. 8, with Coutiere (1900), I'l. I.. Fig. I 1). In other characters the t\ve species are practically identical. 38 AV. M. TATTER8ALL. LIST OF AUTHORITIES QUOTED. COUTIERE, H.. 1906. — Expedition Charcot. Crustaces Schizopodes et Decapodes, Paris. CZKRNIAVSKY, W., 1882-3. — Monographia Mysidaruui imprimis Impcrii Rossici, fasc. i.-iii., St. Petersburg. DANA, J. D., 1852. — United States Exploring Expedition, Crustacea. HANSEN, H. J., 1887. — " Malacostraca marina Groenlandiae occidentalis." Vid. Medd. naturh. Foren. Kjobenavn. HANSEN, H. J., 1905 (1).— " Prelim. Report Schizopoda 'Princess Alice,' 1904." Bull. Mus. Ocean. Monaco, no. 30. HANSEN, H. J., 1905 (2). — "Further notes on the Scbizopoda." Bull. Mus. Ocean. Monaco, no. 42. HODKSON, T. V., 1902. — Schizopoda in " Report collections Natural History ' Southern Cross.' " Loudon. HOLT, E. W. L., and TATTERSALL, W. M., 1905.— " Schizopod. Crust. N. E. Atlantic Slope." Report Sea and Inland Fisheries, Ireland, 1902-3, Pt. ii., Scientific Investigations, Appendix no. iv. HOLT, E. "W. L., and TATTERSALL, "W. M., 190G (1). — "Prelim, notice Schizopoda 'Discovery.'" Ann. and Mag. Xat. Hist. ser. 7, vol. xvii. HOLT, E. W. L., and TATTERSALL, W. M., 190G (2).— "Schizopod. Crust. N. E. Atlantic Slope. Supple- ment." Fisheries, Ireland, Sci. Invest., 1904, v. ILLIG, G., 190fi. — "Bericht ii. die neuen Schizopoden-Gattuug und ArtenderDeutschenTief see-Expedition, 1898-1899." Zoologischer Anzeiger, Bd. xxx., no. 7. NORMAN, A. M., 1902. — "Notes on the Natural History of East Finmark." Ann. and Mag. Nat. Hist., ser. 7, vol. x. OHLIN, A., 1901.— "Arctic Crustacea." Bihang Kongl. Sven. Yet.-Akad. Hand!., Bd. 27, Afd. iv. ORTJLANN, A. E., 1893. — Decapoden und Schizopoden der Plankton-Expedition. Ergeb. Plankton Erf. der Humboldt-Stiftung, Bd. ii. G, b. SARS, G. 0., 1SIU. — Beretning om en i Sommeren 1863 foretageu Zoologisk Reise i Christiania Stift. SARS, G. 0., 1869. — Undersogelser over Christianiafjordens Dybvaudsfauna. Christiania. SARS, G. 0., 1870-79. — Carcin. Bidrag til Norges Fauna. I. Monog. Norges Mysider. SARS, G. 0., 1883.— "Prelim, notices Schizopoda ' Challenger.'" Forhandl. Vidensk. Selsk. Christiania, no. 7. SARS, G. 0., 1885. — Report on the Schizopoda collected by H.M.S. 'Challenger.' Zool. 'Challenger' Exped., Pt. xxxvii., vol. xiii. STEBBING, T. R. R., 1893. — History of Crustacea. London. STEBBIXI;, T. R. R., 1900. — " On some Crustaceans from the Falkland Islands." Proc. Zool. Soc., London. TATTERSALL, W. M., 19n7. — "Prelim, diagnoses of six new Mysidat from the West Coast of Ireland." Ann. and Mag. Nat. Hist., ser. 7, vol. xix. WiLLEMOES-Sumi, R., 1875. — "Some Atlantic Crustacea from the ' Challenger ' expedition." Trans. Linn. Soc., London, ser. ii., vol. i. ZIMMER, C., 190-4. — Arktische Schizopoden. Fauna Arctica, ii. ZODIEK, C., 1905. — "Biologische Notizen iiber Schizopoden." Verhandl. d. Deutsch. Zool. Gesellschaft. 39 EXPLANATION OF THE PLATES. PLATE I. • Euphausia superba. FIG. 1. — Male, 4;"i mm., dorsal view of anterior end x 10. Fn:. 2. — Female, 45 mm., doi&al view of anterior end x 10. Fin. :;. — " GlfiriiiHx '' stage, dorsal view of anterior end x 15. Fin. 4. — Late Cyrtopia stage, dorsal view of anterior end x 30. Fin. 5.- Maudilmlar palp x 1:!. FIG. d. — Second maxilla X 1:1. FIG. 7. — First maxilla x l:i. FII;. *. — First thoracic limb, endopod x '.'. FIG. '.i. — Sirond thoracic limb, endopod X '.». Fin. 10. — Lateral s| line on carapace of female, 50 mm. x :!». Fn;. 11. — Lateral spine on carapace of male, 4.1 mm. x :•«. Fin-. 12. — Lateral spine on carapace of male, :!'.) nun. X 30. PLATE II. FIG. 1. — Male, lateral view of entire animal x U. FIG. 2. — Female, dorsal view of anterior end x l">. FIG. 3. — Manclibular palp x :H>. Fin. 4.— First maxilla x 30. FIG. 5.— Second maxilla x 30. FIG. 6. — First thoracic limb x 20. FIG. 7. — Second thoracic limb, eudopod x -". Fin. 8. — Calyptopis larva x 4n. FIG. 9.— Furcilia larva x 20. FIG. 10.— Cyrtopia larva x 2i>. I'l.ATE III. ma? runt. FIG. 1. — Female, 28 mm., lateral view x G. Fn;. 2. — Female, dorsal view of anterior end x li>. Fin. 3. — Antenna! scale and peduncle x K>. FIG. 4. — Mandibiilar palp x :•<>. PlG. 5.— First maxilla x 30. Fn:. (1. — Second maxilla x 80. FIG. 7. — First thoracic limb, endopod x '•>«. Fin. 8. — Second thoracic limb, endopod x 1">. FIG. 9. — Seventh thoracic limb, endopod x :'•". Fm. in. -Rudimentary eighth thoracic limb x f>«. l-'in. 12. — Endopod of the second jilenpod "f the male x t'.n. I -2 40 W. M. TATTERSALL. PLATE IV. FIG. 1. — Male, lateral view x 0. FIG. 2. — Male, dorsal view of anterior end x 20. FIG. 3. — Inner lobe of the endopod of the first pleopods of the male to show copulatory apparatus X 80. Euphausia vaU?iitini. FIG. 4. — Outline of antennular peduncle of ' Discovery ' specimen x 20. FIG. 5. — Outline of rostrum and basal joint of antennular peduncle of 'Challenger' specimen x :!0. FIG. G. — Inner lobe of the endopod of the first pleopods of the male in ' Challenger*' specimen, to show copulatory apparatus X 80. Euphausia sp, juv. FIG. 7. — Dorsal view of anterior end of specimen, 10 mm. x 00. FIG. 8. — Lateral view of antennular peduncle of the same specimen x GO. FIG. 9.— Spine on the third segment of the pleon of the same specimen x 2<>. Euphausia orystalloroph iii*. FIG. 10. — Inner lobe of the endopod of the first pleopods of the male, to show copulatory apparatus X 80. PLATE V. iit antarctica. FIG. 1. — Female, dorsal view x 10. FIG. 2. — Enlarged view of anterior end x 23. FIG. 3. — Side view of anterior end x 23. FIG. 4. — Dorsal view of peculiar antennular organ x 70. FIG. 5. — Side view of same x 70. FIG. 0.— Mandible x 20. FIG. 7. — Mandibular palp x 20. FIG. 8. — First maxilla X 20. FIG. 9. — Second maxilla x 20. FIG. 10. — First thoracic limb x 20. FIG. 11. — Second thoracic limb, endopod X 10. FIG. 12. — Third thoracic limb, endopod x 10. FIG. 13. — Sixth thoracic limb, endopod x 10. FIG. 14.— First pleopod x 20. FIG. 15. — Second pleopod x 20. FIG. 16. — Third pleopod x 20. FIG. 17. — Fourth pleopod x 20. FIG. 18.— Fifth pleopod x 20. FIG. 19. — Telson and uropods x 20. PLATE VI. Pseudomma lelyicae. FIG. 1. — Female, dorsal view x 10. FIG. 2. — Mandible x 30. FIG. 3. — Mandibular palp x 30. FIG. 4. — First maxilla x 3ii. FIG. 5.— Second maxilla x 30. FIG. 6. — First thoracic limb, endopod x 13. FIG. 7. — Second thoracic limb, endopod X 13. FIG. 8.— Telson X 20. srilIZOPODA. II D(Ktylain /i///iij/.i FIG. i). — Eye, external lateral view x i'". FIG. 10.— Mandible x I". FIG. 11. — Mandibular palp x 4<>. FIG. li'. — First maxilla x 4i>. FIG. 1:1. — .Second maxilla X In. FIG. 14. — First thoracic limb, endopod X -'7- FIG. 15. — Second thoracic limb, endopod X :.'7. FIG. 111.— Telson x 20. PLATE A 71. FIG. 1. — Female, dorsal view x 13. FIG. 2. — Antennnlar peduncle x is. FIG. 3. — Antenna! peduncle with antennal scale x is. FIG. 4. Mandible X IS. FIG. .">. — Mandibular palp x is. FIG. C. First maxilla X IN. IMG. 7. — Second maxilla x is. FIG. s. — First thoracic limb, endopod x is. FIG. 9.— Second thoracic limb, endopod x IN. FIG. ID. Third thoracic limb, endopod x IN. FIG. 11. — Genital appendix of male x IN. FIG. 12. — First pleopod x 24. FIG. 13.— Telson X IS. PLATE VIII. iiitt.riiiin. FIG. 1. — Immature male, dorsal view x (!. FIG. 2.— Mandible X 2<>. FIG. :!. -.Mandibular palp X 2n. FIG. 4.— First maxilla x 20. FIB. ii. — Second maxilla x L'H. FIG. 6. — First thoracic limb, endopod x s. FIG. 7. — Second thoracic limb, endopod x s. FIG. 8. — Third thoracic limb x s. FIG. 9. — Second pleopod of the male (immature) x 15. FIG. 10. — Third pleopod of the male (immature) x 15. KIG. 11. — Fourth pleopod of the male (immature) x 15. Fio. 12. — Fifth plcopod of the male (immature) x 15. INDEX OF GENEPvA AND SPECIES. Amblyops, 29. Amlly/ijix iililu-fi'iata, 30. Ainbli/ops rrozetti, 3. Aiifturtmnyxin, 3, 35. Antarctomysis maxima, 2, 36. Arctomysis, 22. Boreomysis, 22. Boreomysis scypJwps, 3, 22. Geratomysis, 22. Dactylamblyops, 3, 29. Dactylamblyops ymuops, 31. Dactylamblyops hodgsoni, '2, 30. Dactylamblyops sarsi, 31. Dactylamblyops ihaumatops, 31. Dactyleryfhrops, 29. Dactyleryfhrops arcuata, 2. 30. Echinomysix cfnmi, 2. Eitcopia, 3. Eucopia awl rails. 1, 2, 3. Euphausia, 4. EupJiausia sp., 14, Hi. Euphausia anfarctica, 1, 4. Euphausia australis, 1, 4, .">. Euphausia crystallorophias, 2, 9. Euphausia yibboides, 10. Eiiplimisia glacialis, 1 , 4, 8. Euphausia luceiis, 1, 11, 14. Eiiplmusia murrayi, 1, 4, C. Euphausia. similis, 2,11. Euphausia splendens, 1, 11, 13, 14. Euphausia svperba, 1, 2, 4. Euphausia triaca/itka, 12. Euphausia wUentini, 13, 14. Hansenomysis, 3, 22. Hannfiiomysis antan-tifii, 3, 23. Hansenomysis fyllse, 22, 2fi. Hemimysis, 35. Heteromyxis, 32. Lophog aster typicus, 3. Metamysidella, 32. Metamysidella Icerguelmsis, 35. Michtheimysis mi.i'ta, 3. Mysideis, 32. Mysiddla, 32. Mysiiktes, 3, 32. Mysidetesfarrani, 34. Mysidetes posthon, 33. Mysidopsis, 32. Mysiilopsis ini'isa, 32, 35. J///N/.S-, 35. My sis maxima, 1, 35, 36. Nyctiphanes couchi, fi. Petalophthalmus, 22. Pi'talophthalmus armiger, 22. Petalophthalmus omlatus, 22. Petalophthalmus tvillemoesii, 22. Pseudomma, 3, 27, 30. Pseudomma australe, 29. Pseudomma belyicae, 27. Pseudomma roseum, 28. Pseudomma sarsi, 1, 2, 28. Scolophthalmus, 22. Thysanoessa, 3, 17. Thysanoessa gregaria, 18. Thysanoessa macrura, 1, 2, 17. a •o 9 a. x. W u I 3 - 3 IS •8 u •Ji - _ -' -. - u rt V s a ; O 0 L CO - : - - " : o . - • u o n, o _ > : o : •J JL a I .c o v: o •a oo X ^^ rt T3 O a o - - : - y 1 - E-.-s - - - CRUSTACEA. VIIL-COPEPODA.* BY R. NORRIS WOLFENDEN, M.D. (Cantab.), F.L.S., F.Z.S. (7 Plates.) PREFATORY NOTE. THE collection handed to me for examination and report thereon was contained in 163 bottles, the contents of a few of which were in such bad preservation that they were practically worthless for the purpose of identification. The collection of individual species is not a large one, though there were great quantities of the more common species. But few absolutely new forms were found ; these comprised a new genus (Paralabidocera] and seven new species (Euckceta similis, Stephus ant //< tlit nntiirfti<-ii, and Gaetanus mttarcticus). As such of these copepods as may be considered Antarctic were collected within a small area, I have not deemed it necessary to occupy space by the repetition of individual captures, which would be monotonous and of no particular interest. The drawings have been made by Miss Marion Lees. The signs used in the following pages are B 1 and B 2 for first and second basals : Ri and Re for endopodite and exopodite ; Si for inner marginal and N<- for outer marginal spine (or bristle) ; Li for inner and L<- for outer lobe ; Th for thoraric somite. As they were first used in (liesbrecht's great work, and have been subse- quently often employed by others as abbreviations, the author has thought no excuse necessary for their use here, in order to avoid the constant repetition of the words " exopodite " and " endopodite," etc. I. UNTIL the expedition of the ' Belgica ' there existed no records of the collection of Copepoda south of Kerguelen, except those of Dr. Brady, which referred to the ' Challenger' collections made from the south of Kergucleu to the pack-ice at 66" 'J9' S. The collections made by the ' Discovery,' the ' Belgica,' and the ' Gauss ' form a most important contribution to the plauktonology of this southern region, and the * Owing to the author's absence from England he was unable to see the " revise " of this Report. — ED. •2 II. NO H HIS WOLFEXDEX. results of any one expedition cannot properly be appreciated without reference to the others. The 'Belgica' collections were made S. and S.E. of Peter I. Island, between (59° 48' and 71° 18' S., and 81° 19' and 92° 22' W., between April 21st and December 6th, 1898, by means of nets lowered through holes in the pack-ice to a depth of 0-500 metres. The 'Discovery' collections were made by lowering and raising a vertically actuated net through holes cut in the ice, while the ship was in Winter Quarters.* The ' Gauss ' collections were made from the South of Kerguelen to the winter station in Gauss Bay, Kaiser Wilhelm II. Land, and were of very extensive character, and as the collections were further made throughout the Atlantic traverse of the ship, they afford an opportunity for the comparison of the purely Antarctic fauna with that of the Southern Ocean. In considering the question of the distribution of the Copepoda of the southern- most area of the Atlantic (the Antarctic region) it is convenient to consider the results of these expeditions together, since any conclusions drawn from the results of the ' Discovery ' alone would be incomplete and even misleading. The ' Belgica ' collections have been reported upon by Dr. Giesbrecht (" Eesultats du Voyage du S.Y. ' Belgica ' en 1897-1898-1899"; Rapports Scientifiques, 1902), and the ' Gauss ' collections are still under examination, and I only now refer to the results of my examination of that collection in so far as they assist the elucidation of the ' Discovery ' results. From the results of the three expeditions (' North American,' ' Challenger ' and ' Vettor Pisaui') which, previously to the 'Belgica,' had collected in the Southern Ocean as far south a* the pack-ice. Giesbrecht accepts seventeen species as correct, after rejecting a number of species as "uugeniigend beschriebenen und nicht zuverlassig geuug bestimmten "),y c/r., Ai'tuliii* iirnmtus (50° S.), Calanus jmmarchiehus (52°), Caltinus patagoniensis (47°), C. propiiiquus (64° 37'), simittimm (52°), Centropages Iifcie/tiiiftix (52°), ClrtiiHiiciilniiu* arcuicornis (53°), Clytemnestra yeuf<-tlaf2"). Caiulacin i-nrta (oO"| and truncata (64- 37'), EiiciiJiiniin nllfiiiiiitits (47" 25'). Ei/i'liii In nun-ilia (47° 25'), Haloptilus aculi-iitim (46" -lii'i. HeteroVfhabdMA xjiii>/>, (50°) Lucicutiii flaviconiis (17" 2.V). Pli'iii-fiiniiiiiiiii iilxlominale it'i.'i 12'). Cojiilin &tylif,-rn ifii; '20 i, ( • Belgica ' report, p. •">. COPEPODA. (49°), Oithona >/////'//'< (52°), Paracalanus //<'/•/•//- (52°), nasutw (52°), R. giyi* (65° 42'), Scoledthrix minor (46° 46'). This list contains a .striking number of forms which are usually associated with more temperate regions, and, as Dr. Giesbrecht remarks, the failure in agreement with the pelagic species of the ' Belgica ' is very striking, for only two species are common to all collections. Comparing it with the results of the ' Discovery ' the same extraordinary differences are manifest, only four species ((.'. yy/-<.y)/'//y//«.--) ('. >/'/,/, '//;/////>, Glausocalanus <'/r///V«/v//X <.)itln>nr»/'tin/u>i* and C. xiniillinuix, Clausocalanus , A<>tiu* iinim/u*, Lii*. I'ml, url,/t -/////.-•, and in Lat. 49° 40' 8., and Long. 172° 18' 30" W., Pleuromamma . \\hich belong undoubtedly to a subtropical or warm temperate area, and are to lie regarded as accidental. VOL. IV. K 4 R. NORRIS WOLFENDEN. While the number of species captured was in each case comparatively small, the number of individuals in any one haul in the case of the ' Discovery ' was very great. The rule wyhich appears to hold good for tow-netting in the north part of the North Atlantic, viz., that the further north we go the smaller the number of species, but the immensely increased preponderance of individuals of certain species, certainly holds good as regards the South Polar regions. Immense numbers of the small copepod Ctenocalanus vanus appear in some of the hauls, to the almost entire exclusion of any other species, and in other cases the larger copepod Euchceta antarctica appears in great preponderance. Calanus acutus and, to a lesser extent, Calanus propinquus also preponderate largely. Similarly, Metridia gerlachei appears in most of the captures. The collections of the ' Gauss ' provide information which is not given by those of the ' Discovery ' or of the ' Belgica,' namely, that several species which appear in the Southern Polar Sea also occur in the deeper water of the Atlantic Ocean to the northwards of the Antarctic area. But as this properly belongs to the report of the ' Gauss ' collections which I have in hand, I forbear its discussion in this place. Two questions are suggested by Dr. Giesbrecht in his ' Belgica' report, viz., (l) Does the Antarctic area possess a peculiar fauna ? (2) Is the small agreement of the Antarctic copepod fauna with that of the nearest seas due to defective research, or is it that the area of the pack-ice has its own peculiar fauna ? and the further questions as to whether the admixture of Polar and Antarctic fauna occurs in the deep ocean, or whether there are physical and bibgenetic conditions in the Polar regions which differ from those in the warm seas and prevent such exchange of species, receive some elucidation from the collections of the ' Gauss.' With regard to the first question, viz., Does the Antarctic area possess its own peculiar fauna ? it must be remarked that from the results of the three collections named the typical copepod fauna (pelagic) of this region consists in the following : — Calanus acutus Oncca curvata, similis, frigida, notopus, „ simillimus conifer a, „ propinquus Scolecithrix glacialis Rhincalanus grandis Oithona similis Euchoeta antarctica ,, frigida „ austrina Gaetanus antarcticus „ similis Haloptilus ocellatus Ctenocalanus vanus Paralabidocera hodgsoni Heterorrhabdiis austrinus Stephus longipes • Eucldrella magna „ antarcticum Spinocalanus antarcticus Ectinosoma antarcticum Metridia gerlachei Microcalanus pusillus COPEPODA. 5 1. Of the Antarctic Copepoda the following are new species and genera : — Paralabidocera hodgsoni Euchirelli nui/jna HdloptiluS wi'llut/ix J'"unitl/n/fcckl and 3f. ///>,v//.v). Oncea curvata „ ,, 0. subtilis, Giesb. Rltiiiculnnus grandis „ ,, /?. gigu*, Brady. Harpacticus furcifer „ „ IT. flexu*, Brady. •• 3. Of species which occur in the North Polar regions there are only the following ' Discovery ' species, which bear such slight modification as to be practically identical : Microcalanus pusillus ( = Pscudocalanus pygmseus) ; Oith<>nj»(* ; and in the 'Gauss' collection, Oncea cunlfera, Gaidius tenuispinus and brevispinus, and Amaltpphora iinii/nn, that is, seven species of a total of 55-60 species occurring in the South Polar seas, are all that are identical with the species described by Prof. Sars as collected by Nansen's Norwegian North Polar Expedition. It would not, however, be safe to take this list of Prof. Sars' as the ultimate result of copepod research of the North Polar seas, and other species may yet be found to be identical. The following table shows the comparative relationship of species of the more frequently occurring genera :— N. Polar. S. Polar. Citltnttis fitimarr/iicus replaced by <'. /•roiiin\. Eurluetn fintitrctira. „ sii/iilix. Metridia gerlacltei. „ princeps. di Ian us aattits. tonsil*. similliunix. rn mix. Oithona similix. Harpa<-ti<-iixfnr,-ifii-. Microedlanus pusillus. tSttpli nx lo/iffijies. 1 antarcticus. Paralabidocfra hodgsoni. Glausocalanus arcuicornis. Faroella anliir<-li<-iNc,>rrs. (Plate I., figs. 1,2,3, 3", 4.) Calanus propingwa, Brady, Rep. ' Challenger ' XIX., Copepoda (1883), p. 34. Giesbrecht, Fauna u. Fl. Neap. XIX. (1892), p. 91. ,, Giesbrecht und Schmeil, Das Tierreich, Copi-poda (18!)8), p. 15. „ Giesbreclit, ' Belgica ' Report, p. 16. T. Scott, Trans. Linn. Soc. VI. (1800), p. 25. The length of this copepod given by Brady is 5 * 5 mm., by Giesbrecht 4 • 9-5 • 3 mm. The majority of the ' Discovery ' and ' Gauss ' specimens measure under 5 mm. The cephalothorax is rather over three times as long as the abdomen, furcal segments twice as long as broad. Head evenly rounded, without any trace of crest. Head separate from first thoracic segment. Last thoracic segment laterally produced a little, and ending in short points. Anterior antennae not reaching beyond the furca (thus shorter than described by Giesbrecht, in these specimens). Relative proportions of 24th to 25th segments as 18 : 21. Second feet Be 3 divided into proximal portion 24 ; distal 25. Third „ „ „ 20; „ 23. Fourth „ „ „ 36 : „ 20. Ri 3 with seven bristles, end saw two-thirds the length of Re 3. Fifth feet, B 1 with inner margin convex below, concave distally, with thirteen or fourteen teeth, and distally with three teeth, larger than the others. Ri 3 with five bristles, two outer, two apical, one inner. This animal is much more robust than the next species (simillimus). The ', with respectively 1:1:6 short weak bristles. Right foot Ri nearly as long as Re, with 1:1:6 bristles. Re not much more than half as long as Re of opposite side. First basal with inner margin armed with seventeen to twenty large teeth ; in its upper part slightly concave, in its lower part slightly convex, the teeth all of pretty much the same size. 10 R. NOKRIS WOLFENDEN. 2. CALANUS ACUTUS. (Plate L, figs. 9, 10.) Calanus acutus, Giesbrecht, ' Belgica ' Report,* p. 17. This copepod was first described by Giesbrecht from the Belgian South Polar Expedition, and in the ' Discovery ' collection it forms the chief constituent of the South Polar copepod plankton, along with Euchceta antarctica. The majority of the animals I have met with both in the ' Gauss ' and ' Discovery ' collections are smaller than the size given by Giesbrecht, viz., 4 '7-5* 3 mm. But few of our specimens reach 5 mm. length, the majority being from 4 '5-4 '7 mm. The cephalo thorax is not quite four times as long as the abdomen, the head divided from the first thoracic segment, the last segment of the latter produced laterally, but with evenly rounded margins and no points. In lateral aspect the head is slightly produced forwards, and more inclined to be oval than rounded. In the dorsal aspect it has a distinct triangular appearance, with slight crest in the mid-line. In its broadest part the thorax is 1 • 15 mm. broad, that is, three times as long as broad. The furcal segments are a very little longer than the anal, and nearly twice as long- as broad. The anterior antennae vary in length in different animals, in some being only as long as the furca, in others one or two joints longer, and are distinguished by the comparative length of the last joint, which is about twice as long as the one before it. In the second feet the Re is divided into two portions, proximal = 24 ; distal = 13. third ,, ,, „ ,, = 29 ; ,, =15. ,, fourth „ ,, ,, = 15 ; „ = 15. The jRi'3 has in the second and third feet eight bristles, in the fourth only seven, and in the fifth only four (with no outer marginal bristle). The end saw of the Re 3 of the second feet is shorter than the Re 3 ; in the third and fourth pair longer. The fifth feet are distinguished by the absence of the outer marginal bristle of the Ri 3, and the total absence of teeth or hairs on the inner margin of the first basal. All males appeared to be immature. 3. CALANUS SIMILLIMUS. (Plate L, figs. 5, 6.) Calanus simillimus, Giesbrecht, ' Belgica' Report, p. 17. $ 2 • 5-2 • 9 mm. ; cephalothorax, 1 • 9 mm. ; abdomen, • G mm. long. Head separate from first thoracic segment, evenly rounded, without any trace of crest. Head not quite as long as the rest of the thorax (as 18:21). Last thoracic * " Belgica Report " is throughout this monograph used to indicate " Eesultats du Voyage du S. Y. ' Belgica ' en 1897-1898-1899." Kapports Scientitiques. 1902. COPEPODA. 11 segment laterally produced somewhat and ending in short points. Anterior antennas about as long as the furca, or about one joint longer. Genital segment as long as the next two. Furca three times as long as broad, and longer than the anal segment. Second feet, Re 3 divided by the marginal spine into two about equal parts. Third feet, Ri 3 with eight bristles (four outer, two apical, two inner), J'< :\ divided into two parts, of which proximal : distal = 17:13. Fourth feet, Re 3 divided by the marginal spine, proximal : distal = 20 : 11. Ri 3 with seven Si (two outer, two apical, three inner), terminal saw of Re 3 only three-quarters as long as Re 3. Fifth feet B 1 toothed, with fourteen teeth on the rather convex margin, and at the distal end a slight break in the continuity, with three rather larger teeth somewhat- hidden, in front view, by the upper teeth of the marginal surface. Ri 3 with five bristles (two inner, thin and short, two apical, and three outer). In the second pair the Ri reaches about the end of the He 2, in the third pair to the first inner marginal bristle of the exopodite, and in the fourth pair as far as the second inner marginal bristle, in tin1 fifth pair beyond the origin of the first inner marginal bristle. The endopodites are therefore proportionately larger than in C. tonsus, and the third segment of the exopodite is not four times as long as broad. While this species agrees with C. pn>/>////f//>i\ in many particulars, the proportions of the third and fourth feet differ, also the toothing and convex margins of the basals o O of the fifth feet, and the size. Many of the examples were quite adult females with sperrnatophore attached, so there can be no question of their being merely undeveloped examples of C.propinquus,KO.di,&& before mentioned, this species has a considerable area of distribution in the southern oceans. 4. CALANUS TONSUS. (Plate I., figs. 7, 8.) I'lihinmt tinisiis, Brady, Rep. XIX., '('hull.' Report, p. :;i. Scott, Tr. Linn. Soc. VI. (1803), p. 25. „ „ Giesbrecht, Famui u. Flora Neap. XIX., p. !>:.'. „ „ Diihl. Verb. Dcutsches Zool. (irsdls. IV. (1894), p. 11. Brady's original description of this species is very incomplete, and he merely states that it is "like C. finmarchicus and j>r»/>ii/tftitix, except that the anterior antennae are almost devoid of setae, except on the three apical joints; the posterior antenna- are like those in C. propinquus, the fifth pair without basal teeth, and the first abdominal segment large and tumid. The anterior antennae are as long as the body .... 9 Size 3' 6 mm." He gives only two figures — r!:., of the anterior antennae and the abdomen. Giesbrecht includes it under the " I'nbestimmbare species," remarking that the VOL. IV. I, 1:2 R. NORRIS WOLFENDEN. first character probably results from the bad preservation of the animals ; the second is a character of other members of this genus ; and the third point is characteristic of gracilis and rdbustior. Scott merely mentions that " the large and tumid first abdominal segment seems to be a fairly good character " (loc. cit.). However, this is not a characteristic of this species any more than of C. rdbustior, and the existence of this species up to the present time therefore must be regarded as extremely doubtful. However, the ' Discovery ' collections contain several examples of a copepod, which, if it is not Brady's species, answers fairly well to it so far as his description goes. 9 3 '5-3 '6 mm. long (cephalothorax, 2' 75; abdomen, '75. Body broadest at the end of the first thoracic segment ( 1 • 1 mm. broad). Abdomen short, genital segment broad, and one-third broader than the following segment. Furcal segments not quite twice as long as broad, and nearly twice as long as the anal segment. Head evenly rounded, without trace of crest, separate from the first thoracic segment, last thoracic segment only slightly produced, and with rounded margins. Anterior antennae only reaching the end of the third abdominal segment, the only long bristles on the twenty- third, twenty-fourth, and twenty-fifth segments, the twenty-fourth joint twice as long as the twenty -fifth. Mouth parts resembling C. finmarchiws. Second feet — second basal with four large spines on the distal margin at the inner side. Re 3 divided by the external outer spine into proximal and distal portions respectively as 23:16. Ri 3 with eight bristles. The whole endopodite does not reach beyond the distal margin of Re 2. Re 3 as large as Re 1 + Re 2. Third feet — four large spines on B 2 distal inner margin, endopodite reaching a little beyond the distal margin of Re 2. Re 3 divided into proximal part = 32, distal portion = 16. Ri 3 with eight bristles. Fourth feet — Re 3 divided into proximal part = 37, distal = 15 ; apical saw only seven-ninths as long as Re 3. Ri with seven bristles only (three inner, two outer, two apical). B 2 with one or two spines on distal inner margin. On the second, third, fourth and fifth feet the outer margin of the second basal is distally armed with a spine; in second — fourth, the lie 3 = lie I + 2, and is about three times as long as broad. Fifth feet — first basal with straight inner margin without teeth or hairs, B 2 with five spines on the distal inner surface. .K/ 3 with six bristles (two inner, two outer, two apical). The only Calanus with which this shows agreement is, possibly, Brady's C. tonsus ; but Brady's description is so fragmentary that it may well be another species. It occurred in some numbers at Station, 22 -11 -01, Lat. 56° 31' S., Long. 156° 19' 30". Such males as were observed were all immature. 13 RHINCALANUS (DANA). (Plate II., fig. G.) Rhine, gramlis, Giesbrecht, 'Belgica' Rup., p. 18. ? Rh. ffiffas, Brady, ' Challenger ' Rep. XIX., p. 42. Scott, 19th Rep. Scotch Fishery Board (l'.)"l), p. 237. „ Giesbrecht, Fauna u. Fl. Neap. XIX. (1 *'.>:.'), p. 153. Hli. i/tijas was described l>y Brady as 'distributed over a very wide area between l«mg. 53° 32' W.— 130° 52' E. and lat. 36° 44' S — 65° 42' S. Much doubt has been expressed by Giesbrecht as to the validity of tin's species, and the figures given by Brady of abdomen and of the whole animal are those, in Giesbrecht's opinion, of immature animals, and this author thinks that Brady's figure of the first feet is really of one of the other pairs of feet. Scott's specimens (Fair Isle and Firth of Forth) are regarded by Giesbrecht as Rh. nasutus (Tli. .'! and 4 with dorsal or with a lateral spine, as in nasutus, and a pair of small dorsal points on the genital segment). Mobius's specimen from the north of Scotland is also identical with tinsutus. Rh. na-mtus is very common in the Faroe Channel and seas off the north of Scotland, and occurs abundantly in my collections made in these regions and along the Atlantic trough, west of Ireland, and also appears in the ' Gauss ' collections as far south as lat. 20° N., while in the same collections Rh. grandis (Giesbrecht) appeared. From the remarks of Sars in "Crustacea of Norway," Vol. IV., p. 15, it might be inferred that Rh. nasutus is of rare occurrence in the Northern Ocean (" two specimens were taken east of Iceland, one specimen by Hjort between Scotland and Norway, and it has not yet been found in the immediate vicinity of the Norwegian coast.") However I have taken it in abundance on many occasions throughout the Faroe Channel. It is rather important to establish the identity of Brady's Rh. //'//•'-, and of two preserved specimens at the British Museum, which I have examined, one measured 5'8 mm. and another 6'0 mm. Both were immature females with four-jointed abdomen, lateral spines on Th. 3 (small), and on Th. 4 (large), with none on the fifth segment, resembling Rli. ijnDul/*, one dorsal spine on the first abdominal segment (no dorsal spines on the thoracic segments), and so far as could be seen without dissection, the first feet had an exopodite of two segments only, and the fifth pair consisted each of only one ramus of three segments. These two animals were, of course, very much smaller than described by Brady (8'5-10 mm.) and were undoubtedly immature, and the species may well be identical with young /t'//. i/nimUs (Giesbrecht). L 2 14 R. NORMS WOLFENDEN. RHINCALANUS GRANDIS. Rhincalanus grandis, Giesbrecht, 'Belgica' Rep., p. IS. ? 7'2-S'O mm. Head produced in front, dorsally roughly triangular in shape, with large lateral swellings at the base, rostrum not visible from behind. The cephalo- thorax is over six times as long as the abdomen, which is composed of three segments. A pair of short spines on the anterior margin of the third thoracic segment, and a pair of strong and longer spines on the fourth segment, differentiate this species from naxitfu*, also the absence of any spines on the abdominal segments. The first pair of feet have the Ri and Re of only two segments, Re three with two marginal spines ; other feet (except the fifth) have three-jointed rami. The fifth pair, of one branch only on each side, with three segments, have on the second segment a long inner marginal bristle, and on the last segment three bristles of nearly equal length, two apical, of which the outer is the thickest and the middle one a little the longest, and one on the inner distal margin. A short spine is present on the outer margin in its upper third. The anterior antennae are about six joints longer than the furca. Adult males were absent. These examples are absolutely identical with Giesbrecht's species. METRIDIA (BOECK). One of the most remarkable things about Brady's ' Challenger ' Copepoda is the omission of mention of any example of this genus from his report. Distributed throughout the Atlantic from the North to the South Pole, and in the Pacific, and throughout the track followed in the Atlantic and Southern Ocean by the ' Challenger,' the absence of mention of any species of this genus is certainly extraordinary. In the northernmost regions Mftridia lon/ja occurs (Sars, Norwegian North Polar Expedition) throughout the Faroe Channel and the Atlantic trough as far south as Valeutia in Ireland ; and south of the Wyville Thompson ridge, M. lucens, normani and curticauda (Wolfenden) ; while south of Lat. 40° and throughout the Atlantic occur M. curticauda, brevicauda, princeps and veiiuxta ; but south of Kerguelen appears a new and charac- teristic species, M. gerlachei, which replaces all others. This is the representative species of the South Polar seas, and it appears abundantly in the ' Gauss,' ' Discovery,' and ' Belgica ' collections, and it is as characteristic of this area as M. longa and lucens are of the northern cold area. M. princeps occurs seldom, and M. brevicauda as a straggler, outside its proper area of distribution. COPEPODA. 15 METRIDIA GERLACHEI. Metridia gerlachei, < < iesbreekt, 'Belgiea' Report, p. -2~. 9 3 '5-3 "8 mm., very variable iii size, occasionally a little larger and often smaller. but the average of size of examples in the 'Discovery' and 'Gauss' collections is rather less than that given by Giesbrecht for the ' Belgica ' specimens. The cephalo- thorax is one and a half times as long as the abdomen, head separate from h'rst thoracic segment, last segment with rounded margins. The abdomen has the proportional length of its three segment ~ as 9 (genital) : fi : 4 (anal), and tin- i'urca i- one-lift h longer than the anal, and thivr limes as long as bmad. It is divided into two portions by the outer marginal bristle, <>f which the proximal is twice the length of the distal. The shape of the head and thorax is in this species characteristic, the back being extremely gibbous, and the head with very bold curve, which makes it easilv recov.ni.~- able at sight from any other species of this genus. The anterior antenna' are com- paratively short and do not reach beyond the genital openings. The first and second segments are coalesced ; the eighth, ninth, tenth, eleventh, have only faint indications of separation ; the thirteenth and fourteenth joints are not so clearly divided as the others. There are strong teeth on one, two, three, rive, seven (one cadi), those of the third, fifth, seventh joints the strongest, and directed straight forwards. The sesthetasks are numerous. The endopodites of the second pair of feet have the usual excavation and hook process on the first segment, but in this species the inner hook is exceedingly strong. In the fourth pair the end saw is only two-fifths of the whole length of the fie 3 (shorter than in Giesbrecht's examples). The fifth pair consists on each side of three segments, but the distal segment is more or less completely divided into two, the division however is not complete. The two basal joints are of about the same length and breadth, each as broad as a little over half the length. The third joint, however, is not more than four-fifths as long as the basals, and only half the breadth. The second joint bears one short distal bristle, the last joint one outer marginal bristle in the proximal half, and three distal bristles, of which the innermost is the longest and thickest, the outermost the shorte.-t. MKTKIUIA PRIXCKPS. (Plate III., figs. 3, 4, 5.) Sfetridia princeps, Giesbrecht, Atti Line. Ki/ml.. SIT. I. v. ."i. p. i'i. „ „ „ Fauua 11. !•'!. Xrap. XIX.. p. ::in. „ „ ravran, Ann. l!r|>. Fir-h. Iivlaml I'.IOL' OS, PI. II. \[>\<. II. < l'J05). ilii/ nitii-rtirii, Sal's, Bull, iln Mils. Ocuimog. Monaco, I'.HI.'P, no. In, p. 7. Though only one example of this species occurred in the 'Discovery' collection, it was fre<|iient in the 'Gauss' collection, not only at several Atlantic stations, but also 1G K. NOERIS WOLFENDEN. at the southernmost stations. Northwards it ranges to the west coast of Ireland, and, as has been mentioned, has an extreme southern distribution. Giesbrecht's description was given from only one specimen, and compared with Bars', very briefly described, M. maenu'ii. M. princeps, Giesbrecht. M. macrura, Sars. Cephalothorax one and a half times as long as the abdomen Anterior antennas extend beyond the furca Short teeth on 1, 2, 4, 5, and C, the 2nd the Tail about as long as the anterior division Longer than the body Only feeble traces of the, strong teeth of princpps longest Genital segment longer than both the following Anal segment half as long as the preceding one Furca twice as long as anal, and 5 times as long as About as long as the two preceding segments broad 5th feet like priitcrjis, but less unequal Size 8' 5 mm. Size 10 '50 mm. Of the many examples which have come under my notice I find that the relative sizes of the abdominal segments and furca are subject to some variation, thus : — 1. G.S. 30. Ab. 2, 16. Anal 6. Furca 28 long, 3 broad. Size 8 '15 mm. 2. ,, 28. „ 16. „ 8. „ 25 ,, 3 „ ,,8 mm. 3. „ 27. „ 16. „ 7. „ 23 „ 3 „ ,,8 mm. 4. „ 22. „ 11. „ 4. „ 12 „ 2 „ „ 6mm. The genital segment is thus always twice as long as the two succeeding segments, the anal is not more than half the preceding segment, the furca is generally longer than the two preceding segments, and usually from seven to nine times longer than broad. The teeth on the antennae are weak, and entirely resemble the figure given by Giesbrecht in Plate 33, fig. 3 (op. cit.). It is difficult to resist the conclusion that these are one and the same species, and not two different species. The male was not described by either Giesbrecht or Sars, but I have met with several examples. ? . The largest adults were from 8-9 mm. in length. The body is very transparent, the head evenly rounded, cephalothorax (4'15- 4 '5 mm. long, abdomen 4'0 mm. long), only slightly longer than the whole abdomen, and a little over one- third as long as broad. The genital segment is larger than the next two, the anal not more than half o o o ' as long as the preceding, often much more than the combined length of the two preceding segments and 6-9 times as long as broad, and divided into two portions by the marginal bristle, of which the proximal is to the distal as 8 : 5. The right furcal segment is sometimes a little longer than the left. Anterior antennte at least three joints longer than the furca, the basal joints broad, with short teeth on the basal seven joints, of which those on the first two joints are the largest. The 17 distal joints taper and arc very slender. Proportional length of joints of anterior antennae :— 1&2 [ 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8&9 | 10 | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 [ 15 | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 [ 20 [ 21 [ 22 | 23 | 24 | 25 1-2 | 4 | 5 | 5 | 5 | 5 | 14 | G j 9 | 9 | 12 | 12 | 13 | 13 | 14 | 14 | 15 | 10 I 9 | 10 I 10 j 7 j 3 The eighth and ninth joints arc quite coalesced, but in some there is a weak line of division. The second pair of feet have each the characteristic hooks on fill, and the outer one is the longest. The surface of the second basal is beset with short spines, but not the Re 1. The third feet are normal and with shortened end saw. The fifth pair each consist of four segments, of which the basal is greater than the second, this longer than the third, and third longer than the fourth and terminal segment. The first joint has on its ^surface a considerable bunch of long stiff hairs (as in princeps), the second joint has a long stiff feathered bristle on the outer distal margin, and the third joint has a short upright spine on the outer distal margin, in all specimens (not on the inner side as figured by Giesbrecht), and the end joint has three rather long fine bristles, of which the innermost is the longest. The spine on the third joint was in one example replaced by two very short spinules on the right foot, while none were present on the left side. $ 5 • 8-G mm. long (cephalothorax 3 '25 mm. Abdomen 2' 3 mm. long). Relative lengths of the abdominal segments =14, 10, 10, 4, and the furcal segments 13. The left furcal segment is a little the largest and thickest, and six times as long as broad, and three times as long as the short anal segment. The anterior anteniuu extend for about three joints beyond the furca, as in the female, and the left one is a clasping organ with weak joint between the seventeenth and eighteenth segments. The segment beyond the elbow is very long and thin, and as long as the next two distal joints. There are four joints beyond the elbow. The conjoined first and second (basal) joints have two strong teeth, the distal one the largest and curved slightly forwards. The fourth joint has a smaller tooth. Fifth feet : The right foot with very long first joint, the second short, but with very strong, broad- based curved and long hook, the third joint nearly twice as long as the second, and tin- fourth and end joint a long simple spoon-process twice as long as the third. In the left foot the first joint is very small, the second nearly twice as long, the third a short joint, the fourth a very long simple curved spoon-shaped process. On the inner margin (proximal) of the fourth, of the third, and the distal foot of the second arc fine hairs. Both feet are of nearly similar length. EUCHAETA (PHILIPPI). Two representatives of this genus appear in the ' Discovery ' collections — E. antarctica, and another which appears to have constant differences, and to which I have attached the name E. .*///////*. 1 do not in this collection find any example of 18 R. NORRIS WOLFENDEN. Giesbrecht's species E . amtrina, though I have found it in the ' Gauss ' collections. E. antarctica appears in many stages, extensive captures consisted wholly of immature specimens, but there are many adult examples. Many males appear amongst these, and while the females are very distinctively different, I arn not able to discrimin- ate between those males, as to which definitely belong to aiiturctica, and others which might belong to sim'di*. Both species are very closely allied, and differ very considerably from the large species of the northern cold seas, viz., norireijicn, glacial! s and l>arl>ata. EUCHAETA ANTARCTICA. (Plate IV., figs. 5, fi.) Ein-litcta antarctica, GiesbrccLt, 'Belgica' Report, p. 21. This is one of the most abundant copepods in the ' Discovery ' collection, appearing in all stages of growth, and in some samples almost to the exclusion of other species. Size of adult examples 7 • 6 mm.-8 mm. Head evenly rounded, without frontal prominence and with short rostrum directed forwards. Last thoracic segment with rounded margins, produced forwards and with a bunch of hairs on each side. The abdominal segments have the postero-distal margins armed with rather strong bluntly conical and striated teeth, and the two middle segments have on the ventral side bunches of long hairs. The furca and bristles are the same as in E. similis. The genital protuberance occupies the lower half of the segment, its upper margin is not deeply concave like similis, but the whole swelling is directed downwards, and its upper margin is slightly convex. Above the genital swelling is a secondary prominence, which in the ventral aspect is seen to consist of two valve-like chitin thickenings. The lower part of the protuberance has two lateral lobes, the upper are small, and above this a prominent horn directed straight forwards and never absent in adult specimens of E. antarctica, making it quite characteristic of the species. In the ventral aspect the appearance is quite different from that of similis. The genital opening is oval, almost round, with lateral cushions, and above the upper edge of the genital opening guarded by a chitin ridge, is the horn. The whole swelling is quite symmetrical, rather conical, and occupies quite the lower part of the segment. The first pair of feet have the outer margin very concave above and very convex below, with a bunch of hairs on the Re 1 , and a long seta. The seta of Re 2 is also very long and thin. The Re 3 is only half the length of the coalesced Re 1 and 2. In the second pair the Re 1 has a very short Se, that of Re 2 is very long and more than twice as long as the Se 1 of Re 3. In Re 3, the Se 1 does not reach the origin of Se2, the Se2 does not quite reach the end of the segment, and is three times as long as Se 3 and twice as long as Sel. The Se 1 and 2 are very greatly curved and almost sickle-shaped. COPEPODA. 19 In the fourth pair the /?c 3 is not three times as long as broad (1G : G). The anterior antennas are a little longer than the cephalothorax. The (? is a little smaller than the 9, and presents the same sexual differences as in other Euehaetae. The bunches of hairs on the last thoracic segment, so prominent in the 9, are absent in the innus, which was subsequently identified with Stcphos (Scott), several other examples of the same genus have been described. Scott himself recorded three specimens, viz., S. minor, S. fultoni, and 8. ///>. Sars has described two new species from Norway, rlz., S. lamellatus and Scott), which latter is again identical with Stephos gyrans Scott (not Giesbrecht). Giesbrecht's species '(gyranx) is said by Sars to differ in the asymmetrical last thoracic segment and genital segment, the latter with " a number of irregularly arranged spiniform processes not found in any of the northern species," the last feet of the male also differing from S. scotti. The 'Belgica' report contains yet another species described by Gic-lnvcht as Antarctic, viz., S. longipes. This species recurs also in both the 'Gauss' and 'Discovery' collections, and in the latter I find a further and considerably lar-cr example, to which I have given the name antareticum. As these descriptions are scattered over six different volumes, I think it may be of service to bring them together here. 1. S. GYRANS. S. gyrini*. Hi'-sbrecht, Fauna u. Fl. Xcap. XIX. (I*'.':.'), p. 205; Giesbrecht, u. Schrneil, Das Ticrn ich, Copep., p. i".i. Furca longer than broad, anterior antennas reaching to end of genital segment, genital segment with a curved hook on ventral side, shorter hook on dorsal, fifth feet * The author, in agreement with Sars. pri-fcn's the name originally given to the genus by Scott, but it is perhaps better to observe the ordinary rule. — En. M 2 22 R. NORRIS WOLFENUEN. in female, end segment rather curved and broad basally ; iu male, left foot with several long appendages, right foot, thin appendages at end and rest foliate ; size =0'8-1 mm. (Naples.) 2. S. SCOTTI. 8. gy rans, Scott, Nineteenth Rep. Scotch Fishery Board (1901), p. 237. S. scotti, Sars, " Crustacea of Norway," Vol. IV., p. 63. Slender ; cephalothorax symmetrical ; genital segment without spines, furca longer than broad, anterior antennse reach end of abdomen 2, Re of posterior antennse twice as long as Ri ? , fifth, with denticles on last segment, which is elongated and pointed ; $ , fifth, penultimate joint of left foot tumefied, last segment with about half a dozen short processes ; last joint of right foot with long, sickle-shaped process. Size= "85-'95 mm. (Loch Fyne ; Norway.) 3. S. MINUS. S. minor, Scott, Tenth Rep. Scotch Fishery Board, 1892, p. 245. Robust, cephalothorax symmetrical ; genital segment without spines, anterior antennae about as long as the thorax, furca as long as broad, fifth feet in ? with elongated last segment with two little lateral spinules ; in $ , right foot a long foliate joint at end, left foot with two digitiform processes at end, penultimate joint only slightly tumefied. Size = 074 mm. (Firth of Forth.) 4. S. LAMELLATUM. and spine, but no processes. Size '8-'cJ in. (Antarctic). ('Discovery' and 'Gauss' collections. Wolfenden.) 7. S. ANTARCTICUM. Robust, cephalothorax a little unsymmetrical, right side prolonged; genital segment swollen laterally, with bunch of spine-like bristles each side ; fiuva us broad as lon^; anterior antenme reach to Ab. 2 ; Re of posterior antennae longer than Ri. Fifth feet in 9 right side longest, each with three end spines, innermost hook-like ; in <$ , right with third joint elongated and club-shaped distally, with a large, roughly triangular plate, and last joint a strong, curved hook ; left foot, no tumefied segment, and last joint with distally a short-stalked haired knob, no appendages. Size = 175-2 mm. ('Discovery' collection.) STKI-HUX LONGIPES. (Plate V., iigs. 1, 2, 3.) sir/iinis lui/i/ijH's, Giesbrecht. ' Bdgicu ' llq>., p. L'H. 9 '75-' 80 mm. <$ '65-70 mm. Cephalothorax rather more than twice as long as the abdomen ; head separated from first thoracic segment, but all segments very difficult to determine, owing to the indistinctness of the lines. Last thoracic segment with rounded margins and symmetrical. Abdomen in the female four, in the male five segments, f'urcal segments only as long as the anal, as broad as long, and with rounded margins, each with four tail bristles and a short fifth inner marginal bristle, (ieiiital segment in the female as long as the next two, laterally with roughly triangular swellings, and in its greatest breadth, broader than long. Anterior antenna) not as long as the thorax, and of twenty-three joints, the first, second, eighth and ninth coalesced, with few bristles, the longest on the seventh and eighteenth joints, but well supplied with long ;esthetasks. Posterior antemuu with exopcdite about one-third longer than the endopodite. Posterior foot-jaw with rather thick first basal and />' I : /> -2 : /i'/as S : 7 : <> ; mandibles with broad-ended masticatory plate, one pointed outer tooth, with considerable space between il and the middle stout, com para lively broad teefh, and three pointed inner teeth. 24 R. NOERIS WOLFENDEN. First feet Ri=. 1, Re= 3 ; no Se on Re 1, and very short Se on Re 2. Second feet Ri = 2, .Re = 3. Third and fourth feet Ri and Re — ^. Fifth, each of three segments, two basal, each short and comparatively thick, terminal segment longer and thinner, prolonged, with a stout curved hook with short bristles on the upper margin and an external marginal thin and short bristle. The male is rather smaller than the female, the abdomen has five segments, the mouth organs are as in the female, but the fifth feet are transformed into clasping organs, that, of the right side of four segments, the left of five. The second and third segments of the left are elongated, the distal segment short and broadened out, the distal extremity ending in a spine, and at the opposite side a short knob process, apparently without marginal hairs. The right foot with short broad second basal, and two distal very elongated and thin segments, with a long thin sickle-shaped process at the end, which appears to be a continuation only of the joint above it, and though forming an elbow, does not articulate. In the general structure this small Copepod bears great resemblance to the species Stephus antarcticum, which, however, is twice as large ; the fifth feet in the female as well as the male are different, and the two species are therefore quite distinct. STEPHUS ANTARCTICUM. (Plate V., figs. 4, 5, 6, 7, 8.) 9 1'85-2'0 mm. long, cephalothorax about three times as long as abdomen, and in its broadest part distal of the middle line one-third as broad as long. Head evenly rounded, a little produced in front, but without trace of rostrum, a weak line indicating its division from the first thoracic segment. Last two segments of the thorax im- perfectly divided, and last segment a little unsymmetrical ; on the right side a little longer than on the left, produced into a round-ended margin, on the left side more acutely pointed, which is most marked in lateral view. Abdomen of four segments respectively proportioned: genital segment, 2:3 and anal as 20:13:8:8; furcal segments as long as the anal, and as broad as long. Genital segment laterally swollen in the upper part (genital protuberances) and again slightly swollen laterally in its lower part, with on each side a bunch of rather long spines, none dorsally. Furca with four tail setae on each side, outer margins haired and with, on each side, a short lateral spine instead of the usual bristle, and on the ventral side a very short accessory bristle. Of the tail bristles, the two middle ones are much the longest and thickest, and those of the right side more so than those of the left. Anterior antennae reach in both sexes to about the end of the second abdominal segment, having twenty-four segments, the eighth and ninth coalesced. In the posterior antennae the exopodite is longer than the endopodite. The mandibles with branches COPEPODA. 25 nearly of same length, masticatory plate with strong teeth. The posterior foot jaws with first and second basal and Ri in proportion of 24 : 11 : 20 ; maxillae, 132 with 5 ; Re with 10; Pi I with 4, Ri2 with 3, Ri '3 with six bristles, Li 2 and 3 present, and Lc 1 with eight bristles. The first feet have one jointed Hi and three jointed Re, without Se on Re 1. The second feet have two jointed Ri and three jointed Re. The third and fourth feet have both rami three-jointed. Fifth feet comparatively large, that of the right side a little longer than the left. Each of three segments, of which the two basals are equal in size, but the last segment on the right foot is a little longer than in the opposite foot. Each has terminally three spiny processes, the innermost comparatively thick, curved, and hook-like, and with hairs only on the outer margin. The two outer spines are neither much more than half the length of the inner one, and only half as thick. The 3. First pair of feet, B 1 and B 2 with only slightly convex inner margin and no Si. Ri 1 longer than Re 2 + Re 3, outside margin haired and long marginal bristle. Re 2 and Re 3 with similarly long marginal bristles. Se = 1 : 1 : 2 and Si — 1 : 1 : 5. Ri 2 nearly twice as long as Ri 1 and with 5 Si. In the second pair B 2 is broader than long, the inner margin convex and without hairs or bristles ; B I is also without Si. Ri 1 prolonged, Ri 2 shorter (as 7:10). Ri 1 with 2 Si, Ri 2 with 7 Si. Re 1 : 2 : 3 as 1 1 : G : I), with respectively 1:1:1: Se, that of YiV I the largest and of Re 3 the smallest; the end saw about two-thirds as long as the whole /c'< ; a small curved spine distal margin of Re 3 just external to the saw. 5 Si on Re 3. 3rd feet. B I and Ji 2 without bristles or hairs, Ri as in the preceding pair, Re as in the preceding pair and with 1 : 1 : 1 Se only. 4th feet. B I and B 2 as before. Ri 1 with three Si, Hi '1 with only six Si. The three joints uf R<> rather more equal in length, Se 1 : 1 : 1 as in the other feet. Ri I is more elongated than in the other feet and twice as long as L'i •_'. In the second to fourth pairs the Ri is mure than half as long as the Re and extends beyond the distal margin of Re 2. In all feet the number of external marginal spines is certainly peculiar, the usual rule being three marginal spines on the Re 3, so that the animal differs from any true Ltibiflocem. The 5th feet ('(insist of a common basal and one ramus on each side of two B 2 and Re. l\i represented onlv by a spine. The first and second basal. s are L. iv. N 28 R. NORPJS WOLFENDEN. nearly equal in length and each about as broad as long. The second basal segment has at its distal inner margin a very stout articulating spine, JKi four-fifths as broad as this joint is long. On its outer surface, near the distal and outer end, is a delicate bristle. The third segment is nearly twice as long as the second basal, tapers to a point, and just below the distal end is a delicate little bristle. Near the end of the joint and on the inner side is a very stout broad-based spine, not articulating, and nearly half as long as the whole segment. Frequently the foot of one side is a little longer than of the other. The whole animal is very unsymmetrical, especially in the shape of the last thoracic segment and the genital segment of the abdomen. The characters of the swimming feet, as to proportions, and especially as to tlie absence of spines on tin' lu*t joint of tin' f.rnpodite, and the absence of anything like the usual ocelli of Labidocera, are points which appear to remove it from that genus. The abdomen of most females is more or less enveloped in a mass of colourless, structureless membrane. The $ is distinctly five-jointed in the abdomen, whereas in Labidocera this is four-jointed. The right anterior antenna especially also differs from other species. From the characters of the female feet and the abdomen of the males I have thought it justifiable to create a new genus for this animal. I name the species after Mr. Hodgson, the naturalist of the ' Discovery ' Expedition. $ smaller than the 9 (1'6 mm). Cephalothorax with head separate from next segment, two dark lateral spots, but not ocelli, in front of the head. Abdomen little more than half as long as the thorax. -Head evenly rounded, without side hooks, last thoracic segment rounded and not produced. Abdomen of undoubtedly five segments, of which the second is about as long as the third and fourth together, the first is very short, the fourth is twice as long as the anal, which is a short segment ; the furcal segments, of which the right is a little larger than the left, are twice as long as broad and three times the length of the anal segment. Right anterior antenna a clasping organ, the middle joints swollen, the joint before the elbow with a marginal row of small teeth and with only two distinct segments beyond the elbow, of which the distal is very long and thin (over three times as long as broad), and in its distal part carrying on the inner margin a very long spine tapering to a fine whip-like extremity, but broad in its basal portion. This appendage is half as long again as the whole joint. The joint immediately distal to the elbow has on its margin proximally a short but thick spine. I find it very difficult in any of the specimens, of which there are several, to agree with any degree of accuracy upon the exact number of segments in this antenna owing to the fact of its being curled up in every case. First to fourth feet and mouth organs as in the female. 5th feet, powerful clasping organs, the right one of four segments, the left of three, with a common basal. The first segment of the right foot has on its inner margin a small knob projection, the second has two short, thick spines, the third a fine spiiii-, mid the last joint is curved into a strong hook, without any appendages. COPEPODA. 2!> The first joint of the left foot has a short spine 011 the external margin, arid the last joint is broad proxiinally and foliaceous, and on its inner surface is a row of fine bristles, with three or four stiff and longer than the rest. EUCALANUS (DANA). That any species of Eucalanus should be found at extreme southern latitudes is certainly curious, E. elongatus certainly occurs south of lat. 40°, and about 40° W. long., ' Gauss' collection ; and in the 'Discovery' collection I have found about half a dozen examples of a Eucabinu* which 1 regard as a variety of K. subtenuis or >niti:n>- natm. This occurred at station marked 21. x. 01, lat. 57° 25^' S., long. 151° f E., and station lat. 56° 31' S., long. 156° 19' 30", 22. xi. 01 ; in both cases a long distance outside the Antarctic Circle. The 9 (no males were found) is 4 mm. long. The head is very triangular, elongated, and produced in front into a blunt point slightly bent downwards; there are lateral swellings as in attenuatus, the part behind is not, however, indented. The last thoracic segment is rounded. The abdomen has three segments, and one tail bristle on the left side is a little thicker and longer than the rest. The genital segment is laterally swollen and broader than long. Posterior antenna: with first and second joints of the exopodite coalesced, the first joint of the endopodite about three times as long as broad, and about the same length as R(2. The mandibles with very short Hi, the proximal part about three times as long as the distal, the whole Ri very much shorter than the distal part of the basal, and with four bristles and 'two short marginal bristles. Maxilla, B 2 with five, Ri 1 with four, Ri 2 with four, Ri 3 with five bristles. With some resemblance to E. subtenuis, pileatus, and mueronatii*, it is larger than anv of them. The five bristles on the B 2 of the maxilla cause it to differ from either inuaronatus or mhtcnuis, and it has considerable differences from pileatus in size, posterior antenna and mandible. The shape of the head is certainly not that of subtenitix, nor is it so triangular and pointed as CTENOCALANUS (GIESBRECHT). CTENOCALANUS VANI -. Ctenocalitnua rinmx. Gksbrucht, Atti Ace. Lincci Rend., Ser. 4, 1888, p. 335. „ „ „ Fuuua u. Fl. Neap. XIX. (1MH'), p. I'.M. This is extremely abundant in the ' Discovery ' collections, but does not differ in any material particular from the species well known in the Atlantic. Its range of distribution is very great, extending from the Faroe Channel (Wolfeudeu) throughout the Atlantic to the southernmost parts of the Antarctic area. /.<. to the ice region. x 2 30 R. NORRI8 WOLFENDEN. CLAUSOCALANUS (GIESBRECHT). » CLATJSOCALANUS ARCUICORNIS. Clausocalanus amdcornis. Giesbrecht, Atti. Ace. Lincei Rend., Ser. 4., vol. 4, p. 334. Giesbrecht, Fauna u. Fl. Neap. XIX. (181)2), p. 50. „ „ Giesbrecht u. Schmeil, Das Tierreich, p. 27. That this species should occur so far south is rather peculiar. It was found in the collections made at :— Lat. 49° 40' S. Long. 172° 18' 30" W. Lat. 55° 44' S. Long. 95° 43' 30" W. Lat, 5G° 12' 45" S. Long. 136° 18' 30" W. Lat. 57° 25£' S. Long. 151° 43' E. Lat. 58° 49' 45" S. Long. 154° 48' W. Lat. 59° 19' S. Long. 120° 24' 30" E. Lat. 63° 5' S. Long. 175° 43' E. Lat. 84° 01' S. Long. 170° 49' E. and does not differ essentially from the species common in the Atlantic. It has a considerably greater range than was thought, since I can record it from the Irish coast to nearly the Antarctic Circle. GAETANUS (GIESBRECHT). GAETANUS ANTARCTICUS. (Plate III., fig. 6.) G (tetanus antarcficits, Wolfenden, Plankton Studies, Part I. (1905), p. 7. Size 8 mm. The body is very robust and dorsally very gibbous. The head and first thoracic segment are coalesced, and together much longer than all the rest. The last thoracic segment carries two short stout curved spines, directed backwards. The head is in its upper part quite square, and with short stout curved spine, directed a little forwards. The abdomen is not a quarter the length of the cephalothorax. Anterior antennae not as long as the body, of twenty-three segments, with the eighteenth, nineteenth and twenty-first segments longer than the twentieth, and all joints with very few setse. Ei of the posterior antennae more than half the length of Rtj. Posterior foot jaws with lamellar process on the first basal. Maxillse ; Li 1 and Li 3, each with four bristles ; B 2 with five, Ri small and two- jointed. Re small, and less than half the length of B 2. First feet, Re of three segments with three marginal spines, the segmentation being complete ; Ri of only one segment. COPEPODA. 31 Second feet, Rl distinctly two-jointed. Third and fourth feet, Ri and Re of three joints each. B 2 of the fourth feet with tubal bristles as in Gaid'm*. The extraordinary size of this animal makes it the largest known species of Gaetann*. It occurred once only in the 'Discovery' collection, and also appeared in the ' Gauss ' collection, and is probably Antarctic in its habitat Several new species of Gaiiiiniix have been described recently, and it may serve some useful purpose to recapitulate here the different species discovered since Giesbrecht and Schmcil's last work (Tierreich, 1898). 1. (TARTAN us MAJOR. G. major, Wolfe-mien, Proc. Zool. Soc., London, Feb. :!, I'.titt, in Dr. Fowler's paper. „ Farran, Ann. Rep. Fish. Ireland, l!)n^-ii:;. Part II., App. II., I'.Mi.V Size 5 mm. and over. Anterior antenme larger than the body by about one joint ; lamellar appendage of posterior foot jaws absent ; Re of first feet of three segments, and with three Se. Cephalic spine short, and as in G. ariii!;/> r. 2. GAETANUS CAUDANI. i-i/mluiii, Canu, Ann. Univ. Lyon, V. :.'4, p. 24. ,, (?) pi'lci/ti/s, Favran, ihiil. Like G. mil/'*, ljut anterior antennae only one-and-half times as long as the body : lamella of posterior foot jaw like that of G. milt's. Rn of first feet, three segmented basals of fourth feet with tubal bristles, 5 mm. and over. Cunu's original description was of one immature cJ . Farran's were also immature specimens. 3. GAETANUS HOLTI. Gftftanus holti, Farran, ibiil. „ litifrons, Sars, Bull. Mus. Monaco, No. -'(I, March, 11)05. s, Wolfenden, Plankton Studies, Part I. (1!)05), p. 7. Cephalic spine strong- and directed backwards with long interval between the frontal part and base of the horn. Anterior antennae not as long as the body-spines of the last thoracic segment, strong, long, and directed backwards. Small lamella on posterior foot jaw. First feet with three segments and three 6V. Fourth feet with basal tubal bristles. Sixe 4 '74 mm. 4. GAETANUS ANTARCTIC! s. Gaetunii* untaretints, Wolfenden, Plankton Studies, Part I. (1'Jn")), p. 7. Thorax gibbous, very stout short curved cephalic spine directed forwards, head square, not like G. armiger. Abdomen short and thick, not a quarter of whole length. U. NORRIS WOLFENDEN. Anterior antenna not as long as the body. Posterior foot jaw with lamella. Re of first feet with three segments and three Se. Fourth feet with tubal bristles. Size 8 mm. 5. GAETANUS MINOR. Gnetanus minor, Farran, Ann. Rep. Fish. Ireland, 1902-03, P. II., App. II. (1905), p. 34. Cephalic spine as in G. armiger, long slender spines of last thoracic segment. Anterior antennae reaching only to genital segment. First feet with Re of two segments and only two Se. Second feet with one-jointed Re. Size 2'4 mm. 6. GAETANUS ROBUSTUS. G (tetanus rolustus, Sars, Bull. Mus. Oceanographique Monaco, no. 26 (1905), p. 11. Robust, cephalothorax a little swollen in middle. Cephalic spine small, curved, or sometimes absent. Spines of last thoracic segment very strong and divergent. Abdomen thick and about one-third of whole length. Anterior antennae scarcely as long as the body. Size 8 mm. (? possibly the same as G. antarcticus, but the description of G. robustus is insufficient.) 7. GAETANUS INERMIS. Gaetanus inermis, Sars, op. cit., p. 12. Body very thick, anterior division swollen. No trace of cephalic spine, last segment of thorax rounded and without spines. Abdomen very short, not a quarter of whole length. Anterior antennas not longer than body. Structure of other parts not different from other species of this genus (?) Size 6 • 30 mm. (In the absence of cephalic and thoracic spines, which are constant in this genus, this is probably not a Gaetanus.) 8. GAETANUS CURVICORNIS. Gaetanus curvicornis, Sars, op. cit., p. 11. Body like G. miles (Giesbrecht), short curved cephalic spine. Spines of last thoracic segment moderately large and divergent. Very short abdomen only a quarter the whole length. Anterior antennae scarcely longer than the body. Size 4 '35 mm. 9. GAETANUS KRU^PPI. Gaetanus Jcrwppi, Giesbreclit, Mitt. Zool. St. zu Neapel, XVI. (1903), p. 202. Like G. armiger, but larger, viz., 3 '6-4 mm. long, thorax shorter. Anterior antennae reach three joints beyond furca, twenty-second segment longer than in G. armiger. Feet like G. milt'*. <$ 3'7 mm. long, thoracic spines shorter than ? and antennae shorter than body. Se of Re 2 of first foot rudimentary ; fourth feet without tubal bristles. Fifth feet Ri of one segment, Re of right foot of two ; of left, of three segments. Mediterranean. CUFEi'OUA. 33 X ANTHOCAL AN US (GIESBREUHT). There are only two examples of this genus in the 'Discovery' collection. Since the publication of Giesbrecht and Schmeil's " Copepoda " (in " Tierrcii-h ") the genus has received many additional species. To the originally described species, viz., X. ag'dix and AT. minor (Giesbrecht), are now added X. /«j>iiKjn/i.« (Sars), A", niiitii-iix (Sars), AT crixtatus (Wolfenden), X. xnli,-rixiiitux (Wolfenden), X. tfim/ili-.r (Wolfenden), AT. ninijinix (Wolfenden), AT: calaminus (Wolfenden), X. ntl), p. 40. Size 2 "4 mm. Furcal rami little longer than broad, anterior antennae reach genital segment, feet very spinulose. Fifth feet, three segmented, spinulose, and with two terminal and two lateral spines on last segment ; second joint longest, and spiuulose on both margins. (Atlantic. Ireland.) 12. X. PINGOIS. X.pinguis, Farran, Ann. Rep. Fish., Ireland, 1002-03, pt. ii., App. II. (1905), p. 40. Size 4'5 mm. Head imperfectly separated from thorax ; lateral processes of last segment blunt ; furcal segments slightly longer than broad ; anterior antenna; short, not as long as thorax ; rami of posterior antennae short and broad ; feet spinulose. Fifth feet of three segments, and two lateral and two apical end spines ; surface of third and margins of first (inner) and second (outer) spiuulose. (Atlantic. Ireland.) 13. X. GREENI. X. MUTICUS. X.ijreeni, Farran, Ann. Rep. Fish., Ireland, 1902-03, pt. ii., App. II. (190;>), p. 40. X. muticus, Sars, Bull. Mus. Monaco. Size 5'30-G mm. ; last two segments of thorax united, last segment with obtusely triangular margins ; furcal segments short, broader than long; anterior antenna; little longer than budv. Fifth feet small, two-jointed (Sars), or three-jointed (Farran), without spines on inner margin ; last joint with three small apical spines. (Atlantic. Ireland.) 14. X. XTPICUS. Amall«i>linr< >me time when Professor Sars' supplement appeared with the description of u:£t til !<>/>*!*. Consequently I do not kuow to which name priority should be given, nor do I feel yet certain that the genus described briefly by Sars is identical with the Faroella described by me in the J. M. B. Ass. of 1904. Certainly the Faroella of the Antarctic Sea has some differences, and I therefore retain the name for the genus which I originally gave, more especially as Professor Sars, who has examined some Irish specimens, states, as I am informed, that they are not identical with his. FAROELLA ANTARCTICA. (Plate II., figs. 1, 2, 3, 4.) ? $ size 4'3 mm. (cephalothorax 3' 3 mm., abdomen I'O mm.). The fore-bod v is therefore over three times as long as the abdomen. The head and first thoracic segment are united, the two last segments of the thorax separate, the anterior segment over twice as long as the four last segments ; the most posterior of these is well defined from the one in front, small, and laterally prolonged into stout spines which are about three- quarters as long as the genital segment. In dorsal aspect the head is rather triangular- shaped, and on each side below the level of the posterior antenna', laterally expanded. In the lateral aspect the head is evenly rounded, oval, and with stout two-pointed 40 R. NOERIS WOLFENDEN. rostrum directed forwards, with slrght curve downwards, the rostral spines not at all divergent, as in Sars' picture of ^Etidiopsis. The whole cephalothorax is studded with fine and closely-set prickles. Abdomen of four segments, slender, the genital only a little larger than the next, with strong ventral protuberance, > Alt 2 > Alt 3 > Al 4. Furcal segments as long as the anal, and twice as long as broad. Tail bristles four on each side, with very short and delicate veutrally placed accessory bristles. Anterior antennas reaching just beyond the end of the genital segment, the first two joints comparatively large and as long as the next five joints, the combined eighth and ninth joint as long as the two joints either proximal or distal to it, the eighteenth and nine- teenth joints longer than those proximal or distal, and the twenty-fourth separate from the twenty -fifth. All joints only sparingly setiferous. Posterior antennae with exopodite a little longer only than the eudopodite. Anterior foot-jaws with the outer margin of the basal only a little convex, the fifth lobe longer than the four proximal and nearly equally-sized lobes, the Ri small but distinctly segmented. Each lobe with three bristles, two each on the first, second, third, and one on the fourth, being stout, long, and with wide apart stiff marginal bristles. Bristles of Ri long, not feathered, but slightly serrated marginally. Posterior foot jaws having proportionately B 1 : B 2 : Ri = 10 : 12 : 5. 132 therefore a little longer than B 1, and over twice as long as Ri; B 1 two and a half times as long as broad, with two small lobes with respectively two and three short bristles ; B 2 four times as long as broad, its marginal bristles very small and distal of the middle. Ri short and distinctly five-segmented. Maxillse, Le 1 with nine bristles and its outer margin nearly straight ; B 2 with five,, and not segmented from Ri with thirteen bristles ; Le2 a small lobe, but without bristles ; Re small, longer than broad, and with ten bristles ; Li 1 with nine large hooks and four bristles ; Li 2 and 3 well-formed lobes. First feet. Ri one-jointed ; Re three-jointed, with three long thin marginal spines. Second feet. Ri two-jointed, Ri 1 short, Ri 2 very elongated, and nearly four times as long as Ri 1. The whole Ri only extends to the distal end of Re 2. On the distal part of the surface of Ri 2 is a bunch of fine hairs ; Re 3 is as long as Re 1+2, and its end saw is longer than the Re 3 and beset with a great number (exceeding fifty) of closely-set teeth, of which those in the middle are the largest. Fourth feet. Ri and Re of three segments each. Ri proportionately longer than in the other feet, and the third segment as long as Ri 1 + 2, and a little over three times as long as broad, with fine hairs on the surface distally. Re 3 much longer than Re 1 + 2 and over three times as long as broad. Its end saw three-quarters as long as the Re 3, and with over fifty closely-set teeth. No fifth feet. The chief points in which this Antarctic species differs from that of the northern seas are in its greater size, the greater strength of the rostrum, the rather different body proportions, and the more equal size of the rami of the posterior antennae. The COPEPODA. 41 chitiu everywhere in the ecphalothorax is almost covered with prickles, and the whole animal is more robust. MICROCALANUS (SARS). MlCROCALANUS PUSILLUS. (Plate II., fig. 5.) Microcalanus pusillus, G. 0. Sars, Crnstac. of Norway, IT. (1903), p. ir>i;. Pseudocalanus pygmteus, Sars, Norwegn. N. Polar Expdn., Vol. V. Crustacea, I'.HMI. „ „ Giesbreeht, ' Belgiea' Report, p. L'I». Sars originally described a small Calanoid, Ps&udocalanus pypmseus, from Nansen's Polar Expedition, which he subsequently re-named Microcalanus, and included in the new genus a second and still smaller form, of M. puxillu*. Griesbrecht described a small (.'alanoid from the Antarctic seas, which agreed generally with Sars' Polar species, except for very small differences, «'.//. the length of the anterior antennae, and the length of the outer marginal spines of the exopodites of the feet. The size varied, mostly from 0" 7-0 "75 mm. ; some were even smaller. P. pijijmseu*, Sars (= .17! }>>/fjmceus, Sars), is a little longer, viz. • 86 mm. (Sars). The 'Discovery' collection contains many examples of a very small Calanoid which agrees so closely with Sars' M. ]>u*i///<), occurs very sparingly in the ' Discovery ' collection. HARPACTICUS (DANA). HARPACTICUS FURCIFER. Jfiir/itn-tintsfurcifer, Giesbrechf,, ' Belgica ' Report, p. 37. The 9 of this species was first described by Giesbrecht in the ' Belgica ' report ; and in the 'Discovery' collection, marked 4. i. 02. W.Q., occurred three specimens of the male, though female examples were conspicuously absent. The 9, according to Giesbrecht, is 1'55 mm. long; the rostrum small, the series of points on the abdominal segments not numerous, the furca as long as both last abdominal segments, narrowing distallv and about three times as long as broad ; the VOL. IV. P 44 R. NORRIS WOLFENDEN. anterior antennae nine-jointed, the exopodite of the posterior antennae like H. chelifer, but smaller, the second basal of the mandible like H. brevicornis ( — If. fulvus), and the exopodite scarcely half as long as the endopodite ; both rami of the maxillae are about equal ; the first lobe of the anterior foot jaws has three bristles, the fourth lobe is long, and its hook short, the posterior foot jaw is much thinner and weaker than in H. chelifer and IT. brevicornis and more like PL flexus. The first feet have thin and weak terminal claws, both rami of only two segments, and the endopodite is short, the joints of both branches being broader than in flexus ; the endopodites of the second and fourth feet are larger in proportion to the exopodites than in chelifer and brevicornis, and in the fourth pair reach to the middle of the last joint of the exopodite ; the bristles on the second endopodite joint are, however, two, instead of one as in chelifer ; the last joint of the fifth feet is comparatively small, and is scarcely half so broad as this ; its last joint has five, the process of the basal joint, four bristles. The striking feature of H. furcifer is the length of the furcal segments, which are usually very short in this genus, and though related to PL flexus, it differs in the size, which, in the latter species, is only '64 mm. in length, compared with 1'5 in PL furcifer. . \UUirllr |-\|,. Mai iun •up. ill. l jil. I. f'al.mus propiri'i simillim • •] itis i tU i '. 1O) Antarctic (Discovery) E\p. Marlon jiuila pi. II. Faroella amaivtioa (1-4). Microcalanus pusillus (5). Khinocalamis yramlis (6). COPEPODA. 45 EXPLANATION OF THE PLATES. PLATE I. C itl'in us jiriipim/Kim, h'g. 1. Whole animal, 9- Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. „ „ fig. 2. Whole animal, $ . Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. „ „ fig. 3 and 3a, $ . 5th pair of feet. Oc. 3, obj. i in. „ „ fig. 4. 9- Basal joint of 5th foot. Oc. 3, obj. i in. fig. 5. Whole animal, 9 • Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. fig. (1. Basal joint of 5th foot. Oc. 3, obj. \ in. fig. 7. Whole animal. 9 • Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. fig. 8. Basal joints of 5th foot, 9 • Oc. 3, obj. \ in. fig. 9. Whole animal, 9 • Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. fig. 10. Basal joints of 5th foot, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. \ in. tonsus, acutus, PLATE II. initiiriiirii, fig. 1 , fig- 2. %• 3. fig- -t. , fig. 5. Rhincalanus grandis, fig. 6. 9 , whole animal. Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. 9 , Posterior foot-ja\v. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. 9 , 1st foot. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. 9 , 2nd foot. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. 9 , whole animal. Oc. 3, obj. i in. 9 , whole animal. Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. Mftri/lin /'/•/// ''r/is, PLATE III. fig. 1. 9 , whole animal. Oc. S, obj. 2 in. lig. 2. 5th foot, 9. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. fig. 3. Whole animal, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. -1 in. „ lig. I. 5th pair of feet, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. \ in. „ tig. 5. 2nd pair of feet, 9 • Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. anlarcticiis, fig. C>. 9 > whole animal. Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. si mil i*. PLATE IV. fig. 1. 9 , whole animal. Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. fig. 2. 9 , 1st foot. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. fig. 3. 9 , 2nd foot. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. liir. I. 9- abdomen ami genital segment. Oe. :',. obj. 2 in. lig. •">. 9 . abdomen and ircnital segment. Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. fig. i;. 9 , abdomen, lateral view. Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. P 2 46 R. NORRIS WOLFENDEN. Stffhus lonyipes, PLATE V. fig. 1. Whole animal, $. fig. 2. Whole animal, 9 . fig. 3. Whole animal, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. £ in. Oc. 3, obj. | in. Oc. 3, obj. \ in. antard'icum, fig. 4. Whole animal, 9 • Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. „ fig. 5. Whole animal, 9 , dorsal. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. fig. 6. 5th feet, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. i in. figs. 7, 8. 5th feet, <$ . Oc. 3, obj. i in. Paralabidocera hodgsoni, fig. 1. fig. 2. fig- 3. .) » fig- 4. fig. 5. fig- 6. „ „ fig- 7. fig- 8. fig- 9- PLATE VI. 9 , last thoracic segment and abdomen. Oc. 3, obj. -i in. Whole animal, 9 • Oc. 3, obj. -i in. 5th foot, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. J in. 4th foot, 9 i exopodite. Oc. 3, obj. i in. 1st foot, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. \ in. 2nd foot, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. £ in. Posterior antennas, 9 • Oc. 3, obj. \ in. Maxilla, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. \ in. Mandible, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. \ in. fig. 10. Anterior foot-jaw, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. \ in. fig. 11. Terminal lobes of post-footjaw, 9 • Oc. 3, obj. \ in. fig. 12. Whole animal, $ . Oc. 3, obj. ^ in. fig. 13. 5th feet, 9 . Oc. 3, obj. K in. PLATE VII. Xantlioi'iiliiinix magnits, fig. 1. Whole animal. Oc. 3, obj. 2 in. „ „ fig. 2. Rostrum. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. „ ,. fig. 3. Posterior foot-jaw. Oc. 3, obj. I in. „ „ fig. 4. Anterior foot-jaw. Oc. 3, obj. 5 in. „ „ fig. 5. Posterior antenna. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. „ „ fig. 6. Maxilla. Oc. 3, obj. i in. „ „ fig. 7. 1st foot. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. „ „ fig. 8. 2nd foot. Oc. 3, obj. 1 in. „ „ fig. 9. 5th foot. Oc. 3, obj. i in. „ antarcticus, fig. 10. 5th foot. Oc. 3, obj. £ in. „ ,, fig. 11. Posterior foot-jaw. Oc. 3, obj. i in. Antarctic (Discovery i Exp. Marion I y )1. III. Haloptilus ocellatus Metndia princeps (3 — 5). Gaetanus antarcticus • ; . \iit.n Disci '\viy) K\p. •poda pi. IV. Kuchaeta similis (i ,, antarctica 15, '>) Antarctic (Discovery) K\]>. .i pi. V. lon^ipes (i — -j). antarcticum (.(— s) Antarctic (Discovery) Kxp. .l [ll. VI. 1'aralabidocera. Antarctic ( Discovery) K\p. -.1111.1 pi. \ 11. Xanthocalanus magnus (1—9). antarcticus (10, 1 1) ECHINODERMA. I. By F. JEFFREY BELL, M.A. Emeritus Professor and Fellow of King's College (University of London}. (5 Plates.) HAD it not been for the earlier return of the 'Gauss,' this report would probably have had the distinction of signalising the re-discovery of the interesting Criuoid genus, Promaekocrinus, which, as its name denotes, was one of the prizes of the voyage of the ' Challenger.' As in the collection of the ' Southern Cross,' 1 am again able to call attention to .some remarkable variations within what are obviously the limits of single species. The specimens which exhibit these variations could not have been obtained but by very careful collecting, and in the case of CtjCethm it is of importance to note that they were all taken in a comparatively small area; the examples of this genus received by two naturalists, who made a number of species with them, were all taken from stations comparatively close to one another,* but it is to be hoped that such a course will never be taken again ; evidence as to the variability of species of Echinoderms is now beyond question. A.-ANACTINOGONIDIATA. I. HOLOTIIURI01DEA. The collection of Holothurians is small, and the points of greatest interest are revealed by Prof. MacBridc and Mr. Simpson in their valuable report on the larvae, which follows this memoir. CHHUDOTA. I submitted an example of a form taken at 100 fins., <>!!' Coulman lsl;md, to Prof. Lud wig, who has made Antarctic Synaptids one of his special domains. Owing, apparently, to the unfortunate use of formol the spiculrs are so disintegrated that ;i definite judgment is impossible, but it seems probable that, the species is (_'. j>ixtti/ii or allied thereto. * It is true that C. simplrjc was fnmnl ;it Triniilail Channel, and the 'Challenger' specimens on the eastern side of Patagonia ; but he who will look at a map of South America will smile at a " Chorological Synopsis of the species " which gives three to the Atlantic and one to the Pacific. F. JEFFREY BELL. CUCDMARIA CROCEA. Holothvriit- (t'lii'umctriii) crncpa, Lesson, Cent. Zool. (18:i2), p. 153, pi. lii. fig. 1. Cucumariii rruirn.,* Ludwig, Hamb. Magalh. Sammelreise, Holothurien (1S98), p. 15 iliiiji"1 ntnln. In the succeeding memoir by Prof. MacBride and Mr. Simpson there will be found an interesting account of the brood-pouches and young of this form. It was taken at Coulman Island, 100 fins., and on various dates at Winter Quarters down to 41 fms. . CUCUMARIA LAEVIGATA. PentacMla laorigata, Yen-ill, Bull. U.S. Nat. Mns. i. 3 (1876), p. 76. Cucummia latvigata, Ludwig, op. eit., p. 32 ibique citata. The characters of these two species have been fully discussed by Prof. Ludwig, and it is quite unnecessary for me to enter again on the subject. Taken in AViuter Quarters to 41 fms. and in McMurdo Bay. Several distorted Cucumariae and some young were taken at various dates while at Winter Quarters, and at 78° 25' 40" S., 185° 39' 06" E. PsEUDOPSOLUS FERRARI. (Plate V., fig. 3.) It is unfortunate that this new species should be represented by a single specimen only, but there is no doubt that it is unlike any form that has as yet been described. Tentacles ten, two much smaller than the rest ; trivial pedicels in three complete longitudinal series ; dorsal perisome devoid of large scales or grains, flexible and soft to the touch, and having only a few trellis-like spicules. There are some distinct pedicels scattered on the dorsal surface. 73 mm. long, 32 '5 mm. greatest width. The important differences between this species and the only form belonging to the genus which has yet been described are of varying value ; the distinctness of the dorsal pedicels is of great significance, for their presence in P. macquariensis is so inconspicuous that Prof. Deudy denied their existence, on which Prof. Ludwig has remarked " Zu eiuer Entschuldiguug will ich aber gleich hinzufiigen, dass die dorsalen Fiisschen sehr gering an Zahl und sehr retraktil sind, sodass sie sich der Beobachtung leicht entziehen konnen." f The spicules are more delicate and trellis-like in the new species, and there is a * In my ' Southern Cross ' Report I cite Wyv. Thomson as the first author of the combination '• Cucumaria crocea" ; he wrote Cladoilncfi/Jn crocca in 1876 (not 1878, and not on p. 55) ; as all my blunders were made by Dr. Lamport in his " Seewalzen," I stand convicted of neglecting the legendary advice of the venerable gentleman who was once President of my College at Oxford. t Hamburger Magalh. Sammelreise Holothurien (1898). p. 49. ECIIINODERMA. very considerable difference in size. As there is but a single specimen, I thought the question whether or no it is hermaphrodite might be left over for the present. The only suggestion that I have to make is that Prof. Ludwig's definition of the genus (<>p. cit., p. 50) should be altered by the omission of the words " Sehr wenigen," as applied to the dorsal " Fiisschen." As the type of the genus came from Macquarie Island, the two are not widely separated ; no information is given as to the depth of the more northern species ; the Antarctic form was taken at 20 fins., while at Winter Quarters. THYONE sp. A young specimen was taken off Cape Adare. MESOTHURIA MAGELLAN:. Iliilitliiii-iii HKii/fUitiii, Ludwig, Ber. Oberbess. (k-s. xxii. (1883), p. 17">. Mi'fiithnria niui/clltmi, Oustenrren, Festskrift fOr Lilljeborg (18%), p. 350; Ludwig, Ergebn. Hamburg. •Summelreise Holotbur. (1898), p. 8. Two much-injured specimens are assigned to this species ; I was unable to find spicules, but I do not always expect to find specimens taken out of ice-cold water and from 100 fms. equal to the best products of the laboratories of Naples or Plymouth. Coulman Island, 100 fms. B -ACTINOGONIDIATA . II. CRINOIDEA. ('OMATULIDAE. PROMACHOCRINUS KERGUELENKNSIS. (Plate I.) frergueletisis, P. H. Carpenter, Proc. Roy. Soc. xxviii. (1870), p. 385. This is certainly one of the most interesting finds of the ' Discovery,' for the genus was, till the German South Polar Expedition brought back specimens, only known from the collections of the ' Challenger,' which found two species in the Southern Seas, and one a few degrees north of the Equator. The only addition to our knowledge since Dr. Carpenter's report has been the note by Dr. Minckert of Greifswald,* while Dr. Bather lias suggested that it may be a " permanent meristic variation.''! I give a figure * Zool. Anzeig. xxviii. (1905), p. 490. t Treatise on Zoology iii. (1900), p. 195. 4 P. JEFFREY BELL. of a self-dissected specimen which is, I think, clearer and more illuminating than the originals of the ' Challenger ' report. It would be of particular interest to discover fossil examples of this ten-rayed form ; at present, all we can say as to the " permanency " of the form is that it has endured for thirty years ; as to the polyphyletic origin of the genus which Dr. Bather suggests,* we can only say that we have only such data as are given by the distribution of the genus. Though Dr. Minckert had made two genera, he has not contributed to the elucidation of Dr. Bather's suggestion. Taken at East end of Barrier, 100 fms. ; off Coulman Island, 100 fms. ; and at Winter Quarters. ANTEDON ADRIAN:. (Plate II.) This new species is represented by a number of specimens ; as I have already named a member of the genus A. wilsoni, I take the specific name from the second Christian name of Mr. E. A. Wilson, M.B., surgeon and naturalist to the Expedition. It was taken at various depths, down to 130 fms., at Winter Quarters, and at 500 fms. off Mts. Erebus and Terror. At first sight this species does not recall the northern A. eschrichti, but it shows, on analysis, some striking points of resemblance — the shape of the ceutrodorsal, the length (but not the number of the cirri), and the shapes of their joints, as well as the form of the first brachial ; but what distinguishes the creature from all Antedons known to me is the saw -like appearance of the arms when viewed from the side, and well shown in the figure ; this is due to the presence of a well-marked square protuberance on the dorsal face of most of the arm -joints. Arms ten, ceutrodorsal semicircular, with three rows of cirri ; these are from 50-60 in number, may be 60 mm. long, and may have as many as 60 joints ; the axillary has a prominent knob, and the outer edge of the first brachial is twice as long as the inner ; the arm-joints are stout, laterally compressed, and nearly all have one or two dorsal spiuous processes ; syzygies are extraordinarily rare in the proximal part of the arm, where, too, the pinnules are rather short ; further out they are better developed. No specimen is anything like perfect. ANTEDON ANTARCTICA. Antedon antarctica, P. H. Carpenter, Chall. Rep. Comatulae (1888), p. 144. I have compared a single specimen taken at Winter Quarters with those collected by the ' Challenger ' at Heard Island, and have no doubt of their identity. Some young specimens, which appear to belong to this species, were also taken. * Treatise on Zoology iii. (1900), p. 195. BCHINODBEMA. 5 ITT. ECHINOIDEA. ClDARIDAE. ClDARIS CANALICULATA. Temnui'/il/ir/s cfi/uilici/h/t/r, A. A^assiz, Bull. M.C.Z. i. (1863), p. 1*. tociiliiri* canaticulata, <<>. IVv. Krhin. i 1*7.';, p. 131 ; Wyv. Thomson, Journ. Linn. Soc. xiii. (1876), p. r..r> ; Lovt'ii, Bib. Svrask. Akad. Hillg. xiii. iv., 1. p. it ; Agass., Mom. M.C.Z. xxxi. (1904- ), p. 4. x ( Duroritlarix) i-iiiin/ii'////i/ii, Doderlein, Jap. Secigel, i. (18x7), p. 10. i* canaliculate, Mcissnur, Ergebn. Hainb. Miigalh. SainnielreisL-, v. (190u), ]., p. :; //. 1 >r. Meissner lias suggested that J. negleeta, which I described at tlie same lime as A. ftninilfl, is the same species. I think he is right; A belli of Prof. Studer and ^.4. glomerata of Sluden appear to be also synonymous ; with regard to the first three Prof. Perrier suggested the same view in 1891. My species were described on pp. 91 and 94 of the Proc. Zool. Soc. for 1881 ; Dr. Meissner's synonymy will be found on p. 7 of tlie Ergeb. Hamburg Magalluui. Sammelreise, Lief. vii. (1904). I suggested in the report on the 'Southern Cross' collections (p. 215) that the species was circumpolar in its distribution, and so it certainly is. A large number of specimens were collected; the largest, from 4-10 fins. McMurdo Bay, was the " mother of a number of young after capture" * ; and some other large specimens were taken at No. 3 hole, and some smaller at No. 11. Flagon Point (10-20 fms.), Cape Wadsworth, and Hut Point also yielded examples ; the lar-je examples marked 4H and 49 are only said to be from Winter Quarters. From 100 fms. (East end of Barrier) and 130 fms. (X<>. 2) specimens were collected which, but for the formidable synonymy of the species. 1 should be inclined (o regard as distinct. ASTERIAS L< >.\<;STAFFI. This line >pecies is represented bv a single specimen, which presents well-marked features. 1 name it after the generous friend of science whose contribution to tin- funds of the Royal Geographical Society made the vovage of the 'Discover.- possible. A large stout form with A' about equal to I! /• ; the whole of the dorsal surface i- uuiformly and densely covered with paxilliform spines of some size. The madreporite is of moderate size ; the podia are enormous, the adambulacral spines are loni;. cylindrical, blunt at the tip, so irregularly set that it is ditlicult to say whether then- are two or three rows : beyond them there are shorter and more delicate, but otherwise similar cylindrical spines verv doselv set; there are two tjuitc well-marked fets of marginal plates; the inferomarginals are very narrow in the an^le of the arm, while the superomarginals in the same region are verv .-hort ; both sets are covered with coarse granules, among which no pediccllariae are to be detected. The podia within the oral circlet are of enormous si/e. If = 210 ; /• = 70. \V.(V>. : 10-20 fms. As there is only a single specimen, no comparisons are possible; but it muv be ' These luivc IHTII in:uli- tin- -uliji-ct ..1 ;ui iiitcivstin^ separate iv[»>it \<\ I'mf. M;i.-]Hiili' and Mr. •'. ('. Simpson. F. JEFFKBY BELL. pointed out that the closely packed arrangement of the podia, and the distinctness of the two rows of marginal plates are, on Mr. Sladen's basis of classification of Starfishes, mutually destructive ; but the well-known observations of Prof. Ludwig on Echinaster sepositus justify us in supposing that we have here a case of retarded disappearance of the marginals ; the crowding of the podia appears to lie a much more important morphological character ; but the union of these two strikes, I think, a final blow at the current classification, against which Prof. Ludwig has already raised his voice, and the adoption of which by MM. Delage and Herouard in their " Zoologie Concrete " came as a great surprise to me. HEURESASTER* HODGSON i. (Plate III.) Two specimens of a very fine starfish were taken at about 25 fathoms while in Winter Quarters ; they appear to me to form the type of a new genus, as to the general position of which there can be little doubt ; a still larger specimen was taken from McMurdo Bay at 2 fms. It has somewhat the appearance of Porania, but has, in the larger examples, spines in the interambulacral actinal areas. Prof. Perrier defines the Poraniidae as follows : " Squelette masque par les teguments ; margiuales apparentes, mais formant au corps uu bord tranchant ; squelette ventral forme de se'ries de plaques allant de chaque adambulacraire a une marginale, squelette dorsal reticule." I have invented for it a name which will remind the student both of the name of the ship, and of its indefatigable biologist. The larger specimens may be thus described : Arms long, tapering to a rather fine point, R is about = 3. The upper surface is smooth and soft to the touch, and has papulae, in ill-defined areas, spread over the whole of it ; the edge is quite sharp, forming almost a ledge, and made up by a large number of small supero- and infero- marginals. The lower interambulacra covered with some eight rows of small regularly set plates covered with rather coarse granules, and, in the angle, with short spines which give a hairy appearance to these areas. The ambulacral groove is bounded by rows of four or five spines, of which the outermost is small and the innermost spatulate and fluted at its free end. The podia are stout. At each oral angle there is a huge spine, the distal third of which is glossy. These specimens are flat, but the smallest example has the disc arched, and this is probably more natural— R = 200 r = 70. R = 130 r = 50. R = 90 r = 30. Accepting Prof. Perrier's family diagnosis of the Poraniidae, we may make the generic diagnosis of Heuresaster: Abactinal surface only invested by integument, discovery. BCHINODBBMA. '.' margin very .sharp, the inner actinal ambulacralfl with spines, the oral angle provided with a large spine. While the specific characters would appear to be that the longer radius is more than twice as long as the shorter radius, the marginal plates are MTV numerous, and the innermost ambulacra] spine is spatulate and fluted at its free end. The smallest specimen has not quite acquired the generic characters of the larger; the abactinal integument is not so thick as to altogether hide the superficial granules, and the granules on the actinal interambulacra have not developed into spines, so that there is no marked difference between the outer and the inner parts of these areas. PEXTAGONASTER INCERITS. The single small specimen, is, I think, an ally of the Australian species of Penta- gonaster (sens, lat.}, but the arms are proportionately longer than they generally are in this genus ; it is, possiblv, an immature specimen in which R would gradually increase in proportion to r. If it should prove to be an adult, its proportions mav be compared to those of P. duebeni and P. ) p. ->\->. (Hitarctii'iix, Sladen, n/>. fit. p. 190. I must own to some temerity in associating a specimen in which R = 212 and r = 58 with a species whose type had Li = 38 and r = 12 '5, and a representative of which, hardly much larger, was found to be bearing young; but even the most recent writers on Echinoderms have not yet promulgated the. doctrine that difference in size is a specific character, though I am not quite sure that in practice they do not sometimes act as though they had. However, one has only to get a clear idea of the essential characters of this genus to feel sure that one lias it here ; as to specific characters, it is first to be said that most of the L. kerguelpnensis material is badly preserved, while the condition of L. niifdrrticus is particularly good. Though the differences between the two species appear, from Mr. Sladen's lengthy description, to be considerable, it will, I think, be found on examination of the specimens preserved in the Museum, that L. jiliio:ona inermis, Bell, Rep. 'Southern Cross' (1902), p. 217. This species, which was not well represented in the earlier collections, was found on numerous dates during the stay of the ' Discovery ' at Winter Quarters. It exhibits a very wide range of variation, so great indeed as to have been at first quite bewildering ; and it may be noted that Mr. Hodgson did not recognise any of them as belonging to an already known Antarctic form. In the ' Southern Cross ' report I figured some of the remarkable variations in the arrangement of the plates of the dorsal surface of the disc of Ophiosteira antarctica ; a similar, but less striking, variation obtains in this Ophiozona. In 0. antarctica I described the serrated and keeled appearance of the upper surface of the arm ; this is to be seen also in some examples of 0. inermis. The most striking differences are to be seen in the height of the disc, and the size of the so-called radial shields ; so that it is by no means always true that the shields are inconspicuous. Winter Quarters, 10-178 fins, (various dates) ; MacMurdo Bay, 96-120 fms. ; East end of Barrier, 100 fms. ; off Barrier, 300 fms. ; Coalman Island, 100 fms. In some specimens the dorsal plates of the disc are deeply incised ; this appears to be due to want of sufficient calcareous matter, but as others are infested by a sponge it is possible that it is the cause. Ol'HIOSTEIRA ANTARCTICA. (Plate V., fig. 2.) (>l'liinsteira antarctica, Bell, Rep. ' Southern Cross' (1002), p. 218. It appears that the ' Southern Cross ' did not exhaust the variations in the disc plates of this wonderful species ; the upstanding plates shown in Plate V., fig. 2, are worthy of record, and it may be noted that the single arm left to this disc has the dorsal serration extremely well marked. ECHIXODERMA. 13 In the original diagnosis of the genus I spoke of " a large keel-like plate on the disc, which completely overshadows the radial shields," although I was aware of and figured (Plate XXVI., fig. 3) an angle of the disc in which there appeared to lie two large radial shields ; in this case, however, three of the angles of the disc conform exactly to the diagnosis. I have now before me a specimen in which all five angles have a pair of plates. Were it not for the ' Southern Cross ' specimens it would not be possible to put this specimen with the genus Ophiosteira at all. When we are asked whether " specific characters are useful,'7 we may retort that generic characters even are not always constant. AVinter Quarters, 13 fms. Coulman Island, 100 fins. OPHIONOTUS VICTORIAE. Oji/iiniiotiix rii'/nridf, Bell, Rep. 'Southern Cross' (1902) p. 210. This species was not so abundant; it was taken off the Barrier at 300 fms., near Franklin Island, and from 254 fms. at an unrecorded locality. OPHIACANTHA IMAGO. 'i/i/tiacantha imago, Lyman, ' Chall.' Rep. Ophiur. (1882), p. 18i; i/>iq//i' ,-ilahnn. I hope I am right in referring to this species specimens from Winter Quarters, 30 fms. ; Hut Point, 77° 12' 12" S., 167° 27' W., 77° 50' 30" S., 165° 40' K, 100 fms. ; but, in sooth, some of the ' Challenger ' types of Ophiuroids are hardly mature. OPHIACANTHA VIVIPARA. Ophi«i'i>l. lid. vii. il'.HMi. |>. 684. VOL. iv. K 14 F. JEFFBEY BELL. The single* six-armed specimen taken by the 'Discovery' at 8-15 fms. off Cape Wadsworth is a good deal stouter than Ljungman's types, but I can see no reason for making it a new species ; the arms of the young may be seen projecting from some of the bursae. OPHIACANTHA COSMICA. Ophiacantha cosmica, Lyman, Cball. Rep. Oplriur. (1882), p. 194 ibi^ue citatum. This widely spread species was taken on various occasions, but many of the specimens have been marked by me " immature " ; in connection with this I should like to quote some words of Mr. Lyman : " The specimen just described is unusually large for this division of the genus, which leads me to think that the bulk of those now known are immature, and therefore to be treated with all the more caution." Winter Quarters. Off Coulman Island, 100 fms. Off Barrier, 300 fms. OPHIOCONIS ANTARCTICA. Ophioconis antan'tita, Lyman, Chall. Eep. Ophiur. (1882), p. 107 ibiqite citatum. If I have correctly determined some specimens from Winter Quarters, the types of Mr. Lyman 's are very far from reaching the size to which this form attains. AMPHIURA BELGICAE. i Amphiura belyicae, Koehlcr, Res. Voy. 'Belgica' (1901), p. 27. The Antarctic area appears to be the home of large specimens of Amphiura ; not only did the ' Discovery ' bring home several examples of what appear to be the species obtained by the ' Belgica,' but there is a single specimen off the Barrier at 301 fms., which has a disc diameter of 18 mm.,f and which can hardly, I think, be the fully adult example of the somewhat smaller specimens ; but, as it is solitary, I hesitate to regard it as an undescribed species. Several specimens of A. belc/icae were taken at Cape Wadsworth, 8 to 15 fms., and off the Barrier at 300 fms. ; the latter is, as already said, the locality of the single larger form. Like Solaster octoradiatus, A. belgicae is probably a circumpolar species. YOUNG OPHIURID. (Plate IV.) I give some figures of a remarkable Ophiuroid, to which it is very difficult to assign a systematic place ; it appears to be a young form in which some of the arm- plates are still not consolidated. The exceedingly large size of the bursal slits is perhaps only due to the mode of preservation. Two specimens, both broken, were taken in Winter Quarters on 2. 1. 04, and two off Barrier. * As there is but a single specimen this collection throws no critical light on Prof. Koehler's just-made suggestion that this species exhibits sexual limorphism ; cf. Bull. Sci. France xli. (1907), p. 322. t That is exactly the same as the disk diameter of A. magnified; of which Prof. Koehler has lately published a brief diagnosis. See Xool. Anz. xxxii., p. 146 (17 Sept. 1907), but the species is not the same. ECHIXODERMA. 15 AsTIHiToMA A6ASSIZI. Astrotoma agassizii, Lyman, 111. Catal. Mus. C. Z. No. viii. II. (1*75), p. 24. Mr. Lyman calls attention to the coarse granulation on his single specimen, which came from the Straits of Magellan ; the series now collected shows that the granulation may be more or less obscured by thick skin. It is remarkable that the species was not collected by the ' Gauss.' McMurdo Bay, 9G-120 fms. Specimens from off Coulman Island, and from 77° 12' S., 1G7° 27' E., 2 fms. seem to be sufficiently different to lie regarded as varieties. R 2 16 F. JEFFREY BELL. DESCRIPTION OF PLATES. ECHINODERMA. PLATE I. Promacorhrinus Jcerguehnensis. FIG. 1. — Disc and base of arms from the side to show the insertion of the cirri, and the form of the cirrus pit, and the shape of the disc, x 2. FIG. 2. — Disc and base of arms from below ; the central boss is more distinctly seen than in fig. 1. x n. FIG. 3. — An arm from the side, x 3 ; the roughened edges of the joints are well seen in this figure ; the proximal pinnules only are completely shown. PLATE II. Antedon adriani. General view of this Crinoid. x 2. PLATE III. Heuresasfer hodgsoni. X not quite f, seen from below, to show the breadth of the ambulacra! grooves, their size and arrangement. PLATE IV. The young Ophiurid (see p. 14). FIG. 1. — Aboral view of disc and arm. x f. FIG. 2. — Oral view of same. X f . FIG. 3. — View of mouth to show arrangement of the oral and adjacent plates, x 8. FIG. 4. — 1st, 2nd, and 3rd upper arm-plates, x 10. FIG. 5. — View of arm from above, at about its middle, x 10. FIG. 6. — 1st, 2nd, and 3rd lower arm-plates, x 10. FIG. 7. — View of arm from below at about its middle, x 10. PLATE V. FIG. la. — Variety of Cycethra (see p. 10) from above ; fig. Ib from below ; both slightly reduced. FIG. 2a. — Disc of an Ophiosteira (see p. 12), magnified to show keel-like plates ; 2a, seen from above ; 2b, seen from the side. FIG. 3. — Pseudopsolus f&rrari. x ?,. Antarctic (Discovery) Exp. Echinoderma pi. I. l>.TJ>'au del. Ituttcrworth. ST. -•-• Antarctic ( Discover)') I'.xp. Echinoderma pi. II. lierjeau. del. Batlerworth, so. A Antarctic (Discovery) Exp. Echinoderma pi. III. ' del I Illtll \\orth. BC. Antarctic (Discovery) K\p. Echinodenna pi. \\ . HtterrtOl th BC \a -•* '- > * Antarctic (Discovery) Exp. n iderma pi. V. Tcrzl, del. Huth. del. Buttervvorlh.se. ECHINODEEMA. IL-ECHINODEBM LAEV^E. By E. W. MACBRIDE, M.A., D.Sc., F.R.S., Professor of Zoology, McGill University; and J. C. SIMPSON, B.Sc., Demonstrator of Zoology, McGill University. (1 Plate.) THE collection of larval Echinodenns brought back by the National Antarctic Expedition, when received by us from the authorities of the British Museum, was found to consist of forty tubes of material collected during the years 1902-1904. Of these forty tubes, however, by far the greater number contain nothing but early segmenting eggs showing no distinctive features ; the present paper is, therefore, in reality based upon the contents of eight tubes only. A preliminary examination showed that, though the collection contained but four species of Echinoderms, these differ widely from one another, there being one representative of each of the four great classes of the sub-phylum Eleutherozoa. These four species are: Asterias brandti Bell, Cucurnaria crown Lesson, a new Echim>- pluh'ii*, and an Ophiopluteus which may also be new. At first sight the Asterias seemed to promise much, for there were two tubes containing a couple of hundred specimens which had been born after the capture of the mother. More careful examination, however, disclosed the fact that they were all of approximately the same age, only two closely related developmental stages being represented. In the case of the Cucumarin, besides a number of new-born young, the collection contained an adult female which was the mother of some of them. To this specimen considerable interest attaches, from the fact that in it an unsuspected brood- pouch containing a great number of embryos was found. Of the two plutei it need only be said in this place that, since they are probably the first free-swimming Echinodenn larvae found within the Antarctic Circle, they are not without considerable importance. In the matter of preservation the material leaves much to be desired ; but when one considers the difficulties of collecting under Antarctic conditions, it could hardly be expected that this could be otherwise. Of necessity the only preservatives used were formalin and spirit, and as neither of these is at all suitable to Echinoderm larv;v, the specimens show very little histological detail. In examining the material it was found that the preservation of the plutei was such as to make sectioning useless, so they were studied /// fafn, first unstained, and then stained in eosin and mounted in balsam. This method was found to give very satisfactory results. The Asterias and Cuciinmria, however, were treated quite differently. Selected specimens of these were first carefully drawn at a magnification 2 E. w. MACBRIDE AND j. c. SIMPSON. of 12| diameters l>y the aid of the camera lucida, and then, after double imbedding in celloidin and paraffin, were cut into serial sections and stained with Delafield's hsematoxylin. In the succeeding pages the four species will be taken up and described in detail. 1. ASTERIAS BRANDTI. Asterins Irandii, Bell, P.Z.S., 1881, pp. 94 and 50C. The young of this species contained in the collection consist in a brood " born after the capture of the mother," which was taken in McMurdo Bay, February 13th, 1902. The parent was identified by Professor F. Jeffrey Bell as A. brandti, but as it was not sent with the embryos, nothing definite can be said as to its " brood-care," except that this species must now be added to the list of viviparous Asteroidea. It is probable, however, that according to the analogy of its family, the young are attached to the lips of the mother during the earlier stages of development. All the embryos of this brood are of approximately the same stage ; the difference between the youngest and oldest being simply a matter of size. The youngest is shown in Fig. 1, which gives a ventral view. It measures 2' 4 mm. from the centre of the disc to the tip of the arms, while the radius of the disc is 1 • 5 mm. (R. = 2 • 4 mm., r. = 1*5 mm.). The only external trace of the embryonic condition is in the closed mouth and the small pre-oral lobe 'or larval organ. The oldest embryo is much larger than the preceding (R. = 3 • 2 mm., r. = 1 • 6 mm.), but apart from the smaller size of the pre-oral lobe there is little difference. Internally, too, there is little difference in the development of the organs, so that they may very well be described together. As may be seen from the figure, metamorphosis is complete in these young starfish, and an examination of serial sections shows that the internal organs have nearly all attained the adult relations. As these relations are, moreover, practically the same as those in a young Asterina gibbosa of the same stage, it will only be necessary to mention here the few points which show peculiarity. In the first place it will be noticed that the great size attained before the mouth and anus are formed must be looked upon as an expression of the favourable conditions under which development of this species proceeds. Another indication of the same thing may be seen in the amount of yolk which still remains in the closed gut, and which may even be seen outside the gut in the space between its dorsal wall and the inner wall of the coelom. The pre-oral lobe (larval organ) in the oldest stage is little more than a vestige, but in the youngest its connection with the inner perihtemal ring can still be traced. The water-vascular system is well developed, and one can follow it quite easily in vertical sections. The madreporic pore, pore-canal, and stone-canal may be said to have assumed the adult relations. The axial sinus can be seen adjacent to the stone- HcnixoDERM LAKV.I:. 3 canal, and can be traced from its opening into the latter to its junction with the inner perihaemal ring. In none of the sections, however, can one be sure of the aboral sinus or of the madreporic vesicle, though this is doubtless due to the preservation. Several points in the structure of these young Asterids suggest a relation to an embryonic starfish studied in this laboratory some time ago by Dr. E. II. Henderson (4) These were large yolky eggs of an unknown species, belonging, probal.lv. to the "enus Anuteruu, collected off the Franklin Islands. In the remarkably close resemblance to the development of Aster ina gibbosa of the same age, and in the similarity in the appearance and distribution of the yolk, we have indications of a near relationship between this species and Aortas bmndti, but the great difference in age between the two lots ,,f embryos makes it difficult to institute a closer comparison. 2. OPHIOPLUTEUS sp.n. (?). (Fig. 2.) Two specimens of this presumably new Op/iinpluteus were taken at the Winter Quarters of the Expedition ; the first on December 15th, 1903, from No. 12 hole in 3 fin*. Of water; the other on January 4th, 1904, from No. 13 hole, in G fras. The first is in a comparatively good state of preservation : the second is badly disintegrated and from it alone little could be made out. It is, however, of approximated the same' stage of development, though a little larger, than the first. The following description is, therefore, based upon the better preserved specimen. The body, exclusive of the arms, measures 2' 3 mm. in length, and is marked by a strongly developed conical papilla at its posterior end. Three pairs of arms are developed ; of these the antero-laterals and post-orals are only slightly developed, but the postero-lateral pair are already equal to the body in length and are widely divergent. This development of the postero-lateral arms reminds us of the great size of the corresponding arms in the larva of Ophiothrix fragilis, which is such an early and marked characteristic of this species. In fact, tl.r whole appearance of our specimen is strongly reminiscent of the larva of Ophiothrix The ciliated band can be traced quite distinctly bordering all the arms. In our better specimen the coelom can just be made out, On the left side it has already divided into anterior and posterior cceloms, but on the ri-ht side it is still undivided. The gut is well developed and shows the characteristic division into oesophagus, large spherical stomach, and intestine opening on the ventral surface. No trace of the skeleton is preserved in these specimens, and this, together with their young stage, makes classification impossible. Judging from their habitat however, and from their general appearance, they are quite possibly examples of a new species. 4 E. w. MACBEIDE AND j. c. SIMPSON. 3. ECHINOPLUTEDS ANTAECTICUS. (Fig. 3.) The material contained only two specimens of this larva : one taken in lat. 78° 29' 10" S., long. 103° 38' 18" W., on January 25th, 1902, and labelled "30," the other marked " 42," taken in the D-net at Hut Point, near the Winter Quarters of the Expedition, on February 19th of the same year. Both specimens are of approximately the same age. In the stained and mounted condition the specimens measure 0'72 and 0'84 mm. in length, including the arms ; but in each case the body, which is sub-spherical in form, is 0'43 mm. in diameter. Four pairs of arms can be made out ; of these, the post-oral pair are the longest, being a little more than two-thirds as long as the body. Of the others, the autero- laterals are about half and the postero-dorsals about one-quarter the body-length. The pre-oral arms are very rudimentary, appearing only as small outgrowths at the bases of the antero-laterals. All the arms are close together and are approximately parallel. The ciliated band, which borders all the arms, extends back between the post-oral and postero-dorsal arms of either side, so as to form lateral bays running about half way along the body. Three pairs of epaulettes are present, and are arranged so as to form two incomplete ciliated bands encircling the body. The anterior circle consists of a ventral pair situated at the bases of the post-oral arms, and a dorsal pair in a somewhat corresponding position on the dorsal surface of the body at the bases of the postero-dorsal arms. The posterior circle is made up of a single pair only, and these are smaller and much narrower than either of the other pairs, and are laterally placed near the posterior end of the body. We find that three Echinoplutei have been described in which the presence of six ciliated epaulettes is noted. These are : E. coronatus, E. theeli, and the pluteus of Echinus csculentus. From each of these, however, the present larva differs considerably. In Echinus esculent us the presence of the posterior pair of epaulettes was first pointed out by MacBride (8), and a great deal of material of the larvae of this species has been at our disposal for comparison with our new type. Selecting an individual which, judging by the development of the so-called " Echinus-rudiment," is of the same age as our specimens of E. antarcticus, we find that the size of the characteristic larval arms is quite different. The post-oral and postero-dorsal pairs are of about the same length, and are already about twice as long as the body, instead of two-thirds and one-quarter the body-length, as they are in E. antnrcti<-ux. The antero-laterals are also of great length, being more than twice as long in comparison as are the corresponding arms in our new species. The most marked difference, however, is ECHIXODERM LARY.K. 5 in the pro-oral pair ; for while these are mere rudiments in K antarcticus, they are almost equal to the length of the body in E. esculentm. The other two larvae, E. coronatm and E. theeli, were described by Mortensen (9) The first of these is a larva of about the same or a slightly older stage than our specimens. In it, however, the post-oral and postero-dorsal arms are about one and a times as long as the body, while the antcro-laterals and pre-orals are equal to it m length. Besides this great difference in the arms there is also a difference in the posterior pair of epaulettes ; for Mortensen describes these as " very broad/' while in E. antarcticus they are much the smallest of the six. In E. t/u-i-li we are dealing with a larva which is much younger than the others mentioned, hut even here we see certain features in the arms by which to ifferentiate the two; for while three pairs of the arms are of about the same proportionate length as in our specimens of E. antarcticus, the fourth, the pre-orals, are long and well-developed, not at all resembling the mere rudiments by which they are represented in the latter species. As in the case of the Ophiopluteus, so here nothing can be made out of the skeleton, the result, probably, of the method of preservation. On the left side of the larva a well-developed " Echinus-rudiment " can be seen, but of this no details can be made out in either of the mounts. 4. CUCUMARIA CROCEA. Holothuria (Cucumariif) crocea, Lesson, Cent. Zool. (1832), p. 153, pi. Hi., fig. i. Cucumaria crocea, Lampert; Seewalzen (1885), p. 214. Our collection contains some two hundred specimens of the young of this Holothuriau, "born after the capture of the mothers," and one adult female, the parent of some of these young ; all taken at Hut Point, near tl..- Winter Quarters of the Expedition, on the 13th and 28th of February, 1904. The young of this species were first dredged by the ' Challenger ' at the Falklands in January, 1876. Since that time nothing, so far as we can learn, has been added to our knowledge of their development, and as the specimens then found were of a considerably older stage than those brought back by the ' Discovery,' it may be well to recall certain of the observations made by Sir Wyville Thomson at that time, which have a special bearing upon the developmental history. In his " Voyage of the ' Challenger,' " Sir Wyville says : " In a very large proportion of the females which I examined, young were closely parked in two continuous fringes adhering to the water-vascular feet of the dorsal ambulacrum. The young were in all the later stages of growth, and ,,f all sizes, from 5 mm. up to 40 mm. in length; but all the young attached to one female appeared to I..- of the same age and size All the young I examined were miniatures of their parents; the only marked difference was that in the young the ambulacra of the bivium were quite VOL. IV. c E. w. MACBRIDE AXD .1. c. SIMPSON. rudimentary." They " attached themselves by the tentacular feet of the trivial ambulacra, which are early and fully developed." He says, however, that they " were too late at the Falklands (January 23rd) to see the process of attachment of the young in their nursery .... There can be little doubt that, according to the analogy of the class, the eggs are impregnated either in the ovarial tube or immediately after their extrusion, that the first developmental stages are run through rapidly, and the young are passed back from the ovarial opening, which is at the side of the mouth, along the dorsal ambulacra, and arranged in their places by the automatic action of the ambulacral tentacles themselves." (Vol. II., p. 215 et seq.} Now the young brought back by the ; Discovery,' with two exceptions, all measured from 2.? mm. to 3 mm. in length, and had been born in the interval between capture and preservation ; it seems, therefore, that we had here a key to the solution of the manner in which the early developmental stages are passed over, and that we might thus get a more complete history of the " brood-care " of this species. A careful examination of the adult female specimen, made with this object in view, showed two prominent openings, each about 3 mm. in diameter, situated in the dorsal interambulacrum, a short distance behind the peristome (Fig. 4). Looking into these openings, one could see a number of embryos of about the same size as the new-born specimens of the collection. At first sight these openings seemed to lead into the body- cavity, but a careful dissection revealed the fact that they were in reality the openings of two large brood-pouches situated in the dorsal body-wall (Fig. 5). Owing to the extreme contraction of the specimen, the extent of these pouches can be made out only approximately. The right, which is by far the larger of the two, extends from the mid-dorsal line downwards to the right ventral interambulacrum, and from a point just behind the peristome backwards for about one-third of the body length. The left sac, however, is only about half as large. Both pouches are divided up by a number of pillars representing the podia, which thus seem to traverse the sacs. In reality, however, the podia are probably only surrounded by the pouches as they develop. Some idea of the extent of these spaces may Vie gained from the figure, which is drawn of the natural size. No communication was found between the two sacs, nor was any opening into the body-cavity or genital ducts made out. In these two pouches 140 embryos were found — 110 in the right and 30 in the left. These, however, are all of the same size, and of a comparatively late stage of development, with the exception of two specimens which are much less developed than the rest. Through the kindness of Professor F. Jeffrey Bell we have also been able to examine three other specimens of C. crocea belonging to the British Museum. It was hoped that they might show some trace of these brood-pouches, but the most careful search revealed nothing. If we now try, from the facts before us, to get a connected idea of the " maternal care " of this species, we shall probably find that its course is somewhat as follows :— ECHINODERM LAKV.K. 7 The eggs, either before or after fertilization, are shed into the water and are attached to the mother's back, possibly by means of a mucoid secretion. They are soon, however, surrounded by the brood-pouches, which probably develop by a sinking-in of the dorsal ectoderm, and here they are retained until they have readied a condition where the tentacles are able to serve as organs of attachment to the mother. This we know must be when the little animals are between 3 mm. and 5 mm. in length. They then pass out of the brood-pouches and are arranged along the dorsal ambulacra of the mother as Thomson has described. The presence in the sacs, among a large number of older embryos, of two which are comparatively young, naturally brings up the question of the number of broods in this species. Are all of the young brought forth in a single brood, or is there a succession of broods such as we find in Si/ixiptn r/r/jinni, Clark (3) ? If these two embryos represented the beginning of a second and younger brood, one would expect to find the gonad of the mother showing some sign of activity ; but, as this is not the case, we must conclude that they are members of the same brood as the larger embryos, and that their development has been, for some reason or other, retarded. What evidence we have, therefore, seems to be in accord with Thomson's observation that all the young attached to one mother were of the same age and size. Coming now to the embryos themselves, it is somewhat disappointing to find that among the large number brought back only two stages are represented. Turning our attention to the younger of these, we see that of the two specimens in the collection one was somewhat distorted through the pressure of the surrounding embryos in the brood-pouch ; but this does not at all affect the disposition of the internal organs as seen in sections. The other specimen, apparently quite normal, is oval in form, and measured before sectioning 1 • 8 by 1*2 mm. No evidence of any external opening could be made out. When sections of this stage are examined it is seen to be a typical pentactula, and the only points which need be specially mentioned are in connection with the water- vascular system. The ring canal is well developed, and the radial canals coming off from it can easily be followed as they arch back and run towards the aboral pole. As yet there is no sign of the development of podia, but the tentacular canals can be seen to originate one on either side of each radial canal, close to where it comes off from the ring canal, and to run out into the tentacles which do not reach the surface of the embryo, but still project into the "atrium.' Even at this stage valves may be seen guarding the entrance to these tentacular canals. The stone-canal is well formed, and runs out in the dorsal inter-radius to open into a large, clearly-defined axial sinus. From the latter the pore-canal can be traced outwards for a short distance, but we were not able to follow it to its external opening in this stage, though in the older embryos it is very easily followed. No Polian vesicle has yet been developed. Of the later stage there were a great number of specimens, for it was found that all the embryos in the brood-pouches (with the exception of the two ahvadv mentioned), s -.: E. W. MAcBRIDE AND J. C. SIMPSON. and a second brood dredged a fortnight later, are of approximately identical development. These embryos all measure from 2' 5 to 3 mm. in length, and have assumed the typical ten-teutacled form. The tentacles are still simple, unbranched, peg-like outgrowths (Fig. G), but there is some slight indication of a differentiation in size, the two ventral tentacles being just a shade smaller than the rest. In sections the digestive tract is seen to be well developed, though the oesophagus is still solid, and the anus has not yet been formed. The stomach walls are thrown into heavy folds and the intestine shows the characteristic double twist. The water-vascular system in this stage shows many advances. The pore-canal can be distinctly seen to open to the outside, and can be traced into the axial sinus, which runs for a short distance in the body-wall before it communicates with the stone- canal. The presence in Holothuriaus of an axial sinus opening, on the one hand, into the stone-canal, and on the other to the outside by means of the pore-canal, has been described in two cases only — once by Bury (2) and once by Ludwig (6). As Bury's observation, however, has been very generally questioned, and as Ludwig, though noting the presence of these structures, does not attach any very great weight to them, the present discovery becomes of extreme interest and importance, as a confirmation which places the matter beyond doubt. As has been noted above, in the younger embryos the pore-canal cannot be traced throughout its whole length, but this is in all probability due to bad preservation. A large Polian vesicle is now seen in the left dorsal interradius, a position which Ludwig (5) says it occupies in some Cucumariae, though he does not mention C. crocea. Tube feet have made their appearance, and we now find four arising from each radial canal, though they have not as yet reached the surface. The state of the preservation prevents any very minute study of the nervous system, but one can readily see the well-developed nerve-ring and the five radial nerves, as well as the branches to the tentacles. The epi-neural ring and canals are also clearly seen, and we find that the ring also gives off branches which accompany the tentacular nerves. Of the condition of the mesenteries little can be made out. A bunch of cells in the dorsal mesentery close to the stone-canal may very possibly be the rudimentary gonad, but of these points it is impossible to be sure. In conclusion, it may be said that the collection, though small, has yielded many interesting points. Chief among these may be mentioned the discovery of two pelagic Echinoderm larvse within the Antarctic Circle, and of the brood-pouch in Cucumaria crocea. The first are important because they disprove the generally accepted theory that none of the Antarctic Echinoderms have free-swimming larvoe, the second because it fills a gap in our knowledge of the life-history of a well-known form. The well-marked axial sinus and pore-canal in the Cucumaria embryo is also ECMiXODEKM LAKV.H. a point of importance, since it gives positive evidence of the existence of these structures among the Cucunmm.Uu, a fact which has been asserted, hut never conclusively proven. Zoological Laboratory, MeGill University, April 1st, I!>o7. LIST OF PAPERS QUOTED. 1. DELI..^ J.--" E rhinoderms " in K,port on the collections of the ' Southern Cross," London, 1902, 2. IJniY, II.-" Studies in the Embryology of the ly:hinodmns." Q.J. Micros. Sri Vol 29 fi8891 It- »09-44'J. 3. CI.AKK, II. L-«Synapta vivipara : a contribution to the morphology of Erhiuodermata," Boston Memoirs Soc. Nat. Hist., 5 (mis), pp. ;,;;_«*, 5 pls. 4. HKXI.ERSON E. H --"Some observations on the development of an Asterid with large yolky eg** from the Franklin Islands," Ann. Ma- Xat. Hist, vol. 10 (I'll,;,) s, •> M., * Abth., 6. Lu™.-"Zur Entwicklnngsgeschichte dcr Holothurien." Sitzuugsber. JVenss. Akad. d. \Viss. Jt>erliD, 1^91^ p. do;j. -m W-"Devel°Pment of Astt'rina t'il'bosa." Q.J. Micros. St-i., vol. 38 (1896), - 8. MAC_BHI,,E E W- -••The Development of Echinoids," pt. l. -The larva, of Echinus miliuris and E. esculentus." Q.J. Micros. Sci., vol. 4i> (1801)), pp. 835-S8M 9. MOETENSE-N, Tii " Die Echinodermenlarven der Plankton-Expedition d. Ilnmboldt-Stiftung " iW. II. J., Kiel and Leipzig, 18'J8. 10. THOMSON, C. WYVILLK.-" The Voyage of the Challenger-the Atlantic," London, 1x77. TABLE OF PLATES. FIG. 1. Astern bramHi liell. x U>i. Youngest einl^ryo of brood. ilG. 2. Oplnuplufrtis sp. n. ? x 100. FIG. 3. Eehmopluteus mitim-tii-iia sp. n. x 100. ' '™«M™ crocea Lesson, x 1. Adult female, showing openings of the two brood-pouches. •MTb MiM Lesson. < 1. Another view of the same specimen, with the body-wait cut thiough so as to expose the interior of the brood-pouches Fl%Lnl:t:r; ;:;;"Lcsso"' x 15'- YM» emb^ *- •"- •*« «• <"<• «*-. «-^b » F'°'i I""""""" '""" LeSSO°' T'«™«««e «««<» through the a,,tc.,i,,r region of eml.rjo Ao.vn in Preoral Lobe - -f FlG.I. ASTERIAS BRANOTI. Youngest efnbr^yo of brood Fie 2 OPHIOPLUTEUS N SP 7 K/00 Openings of ' Brood pouches Position of openings *>„ shown in> Fiy 4. .-Left Broad-pouch Riaht Brand-pouch FlG 3. ECMINOPLUTtUS ANTARC1I X 1(10 Ventral Tentacles. FIG 5. CUCUMARIA CROCEA Adult female — to show interior of brood -pouches. x/ ' . }', ',l~ru 7 Fic 4 CUCUMARIA CROCEA Adult female— to show openings of brood-pouches, x 7. Part Can n I , Axial Sin it * . ^<" Polian. Vesicle - FIG 6. CUCUMARIA CROCEA. Young embryo born after capture of mother x IZi. ' ' Ring Canal " IE soph a y FIG.?. CUCUMARIA CROCEA Transverse section through anterior region of embryo shown in Fig 6 To be bound with plalr. [..irval l-icliiiioderius. Antarctic (Discovery) Exp eu3TUJ90IH=)0 S Oil OOXx .ITQHAH8 booid >o o^idms *"•*-,« A3000D AlHAMUOllO _3|6nri9> >o A330HO AIRAMUOUD .6 m >o n A30000 AIHAMUOUO .3 mod >o A3DOSO 0 noigsn loiiaJnt .6gi1 nj nworla uniiloil Icvit.1 .,itlq djiv/ bnuod 3d o'l q/3 ('(•I^vo^^ia) aiJoiBinA 0 ^ Antarctic (1 )iscnvrry) l-\p. i Iv.-liinoderins. MYZOSTOMIDAE. BY DR. RUDOLF RITTEI; v. STUMMER-TRAUNFKLS (Graz, Austria). (1 Plate.) ElNLEITDNG. DAS von der ' Discovery ' heimgebrachte uud mir von Prof. F. Jcft'rey Bell in liebenswiirdigster Weise zur Bearbeituug iibergebeue Myzostoma-MateTia] umfasst nur eine relativ geringe Anzahl von Exemplaren, die sich auf zwei Species, eine freilebende und eine encystirte, verteilen. Die erstere ist eine neue Art : M. (iiitiirctii-nni, die k-tztere halte ich fur ideutiscli mit dem schon von Prof. Graff beschriebenen M. cysticolum. AVenngleich also die Ausbeute nur eine geriugfiigige Erweiteruug unserer beziiglichen systematischen Kenutnisse zu bringen vermockte, so erscheint sie doch in tiergeographischer Beziehung reclit benierkenswert : einerseits, weil die beiden Arten aus dem siidlichsten bekannten Gebiete des antarctischeu Uzeans stammen, aus welch' letzterem bislier noch nie Myzostomen heimgebracht wordeu sind ; * und andererseits, weil dadurch ein neuer Beweis fiir den Kosniopolitisnius des M. cysticolum geliefert wird. Diese Art kennt man nun von drei geographisch ausscrordentlich weit von eiuander entfernten Fundorteu (tropiseher West-Atlantic, Ostkiiste v. Japan, Ross-Meer iu der Autarctis), ein Befund, welcher durch das hohe geologische Alter der Gruppe sowie durch die bekanntlich sehr uniformen Lebensbediugungen des Stillwassers und der Ticfsee seine Erklarung findet. Da, wie schon gesagt, das mir zur Bcarbeituiig iibcrgebene Material nur eine geriuge systematische Ausbeutung zuliess, so beschriiukt sich die vorliegeudc Arbeit hauptsiichlich auf die anatomische Beschreibung der beiden Arteu. In dieser Hinsiclit vermochte ich insbesondere das M. cyxtic.olum genauer zu untersucheu, als dies bisher * Das siidlichste Gebiet, aus welchera man bis jetzt Myzostomen kannte, niimlich die See um die Prince Edward- und die Crozets-Inscln, liegt nocli in der Snbantarctia u. zwar nur wenig siidlich von der Nordgrenze der treibenden Eisberge und der Sttdgrenze des Wcltverkehrs. Von liicr wurden durch die ' Challenger '- Expedition folgende Arten gesammelt : — )[. i-niii/ireiiniim GmtT . . -3, pag. 42. M. coronatinii dr.- ill' . . . 3, ., 60. 8tf!i'i-li • •> I 1 6-0 7-5 Die Untersuchung erstreckte sich auf je ein in Xylol aufgehelltes Exemplar der Classe a, d, e, i) zuerst in lateraler Richtung an der Dorsalseite des Magens, um dann an dessen seitlicher Circumferenz ziemlich vertikal nach abwarts zu ziehen. Nacb Umgreifung des hintersten Hauptstammes der Darmverzweigung sehlangeln sie sick dann langs der Ventralseite des Magens zur Kloake hin, in welche sie schliesslich von beiden Seitcn her mit je einem spaltformigen Nephroporus ausniiindeu. VERWANDTSCHAFTLICHE BEZIEHUNGEN zu ANDEREN MYZOSTOMA-ARTEN. Die Griiude, welche Graff seinerzeit (3, pag. 22, Abs. 2) veranlasst haben, von einer Untertheilung des provisorischeu Sarumel-Genus Myzostoma abzuseheu, bestehen auch noch heute, da fiir die Hauptmasse der von ihni beschriebenen Arten noch immer eingehende anatomische Untersuchungen fehlen, ohne die eine systematische Die einzelnen Hodenfollikel sind von einander relativ weit entfernt und duroh mehr oder minder breite Bindegewebspartien oder durch andere Organteile getrennt. Die Speruriducte sind im Allgeuieinen verlangert und in einzelne Abschnitte (Vasa efferentia und deferentia, Samenblase, Ductus ejaculatorius), differenziert. Der rnaunliche Geschlechtsporus ist ventralseitig, zumeist ziemlich weit nach innen vom Kb'rperrande und fast regelmassig an der Spitze einer kegelformigen von der Basis des mittleren Parapodiurns nach aussen hin vorspringenden Genitalpapille (Penis) gelegen. (6) Compacter Hoden (" compact roundish glands occupying definite areas in the lateral part of the body " : Graff, 3, pag. 11, abs. 1)— Typus : M. cysticolum (vorliegende Arbeit, Pag. 13-14). Die Hodenfollikel sind auf eineui deutlich lungrenzten rundlichen Bezirk in den Seitenteilen des Korpers concentrirt. Sie liegen enge neben einauder und werden nur durch diinne Bindegewebsbalkchen oder -lamellen, nie durch andere Organteile getrennt. In der Mitte des Hodens bildet sich durch Platzen der dortselbst gelegenen bindegewebigen Follikelwandungen ein centraler Sammelraum, in welchem sich die reifen Geschleehts- producte anhiiufen. Dieser steht entweder vermittels eiues ganz kurzen unbedeutendeu Ductus ejaculatorius oder auch direct mit der miirmlieheu Geschlechtsomiung in Verbindung. Letztere ist am Seitenrande oder in unmittelbarer Nachbarschaft desselben gelegen. Eine Genitalpapille scheint nie ausgebildet zu werden. (c) Den dritten von den zwei vorigen Modificationen principiell verschiedenen Typus der Hodenanordnung hat Wheeler (8, pag. 247, 248) bei dem M. belli u. bei deni M. cryptopodium beobachtet. Bei diesen zwei Arten soil die Gesammtmasse der Hodeufollikel dorsal von den Darmiisten in der mittleren Korperregion gelegen und durch zwei dorsoventrale Septa in drei Lappen (einen medianen u. zwei laterale) geteilt seiii. Die Hodenfollikel springen in den dorsalen Theil der Leibeshiihle (" Uterus ") vor, m welchen auch die fertiggebildeten Spermien entleert werden, die dann offenbar (Wheeler spricht sich dariiber nicht aus) durch die weibliche Geschlechtsoffuung (oder Kloakalofmung ?) ihren Weg nach aussen finden. Bei der Isoliertheit dieser Beobachtung und bei der Wichtigkeit, welche dieselbe hinsichtlich der Leibes- hohleiifrage sowie der Genese der miinnlichen Keiinzellen bei den Myzostomen besitzt, erscheint eine Nachuntersuchung dieser beiden vou AVheeler nur oberfliichlich beschriebenen Arten dringend geboten. Anhangsweise mochte ich hier noch die sogenannten subectodennalen Hoden erwiihnen, welche Nansen (5, pag. 78 u. 79) bei M. gigas, M. gigantcum, M. graffi, u. AT. carpenteri beschrieben hat. Diese liegen als vollkommen von dem normalen verzweigten Hoden getrennte Follikel dicht unterhalb des Integumentes. Sie schemen — dies liisst auch ihre eigentiimliche Structur vennuten (Nansen, 5, pag. 79, zeile 3-5) — abgetrennte und in Riickbildung begriffene Terminalfollikel des normalen Hodens zu sein. MTZOSTOMTOAB. 7 Bearbeitung der Myzostoniiden undurchfiihrbar ist. Diescr Mangel lasst duller im AUgemeinen vorderhand nur eine additionelle Einreihung einer ncucn Species in diese Gattung geboten erscheinen. Im Speciellen wird man sich darauf beschranken miissen die ueubeschriebene Form mit den wenigeu Arten zu vergleichen, deren Organisation genauer bekannt ist und ihre Beziehungen zu ihnen festzustellen. Von diesem Standpunkte aus betrachtet steht das M. antarcticum jencr Gruppe von Arteu am niichsten, zu welcher das M. cirriferum (Gratf', 2, div. pag., Nansen, 5, div. pag., Wlu-el«..r, 8, pag. 229-236 ; pag. 276, abs. 3), ferner das .]/. 'gigas, das M. giganteum, das .]/. graft und das M. carpenten gehoren. (Die anatomische BeschreilMin- fiir .lie vier letztgeuannten Arten hat Nansen 5, pa". G«)-70 u. \\ m«r T f i \ geliefert.) 2. MYZOSTOMA CYSTICOLUM. (Plate, fig. 2-10.) Myzostoma cynticolum, Graff, Cliall. Rep. (1884), p. KG. " Mts. Erebus u. Terror; 22. i. 1902 ; 500 fms." Unter dem von der 'Discovery' heimgebrachten Crinoiden-Material fanden sich an den Armen eines Exemplares von Anted on adriani Bell zwei Cysteu vor, \\-elche eine Mi/;,>.stoma-Ait beherbergten, die ich fiir identisch mit dem M. cysticulum Graff (3, pag. 66-68) halte. HlSTORISCHES UND KRITISCHES. Diese cystenbewohnende Species wurde von dem genannteu Autor naeh einer Serie von Exemplaren aufgestellt, die aus dem westlichen Gebiete des tropischen Atlantic's (" Cabo Frio," Brasilien ; " Insel Grenada," kleine Antillen) stammten. Als \\ irt derselben fuugierte durchwegs Actinomttra meridwruili* var. cm-inata P.H.C. Graff hat aus Griinden, welche er in der Eiuleitung zu seinem ' Challenger '- Report (3, pag. 22, abs. 2) auseinandersetzt, bei der Beschreibung der lietreffenden Art fast ausschliesslicli uur ihre aiisserlich erkennltaren Merkmale sowie ihre biologischen Eigentiimlichkeitcn beriicksichtigt. Seine Angaben iiber die innere Organisation clieser Form beschranken sich auf eiuige die Darmverzweigung sowic den Genitalapparat betrcffende Befunde. 01)\vohl sich dieselben durchwegs als richti^ beobachtet erwiesen habeu, so hat sich inzwischen doch herausgestellt, dass jene iiuter ihnen, \velrhe sich auf die Geschlechtsorgane des sogenannten " Weibchcns " beziehcn, von Gruff in Ubereinstimmung mit den damals noch herrschcuden Ansichten iiber die Morphologic des weiblirhen Sexualapparutes missverstandlich gedeutet \vi >rden sind. Dies gilt insbesondere von den angeblichen " Hodenrudimeuten," welche, vie spater (Pag. 27) dargeleot wei-deu wird, als die functionierenden Ovarien aufgefasst werden miissen. Seit dem Erscheinen der ' Challenger '-Publication ist das J/. cy*t'm>htw, suwcit mir bekannt, uur uoch eiumal und zwar an der pacifischen Kiiste von Japan in einer DR. RUDOLF RITTER v. STUMMER-TRAUNFELS. Armcyste von Antedon discoidea P.H.C. angetroffen worden. McClendon, welcher die beiden in der Cyste vorhandenen Individuen untersucht hatte, beschrieb dieselben als eine neue Varietat : M. cysticolum var. orientale (4, pag. 120-121), und zwar mit der Begriindung, dass : (a) die Wirtsformen der Graff schen und jene der japanischen Exemplare eine verschiedene systematische Stellung einnahmen ; (b) die betreffenden Fundorte in tiergeographischer Hinsicht differierten, und (c) die japanischen Exemplare gegeniiber den Graff'schen Typen einige unwesentliche morphologische Unterschiede zeigten. Abgesehen da von, dass das McClendon vorgelegene Material (eine einzige Cyste !) an Zabl weitaus zu gering gewesen 1st, um die Aufstellung einer besonderen Varietat zu reclitfertigen, so halte ich die hierfiir angezogenen Argumente des genannten Autors nicht fiir eiuwandfrei. (ad a) Beziiglich des ersten derselben erinnere ich an die durch Graff (3, pag. 21) bekannt gewordene Tatsache, dass ein und dieselbe Myzostoma-Axt auf 1-4 Criuoidenspecies vorkommen kann (in einigen Fallen sogar auf Vertretern zweier Genera). Graff, gewiss der erfahrenste Kenner der Myzostoma-Systematik, hat sich jedoch nicht veraulasst gefiihlt, auf Grund dieses Umstandes verschiedene Varietaten der betreffenden Species zu unterscheiden. (ad l>) Was die von McClendon hervorgehobeue zoogeographische Differenz der Fundorte anbelangt, so diirfte dieses Argument gerade bei den Myzostomeu nur mit grosster Vorsicht anzuwenden sein, da das Verbreitungsgebiet dieser Parasiten noch sehr wenig bekaunt ist, aller Voraussicht nach aber mit jenem ihrer Wirte zusammenfallt, von welchen weitaus die meisten sich als charakteristische Vertreter der einen cosmopolitischen Charakter besitzenden " Stillwasserfauna " erwiesen habeu (Doflein, 1, pag. 251 u. pag. 272-273). I in iibrigen kann man der tiergeographischen Differenz der Fundorte als solcher allein keine Bedeutung fiir die Aufstellung von Varietaten beimessen, wenn sich nicht die verglichenen Localformen auch in morphologischer oder in biologischer Hinsicht als solche documentieren. Diese Bedingung erscheint meines Erachtens nach bei den Exemplaren McClendon's nicht erfiillt, (ad c) Die Besonderheiten, durch welche sich die letzteren vor den Graff'schen Typeu auszeichnen solleu, beschranken sich auf die bedeutendere Grosse sowie auf den etwas differenten Bau der Cyste, ferner auf die hervorragenderen Dimensionen der Parasiten selbst, schliesslich auf eine geringfiigige formale Differenz der sogenannten " Mannchen." Die Grosse der durch das M. cysticolum hervorgerufenen Cyste hiingt in erster Linie von der Grosse des ihr Lumen fast vollstandig ausfiillenden " Weibchens " ab. Da dieses jedenfalls von kleineren Dimensionen zu grosseren heranwachst und auch sonst in dieser Beziehung individuelle Verschiedenheiten zeigen kann, so werden MTZOSTOMIDAE. 0 demnach auch verschieden grosse Cysten vorkommen.* Da wir nun derzeit iiber die maximale Grosse, welche das M. cysticolum erreichen kanu, noch vollkommen im Unklaren sind, so erscheint es vorderhancl untunlich eine iiber die bekaunten Masse hinausreichende Cystengrb'sse als Kriterium zur Aufstellung einer neuen Varietat zu verwenden. Ebensowenig geeignet sind zu diesem Zwecke auch kleinere, den formalen Typus der Cyste nicht beeintrachtigende Differenzen im Baue derselben. Deu physiologischen Anlass zur Bildung einer Cyste gibt allerdings das Myzostoma, da es entweder durch seine Bisse oder warscheinlicher durch Absonderung toxischer Substanzen, wie es z. B. die Excretstoffe sein kb'nnen einen localeu Reiz auf den Wirtskorper ausiibt, auf welchen dieser dann durch Wucherung des geschiidigten Gewebes reagirt. Da wir aber den hauptsiichlichsteu, das ist den formativeu Anteil an der Cystenbildung der Wirtsform zuschreiben mussen, so werden wir kleiue, unwesentliche Veranderuugen in der Morphologic der Cyste iu erster Lime als den Effect einer iudividuellen Verschiedenheit des Wirtes zu betrachteu haben und erst in zweiter Linie, wcun sich eine solche ausschliessen lasst, an eine Verauderung des reizenden Substrates denken. Voraussetzung fiir diese Erwaguug ist uatiirlich, dass sich die Cysten an verschiedenen Individuen ein und derselben Wirtsspecies vorfinden.f In weit hoherem Grade niusseu wir jedoch die Wirtsform fiir etvvaige Veriinderungen im Bau der Cyste verantwortlich machen, wenu ein und dieselbe Myzostoma-Att verschiedene Wirts- species befallt. Es kommt denn eben die artliche Difi'erenz der letztereu auch im Baue der auf ihnen entstehenden Cysten zum Ausdrucke. Von diesem Gesichtspunkte aus muss auch die von McClendon beschriebene Cyste beurteilt werden. Sic fallt luiuptsachlich dadurch auf, dass sie im Gegeusatze zu den mit einem einzigen Porus versehenen Exemplaren Graff's, zwei derartigc Offnuugen und zwar eine an jedem ihrer Schmalenden besitzt. Als morphologischeu Unterschied zwischen den von Graff und deu von McClendou untersuchteu Parasiten erwahnt der letztgenannte Autor vor allem die bedeutendere Grosse seiner Individueu. Diese kaiiii jedoch ebensogut durch individuelles AVachstum oder durch besondere Eruahrungsverhaltnisse bediugt sein. Weiters hebt dersclbe Autor die Beobachtung hervor, dass bei dem mannlich fuuctiouierendeii (" small individual") seiner Exemplare die zwischen der Korperperipherie und der Eeihe der * Dies ist auch bei den von Graff untci-suchten Cysten der Fall gewesen. Vergleioht man die auf die Cystenliingc beziiglichen Angaben des genannten Autors mit dem von McClendon gegebenem Masse, so ergiebt sich, dass die Grossendifferenz zwischen dem kleinsten und dem grossten Exemplare Graffs genau dieselbe ist, wie zwischen dem letzteren und dem Exemplare McClendon's : — / kleinstes Exemplar . 1 mm. Graffscher Typ : ( ^..^ . 3 mm. < Differcnz = 2 mlu- McClendon's Exemplar ... .5 rum. "^ ^ mm- t Die Cysten von M. cysticolum, welche Graff untersucht hatte, fanden sich samrntlich an Actinomrlr.i mn-idionalis var. carinata P.H.C. Obgleich einige von ihnen kleinc Verschiedenheiten in ihrer Gestalt und ihrer Lage am Crinoidenarmc aufwiesen, so ist cs dem genannten Autor doch nicht beigcfallen, die Insasscn .In-, sulbon uls dififerente Varietaten dor typisL-hcn Form v.\\ beschrcibcn. 10 DK. RUDOLF HITTER v. STUMMER-TRAUNFELS. Parapodien gelegene Randpartie (" edge of the disc ") sich welter gegen das Centrum der Bauchseite bin ausdehnte, als dies bei der von Graft' gelieferten Abbildung (3, taf. xni. fig. 5) der Fall ware. Diesem Umstande vermag ich durchaus keiue Bedeutung zuzumesscu. Jeder Beobachter, welchem zaMreiche Exemplars eiuer Myzostoma-Sipecies zu Gesicht gekommen sind, weiss wie modulationsfakig hinsichtlich seiner centripetalen Ausdehnung gerade dieser Korperabschnitt 1st, dessen Areale durcli starkere Con- tractionen der " bauchstandigen Muskelmasse" (Graff, 2, pag. 41-42) vergrossert, durch Entspannung derselben verkleinert werden kann. Von den eben dargelegten Erwagungen ausgehend glaube ich also dass eiu zureichender Grund zur Aufstellung einer neuen Varietart fiir die von McClendon beschriebenen Exemplare des M. cysticolum uicht vorliegt. Ich hoffe durch die Beschreibung der von der ' Discovery ' heimgebrachten Individuen, fiir welche alle die von dem obgenannten Autor zu Gunsten seiner Auffassung ins Treffen gefiihrteu Argumeute in gleicher Weise, ja vielleicht in noch hoherem Ausmasse passen, wie fiir die von ihm untersuchteu Exemplare, einen weiteren Beweis fiir meine Ansicht erbringen zu konnen. Von der inneren Anatomie des M. cysticolum beriicksichtigt McClendon im wesentlichen nur den Geschlechtsapparat. Er berichtigt und erganzt die beziiglichen Angaben Graffs und bestatigt auch fiir die genannte Species das Vorhandensein von weiblichen Gonaden bei einem jeden der beiden, friiher als " Weibchen " und als " Zwergmannchen " unterschiedenen Individuen des die Cyste bewohnenden Parasiten-Parchens. BESCHREIBCNG DER ' DISCOVERY '-EXEMPLARE. CYSTEN. Die beiden mir zur Untersuchuug iibergebenen Cysten waren als eiformige Auftreibungen des Wirtsintegumentes ihrer Lange nach dem Crinoidenarme etwas seitlich von dessen Ambulacralrinne angeschlossen (Fig. 3). Sie massen 6 '2 mm. beziiglich 5 mm. in der Lange uud 3'2 mm. beziiglich 2'5 in der Breite. Die Wandungsdicke der grossereu Cyste betrug durchschnittlich 0' 15 mm.,- war also verbal tnismassig viel geringer als bei den Cysteu, welche Graff beschrieben hatte (3, pag. 67, zeile 9-10 ; pag. 68, abs. 2 ; taf. xni., fig. 4).* An jedem Cystenende zeigte sich in gleicher Weise wie bei den Exemplaren McClendon's eine ins Innere fiihrende Offnung, von welchen die von der Muudscheibe des Wirtes abgewendete in beiden Fallen viel grosser als die andersseitige war und sich vor dieser ausserdem noch durch eine schwache Aufwulstung ihres Randes * Dies hiingt mit der ansehnlichen Grosse der antarctischen Myzostoma -Individuen zusarnmen ; denn eine Cyste, welche ein grosseres Myzostoma beherbergt, wird auch eine ausgedehntere, daher relativ dtinnere Wandung besitzen als eine solche, welche einen kleineren Parasiten umschliesst. Auch unter den von Graff beschriebenen Cysten besass die kleinste (3, ' Blake '-Exemplar, pag. 68, abs. 2) eine derbere "Wandung als die iibrigeu. MYZOSTOMIDAE. 1 1 auszeichuete. Die kleinere der Cystenoffnuugen wurde erst daim sichtbar, wt-nn man die in der Cyste enthaltenen Parasiten entfernt liatte, so dass Licht durch den punktforinigen Porus fallen konnte.* A.USSERE MORPHOLOGIE DER PARASITEN. Jede Cyste umschloss, wie bei den Exemplaren Graft's u. McClendon's, je ein grosseres weiblich- und eiu kleineres niauulich-functionicrendes Individuum. In folgendem will ich nach dem Beispiele der friiheren Autoren der bequemeren Ausdrucksweise halber das erste als " Weibcheu," das letztere als " Mannchen " bezeichnen, trotzdem beide, wie spater nachgewiesen werden soil, als morphologische Hermapliroditen organisiert sind. A. Das Weibchen (" female " : Graff, 3, pag. 67 ; " large individual " : McClendon, 4, pag. 121), (Fig. 2 u. 4), war der Lange nach in der Cyste gelagert, deren Innenraum es dabei so vollstaudig ausfiillte, dass seiu Hinterende in ihm keinen Platz mehr fand und aus der grosseren der beiden Cystenoffnungen etwas herauszurageu gezwungen war. Auch der Breite nach entsprach das Cystenlumen nicht den Dimen.siouen des Tieres, weshalb dessen laterale Korperpartieu, wie dies schon die beiden vorgenannten Autoren geschildert hatten, dorsalwarts aufgerollt waren, so dass die Seiteuriinder in der Medianebene nicht bloss zur Beriihrung sondern auch stellenweise (am Hinterende und in der Mitte des Korpers) zur Uberlagcrung gelangten (Fig. 7 u. 8). Wie ein Blick auf das in Fig. 4 von der Veutralseite her abgebildete Weibchen zeigt, ist der (in der Fig. nach oben gerichtete) Hinterrand desselben medial ziemlich tief eiugezogen. An dieser Stelle springen die benachbarten hintersten Abschnitte der aufgerollten Scitenrander nach riickwarts vor und legen sich zugleich, wie dies aus Fig. 6 zu erkennen ist, nach Art von zwei einander tiberdeckenden Fliigelklappeu von seitwarts und hiuteu her, iiber den trichterformig rnvcilrrten After (aiJ), sowie iiber die unmittelbar olterhalb von diesem gelegcne wcibliche Geschlechtsb'ffuung (6). Oberhalb von diesem miindet der dem sogenanuten Uterus des Weibchens entsprechende mediale Dorsalabschuitt des Coeloms durch eine kleine Offuung aus, die wir demgemass als ein Homologou der weiblichcn Geschleclitsiill'nuug betraclitm miisscu (Fig. 9, £>H). Die beiden maunlicheu Genitalporen (Fig. 5, d<">), welclic in der die mittlcreu Parapodien vcrbiudendeu Transvcrsanebeue gclegen sind, offuen sich nicht, wie Graff uud McCleiidou fiir ihrc Exemplare augebeu, marginal, sondern auf der Dorsalseite des Tieres, siud indess dem Korperrande sehr uahe geriickt. Von diesem aus zieht zu eiuem jeden von ilmeu eine kurze rinuenformige Vertiefung des Integuments, welche moglicherweise von den beiden obgenannten Autoren als Ductus ejaculatoriua aufgefasst wordeu ist, woraus sich ihre von ineinem Befuude differierende Angaben erklaren liesseu. Eiii Excretionsporus ist auch beim Manncheu nachzuweisen. Er liegt wie beim Weibchen median auf der Ventralseite dicht vor dem After (Fig. 10, nj>).* * Wio aus dem Vorstehenden zu entnelimen ist, findcn sich simitlirli.- ;un Kiirpov des Weibchens autretende ()ffnungcn auch iri gleichcr Lage brim Mannchcn vor, ein Vcrbaltcn, welches mit d.-m lliinveis auf die spiiter zu bcsprechcnden uiorphologischcn uud biologischen Bcziehungen der beiden Qesohlechtsformen sclion hier hervorgehobeu sei. U 2 14 DR. RUDOLF RITTER v. STUMMER-TRAUNFELS. INNERE ORGANISATION. AA7ie in der Lage der Korperoffuungeu so besteht auch hiusichtlich der iuneren Organisation beim Mannchen uud beim Weibchen trotz deren aiisserlichen Grossen- und Formdifferenz eine principielle Ubereiustimmung. Diese aussert sich vor allem am Sexualsysteme, das bei jeder der zwei Geschlechtsformen durch zwei Apparate, einen niannlichen und eiueu weiblichen, vertreten ist, von welchen aber beim Mannchen nur der erstere, beim AAreibchen uur der letztere reife Sexualproducte liefert. Die Differenzen zwischeu den Geschlechtsorganen des Mannchens und jenen des Weibcheus sind also hauptsachlich functionelle uud dies gilt irn Grunde genomnien auch fiir alle iibrigen Organe. Diese erscheinen bei den zwei Geschlechtsformen nach demselben Plane angelegt uud unterscheiden sich nur durch ihren Ausbildungsgrad, der seiner- seits von ihrer Functionsintensitat abhangt. Diese wird wieder durch die physiologische Sexualitat des betreffenden Individuums bestimnit* Aus diesem Grunde halte ich es fiir zweckmiissig in Nachfolgendem die einzelnen Organe gemeinsam fiir beide Geschlechtsformen zu beschreiben und zwar in folgender durch obigen Gedankengang begriindeten Eeiheufolge :— (1) Weiblicher Geschlecht*apparat. (2) Mdnnlicher Geschlec.htsapparat. (3) Ernahrungsapparat. (4) Excretionsapparat; Auf eine Schilderung des Nervensystems beabsichtige ich aus dem Grunde nicht einzugehen, weil sich dasselbe in seiner groberen Morphologic nicht von jenem der anderen Myzostomen unterscheidet, und weil andererseits eine Untersuchung seines feineren Aufbaues, der bei dem Maimchen und dem AVeibchen moglicherweise interessaute Differenzeu vergeben hatte, wegen der quantitativen und qualitativeu Unzulauglichkeit des Materials aussichtslos schien. AVEIBLICHER GESCHLECHTSAPPARAT. Derselbe wird bei den Myzostomen, wie bekannt, von einem Teile der Leibes- hohle (dem Uterus mit seinen Diver tikelu), und weiters von bestimnit localisirten Wucherungen seiner peritonealen Auskleidung (den Ovarien) gebildet ; (vergl. diesbeziiglich : Stummer, 6, pag. 574 u. ft'.). Mannchen : Bei diesem erscheint der zu den weiblichen Geschlechtswegen umgebildete Leibeshohlenanteil, — ini Gegensatze zu den ausschliesslicB mauulich * Durch die physiologische Unisexualitat werden abgesehen vom entsprechenden Geschlechtsapparate hauptsachlich die Stoffwechselorgane (Darni- u. Excretionssystein), in ihrein Ausbildungsgrade beeinflusst, und zwar in der Weise, dass die Functionsintensitat dieser Organe beim Weibchen gegeniiber jener beim Mannchen erheblich gesteigert erscheint. Der miitterliche Korper, welcheni die Ausbildung der grossen und dotterreichen Eier obliegt, besitzt eben ein weit grosseres Stoffwechselbediirfnis als der vaterliche, der durch die Production der winzigen Spermien diesbeziiglich nicht so sehr beansprucht wird (vergl. Pag. 20 und 21). MYZOSTOMIDAE. 15 functiouiercndeu Individuen anderer Myzostoma-Alten, bei welchcu sich bisher nur sparliche Andeutungcn dieser Coelompartie nachweisen liesseu, — wohl entwickelt ; er 1st zwar raumlich nicht so ausgedehnt, wie beim Weibchen, zeigt aber dicsclbe Unter- gliederung wie bei dicsem. Er setzt sich aus einem dorsalcn, zwei seitlichen und eiueni veutralen Abschnitte zusammen. Der erste entspricht der bei anderen hermaphroditisch functionierenden My:ost«nin- Arten gemeiniglich als Uterus bezeichneten Leibeshohlenpartie. Er stellt ein medianes, dorsoventral abgeplattetes Rohr dar, welches ungefahr oberhalb der Mageninitte beginnt und von hier aus unter allmahliger Verschmiilerung nach riickwarts bis zur weiblichen Geschlechtsoft'uung verlaiift, durch welche es ausmiiudet (Fig. 9, ua + ul>] Bald liinter seinem verbreitcrten Vorderende erscheint seine Seitenwauduug rechts und links in einen kurzen Zipfel ausgezogen, an dessen Lateralende sich je ein Nephrostom (Fig. 9, ns) offnet. Vorne steht der Uterus jederseits durch einen kurzen und breiteu Querast mit den beiden Seiteuabschnitten der Leibeshohle in Verbindung. Diese verlaufeu zunachst in dorsoventraler Richtung langs der rechteu und liuken Seitenwand der vorderen Magenhalfte nach abwarts, um sodann beiderseits nach Umfassuug der Wurzeln des n. und in. Hauptdarmastes in den Ventralabschnitt der Leibeshohle iiberzugeheu. Letzterer besteht aus zwei symmetrischen, durch cine schmale suboesophageale Quer-Commissur verbundeue Halfteu (Fig. 10, vl). Eiue jede von dieseu beginnt als ein langlicher, unter und seitwarts von den lateralen Magenpartien gelegener Hauptraum, von dem weiterhin drei Uivertikel gegen die Hauptdarmaste ausgehen, welche die letzteren unter entsprechender Teilung langs ihrer ganzen Verzweigung ventralseitig begleiten (Fig. 10, 1,2,3). An der Wurzel des ersteii uud dritten dieser Divertikel liegt nun je ein aus einer localeu Wucherung des Peritonealepithels hervorgehender Zellhaut'cn, welcher von seitwarts und von unten her in den Hauptraum einspiiugt. Im Ganzen sind daher vier derartigc Gebilde vorhanden (Fig. 10, o). Hirer Lage und ihrem histologischen Aufbaue nach miissen wir sie in Ubereinstimmung mit McClcndon (4, pag. 121, abs. 3) mit den von Nansen (5, pag. 78, abs. 4) bei anderen Myzostomen entdeckten " problematischeu Organen " homologisieren, die spatcr von Wheclor (7, pag. 178, abs. 2) als die echten Ovarien erkannt worden sind. Dass sic bcim ^liiunchen von M. cysticolum tatsachlich als solche friiher odor spater functiouieren lasst sich jedoch nicht uachweiseu. Sie machen im Gegensatze zu den productiven Ovarien ) augehorenden Hoden liegt eiu deutlicher centraler Sammelraum, der direct mit der Geschlechtsoffnung communiciert und sowohl Spermien als auch cine Meuge von sich nicht weiter eutwickelndeu, viellcicht auch degenerierten Spermatocytcn (Stummer, 6, pag. 583) enthalt. Beim Weibchen fand ich die beiden Hodeu genau in derselbcn Lage und in der formell gleichen Ausbildung, wie beim Mannchen. Sie liegen jederseits in der ]\Litte des aufgerollten Seiteurandes, dicht nel)en dem mannlicheu Geschlechtsporus, und stellen eine deutlich vom iibrigen Korperparenchym abgegrenzte Masse von reticu- larcm Bindegewebe dar, dcssen Intercellularraume zu grosseren Blasen ausgedelnit sind (Fig. 7, t). Die letzteren flicssen in der Mittc dieses Complexes zu einem dicht an die mannliche Geschlechtsoffnuiig anschliessenden centralen Sammelraum zusammen. Wahreud aber die Intercellularraume beim Mannchen dicht mit Keimzellen bezie- hungsweise mit deren Teilungsproducten crfiillt sind, cuthalteu sie l)eim Weibchen relativ uur wenigc Zellen. Von dicseu lasscn sich zweierlei Formen uuterscheiden : Die eincu gleichen auftallend den von Graff (2, pag. 64, Abs. 1) als " Ruudzelleu " * Benierkenswort ist, dass schon Graff die Ovarien bei M. cysticolum gesehen hat. Nur wunlcn sic von ihm zufolge der damals noch herrschenden Anschauung, dass die Vcrzweigungcn des Uterus (Leibeshohle uucl ilire Divertikel) das Ovarium bei den Myzostoinen ilarstellten, als rudinicntare Hoden gedcutet (Gruff, 3, pag. 67, abs. 2). Nach der Abbildung, welche der genannte Autor von diesen Gebilden gelicfert hat (3, taf. xm., fig. 4, t), erscheint es jedoch zweifellos — auch McClendon ist dieser Meinuug (4, pag. 121, abs. 3) — dass sic mit den oben gcschilderten echten Ovarien idcntificicrt \verden miissen. Die Prioritiit, die wahren .1A/^ns/o»ia-Ovarien zuerst gesehen zu haben gebiihrt daher Graff, und nicht Nansen, dern sie bisher zugeschrieben worden ist. 18 DR. RUDOLF HITTER v. STUMMER-TRAUNFELS. beschriebeuen freien Bindegewebselementen (Stammer, 6, pag. 589, letzt. Abs.). Die auderen machen jedoch vollstandig den Eindruck von degenerierten Zellen. Sie besitzen einen relativ kle.ineu uuregelmassig gestalteteu Kern, der sich mit Haema- toxylin intensiv farbt und dabei neben einem homogenen Aussehen auch ein eigentiimliches Lichtbrechungsvermogen entwickelt. Ihr Cytoplasma 1st nur in sehr geringer Meuge vorhanden und im giinstigsten Falle als ein kaum tingierbarer, sehmaler, den Kern umhullender Saum zu erkenneu. Von Spermien fand sich innerhalb des ganzen Bindegewebscomplexes keine Spur. Der centrale Sanimelraum desselben entliielt dagegen bei jedem der mir vorgelegeuen Exemplare eine feinkornige oft fadig angeordnete und auch aus der Geschlechtsoffhung dringende Masse, in welche zahlreiche der oberwahnten anscheinend degenerirten Zellen eingebettet waren. Ich stehe nicht an, die eben geschilderten Organe auf Grund ihrer Lage uud ihrer Ausbildung als functionslose Hoden zu betrachten, die jenen des Mannchens vollstandig homolog sind. Es ist infolge des ungeniigenden Materials selbstverstandlich sehr schwer zu entscheiden, ob sie als Riickbildungen von mannlichen Gonaden aufzufassen sind, die in einem friiheren Lebensalter des Individuums functioniert haben, oder ob sie auf einern friihen Entwickelungsstadium stehengebliebene, niemals zur sexuellen Betatigung gelaugte Apparate darstellen. Meiner Meinung nach dtirfte die erstere Annahme die zutreffende sein, insbesondere deshalb, weil sich ahnliche Verhiiltnisse (Proterandrie mit spaterer Riickbildung des Hodens) bei zahlreichen frei lebenden und auch bei einigen entoparasitischen Myzostoma-Axten, mit Sicherheit haben nach- weisen lasseu (Wheeler, 8, pag. 288-289). Schliesst man sich dieser Ansicht an, so konute man von den oberwahnten, in den Intercellularraumen vorhandenen Zellen, die von mir als auscheinend degenerirt bezeichneten Elemente als riickgebildete Keimzellen, jene aber, welche den " Rundzellen " Graff's ahneln, als secundar in die Follikel eiugewanderte freie Biudegewebszellen auffassen. Die feinkoruige, im Sanimelraum enthaltene Masse wiirde danu auf Reste von abgestorbeneu Spermien oder von zugrundegegangeueu Sperm atocy ten etc. zuriickzufiihren sein. Derartige fuuetionslose Hoden sind weder von Graff noch von McClendon bei den von ihnen untersuchten " Weibchen " beschrieben worden. Ich glaube aber, dass diesbe- ziiglich ein Uberseheu von Seiten der genannten Autoren vorliegt, da diese Gebilde bei dem vollstandigen Fehlen von tatigen Keinizelleii und von Spermien nicht sofort als Hoden zu erkennen sind. Graff diirfte ihnen schon deswegen keine weitere Beachtung gescheukt haben, weil er iiberzeugt war, in den von ihrn beim Weibchen beschriebenen "collections of small cells closely resembling the immature testicular follicles . . . ." (3, pag. 67, abs. 2) Hodenrudimente vor sich zu haben. Dass diese seine Auffassung eine irrtiimliche war, uud dass diese Gebilde die Ovarien darstellen, habe ich schou friiher (Pag. 17) erwahnt. MYZOSTOMIDAE. 19 ERXAHRUNGS-APPARAT. Derselbe ist nach dem schon von den iibrigen Myzostomen her bekannten Typus gebaut. Wegen der viel einfacheren Verhaltnisse, welclie er beim Mdnnchen aufweist, sei er zuerst an diesem geschildert : Beziiglich YOU Muud und After vcrweise ich auf die schon friihcr (Pag. 13) gelieferten Angaben. Der lange, eylindrische, an seinem Vordereude nicbt mit Tastpapillen ausgeriistete Pharynx (Fig. 9, bin), steht vermittela eines kurzeu " Oesophagus " mit dem Magen in Verbiudung. Dieser (Fig. 9, mi/), zerfallt durch eine seichte, querc Einschniiruug in eineu vorderen \veiten uud einen hiuteren eugeren Abschnitt. Vom crsteren gehen ventral jederseits drei Hauptdarmaste (Fig. 9, I, II, ill) ab, welche sich nach kurzein Yerlaufe teilen und mit ilm-n wcuig zahlreicheu, stumpf eudigenden Divertikeln bis zur Randzone des Korpers reicheu. Von dieaen drei Hauptdarmasten verzweigen sich jederseits die zwei ersten in der vor dem Hoden gelegenen, der dritte in der liiuter diesem befindlichen Korperpartie. Der hintere Magenabschmtt ist kleiner als der vordere uud geht vermittels eiues nur am oontrahirtcn Tiere (Fig. 5) sichtbaivu Absatzes in das rohrenformige dorsoventral compresse Eectum (Fig. 9, r) iiber. Die Afteroffuung kann durch einen sich aus dem Hautmuskelschlauche ditiereuzierenden schwachen Spliinktcr gescliLisscn \vcrdrn. Der gesamte Verdauungsapparat ist bcim .Mauuchen entsprechend dessen geriugem Ernahrungsbedurfnisse recht einfach gebaut. Seiue cinzeliii-u Abschnitte setzen sich aus einer weit geringcreu Auzalil von Zellelcmcuten zusammeii \vic jene des Weibchens. Auch seine Muscularis ist nur schwach entwickell und an manchen Stellen iiberhaupt uicht nachzuweisen. Beim Weibchen hingegeu dessen Stoffwechselbediirfnis infnl-i' der reichlichen Eierproduction uugeniein gesteigert ist, zeigt der Eruiihrungsapparal eine vicl machtigere Ausgestaltuug : vor allcm ist der Magm (Fig. (>, 7, 8, mi/) relativ bedeutend voluminoser wie beim Mannchen. Er wird seiner ganzeu Ausdehuung nacli sanit dem Oesophagus (Fig. 6, «c) von einem sehr auftalleudeu Wimpercpithd ausgekleidet, desseu zahlreiche uud dicht stehende Cilien wegen ihrer uugewohnlichen Lange bemerkenswert siud (Lange der Epithelzellen : 0'OG8 m., jeue der C'ilien : O'l m.). Die Hauptdarmaste sind distahvarts ausserordentlich reich verzweigt. Ihre Divertikel liegen vollkommen in die latcraleu Leibeshohlensacke eiugebettet (Fig. 7 u. 8, (In), uud verbreiten sich in grosser Xahl iiislpfsoinlrrc iimcihalli <\>T aufgerollten Seiteupartien des Korpers, wo sie sich mit ihreu Terminalenden bis kuapp unter deu Hautmuakelschlauch erstn-rken. Das Hiutrrcndc des Magens erscheint scharf von Eectum (Fig. 6, r) abgesetzt. Das letzterc verliiuft in zicinlii-h gerader Richtuug bis zuni After. Es wird von einem Wimperepithel ausgekleidet, das in radiiir in sein Lumen einspriugcude Langsfalten gelegt ist. Eim- durch aiissere Ring- uud iiinere Langsfaserii hergestellte Muscularis fmdet sich 20 DR. RUDOLF EITTER v. STUMMER-TRAUNFELS. sowohl am Magen als auch am Rectum. Sie erscheint insbesondere am crsteren kraftig ausgebildet ; an letzterem ist sie jedoch schwach entwickelt, ihre beiden Schichten werden aber hier noch durch eine periphere dritte Lage vervollstandigt, die aus locker vcrfilzten Fasern besteht. Ein besonders differenzierter Sphinkter findet sich weder an der Grenze zwischen Magen und Rectum, noch um die Afteroffnung. Fiir die letztere wird die Function eines solchen wohl von den benach- barten Partien des Hautmuskelschlauches iibernommen. Ausserdem erscheint aber der After fur gewohnlich auch noch durch die friiher (Pag. 11) beschriebenen Analklappen verschlossen. NEPHRIDIEN. Dieselben beginnen jederseits mit einem sich in dem vorderen Uterusabschnitt ofihenden cylindrischen Nephrostom (Wimpertrichter) (Fig. 8, 9, ns). Dieses setzt sich in einen engen, beim Mannchen kiirzeren, beim Weibchen, wegen dessen bedeutender Dicke, laugereu Nephridialcanal fort, welcher in ziemlich geradem Verlaufe langs der Seitenwand der hinteren Magenhalfte nach abwarts zieht (Fig. 8), um sich etwa in halber Magenhohe plotzlich (diese Stelle ist in Fig. 8 und 10 mit * bezeichnet) zu eiuer grossen, vielfache Windungen und Einschuiirungen zeigenden Endblase zu erweitern. Die letztere (Fig. 6, 8, 10, nb) besitzt in ihrem proximalen an den Nephridialcanal anschliessenden Abschnitt eine bedeutende Ausdehnung, verschmalert sich aber distalwarts . allmahlig zu einem relativ langen, ziemlich gerade nach hinten verlaufenden Canal, welcher mit jenem der auderen Kb'rperseite gegen die Medianebeue convergiert und sich schliesslich mit ihm zu einem kurzen unpaaren Endstiick (Fig. G, 10, nu) vereiiiigt, das durch den median, knapp unter der Afteroffnung gelegeuen Excretionsporus (Fig. 6, 10, np) ausmlindet. Wahrend der Nephridialcanal von eiuem verhaltnismassig niedrigeu Wimper- epithel ausgekleidet ist, findet sich in der Endblase bis zuni Excretionsporus hiu ein deutliches Driisenepithel, dessen hohe keulenformig gestaltete Elemente (aus Fig. 8 ist die Lagerung und die relative Hohe derselben ersichtlich) der Wimpern entbehreu. Eine besoudere Muscularis liess sich nur an der Endblase nachweisen, aber auch hier ist sie sehr schwach ausgebildet uud besteht lediglich aus einer Ringfaser- schichte. So wie der Ernahruugsapparat, zeigeu auch die Nephridieu des Weibchens gegeniiber jenen des Mannehens eine viel machtigere Entfaltuug, die sich insbesondere in der relativen Lauge des Nephridialcanals sowie in der Grosse der Endblase aussert. SEXTTALVERHALTNISSE TJND DIMORPHISMUS DER GESCHLECHTSFORMEN. Graff (3, pag. 11-12) unterscheidet unter den von ihm beschriebenen cysticoleu Myzostomen zweieiiei in Bezug auf ihre Sexualverhaltnisse divergente Formen und zwar rein dioecische und rein hermaphroditische. MYZOSTOMIDAE. 21 Zur ersteren Gruppe gehoren : M. tenuispinum, M. w[ll<-n\<»x'i, .}f. i/ij/a/vr uud M. ini/nrii/i. Bei diesen Species finden sich in je eiuer Cyste zwei auffallend dimovpbe Individuen vereinigt, ein kleines, nur mannlich organisirtes " Manuchen " und cin grosses, nur weibliche Charaktere besitzendes " Weibchen." * Die zweite Gruppe wird durch M. pmtiicrini und M. ilfunimt^r repraeseutirt. Die Individuen dieser beideu Arten lebeu entweder eiuzeln in je einer Cyste, oder aber sie warden, falls sie zu mehreren (zwei bis drei) eine solche bewolmen, in dieser durch entsprechende Scheidewande von einander getrennt. Zur innigen Beriihrung zweier Exemplare, wie dies bei den rein dioecischeu Species die Regel ist, kommt es daher bei ihnen nicht. Ebensowenig besteht hier ein Dimorphismus unter den Insassen einer und derselbeu Cyste. Jedes Individuum zeigt sowobl mannliche als auch weibliche Charaktere und functioniert auch dementsprechend als Herniaphrodit.f Das M. cysticolum betrachtete Graff als eine in sexuellcr Beziehung intermediare Form zwischen den rein dioecischeu und den rein hermaphroditdschezi Species (3, ]>ag. <>7, Abs. 2), da er vermutete, dass bei ihr das " Weibchen " Hodenrudimente besasse. Auf Grund unserer heutigen Kenntnisse iiber die Anatomie dieser Art diirfen wir jedoch behaupten, dass ihre beiden dimorphen Greschlechtsindividuen morphologisch als Hermaphroditen organisirt sind, in physiologischer Beziehung jedoch nur eingeschlechtlich und zwar entweder nur als Mannchen oder uur als Weibchen functionieren.J Von einem Sexualdimorphismua in der gebrauchlichen Bedeutung kann daher bei ^f. ci/sticolum nicht die Rede sein. Man wird vielmehr die bei dieser Species herrscheudeu Geschlechtsverhaltnisse als das Endergebnis einer physiologischen Sexualdifferenzierung betrachten miissen, die sich im Laufe der Ontogenese auf (morphologisch-) hermaphroditischer Grundlage vollzieht und dabei niit einer Dimorphosierung der sich entwickelnden Geschlechtsindividm-n vcrbuudeu ist. Der typische Myzostoma-TLabitua uud die relativ geringc Grosse de.s Manncheus, ferner die verhaltnismassig sehr eiufache Ausbildung seiner iunereu Organe, sowie der primitive Aufbau seiner Korpcrgewebe lassen dasselbe viel urspriiuglicher und unverauderter erscheinen als das Weibchen, weshalb wir annehmcu miisseu, dass die Dimorphosierung hauptsachlich an dem letzteren wahrend seiner Entwickelung Vdll- zieht. Es wird hier die allmiihlig sich eiustellende physiologische Praeponderanz der weiblichen Gonaden nicht nur den hciheren Ausbildungsgrad dos weiblicheu Sexualapparates (Leibeshohle), sondern auch die functionellc Ausgc-staltung jeuer * Nur eininal wurde von Graff (3a, pag. 8) in einer durch If. willemocsi hervorgerufcnen Cyste bloss ein einziges und zwar uiiinnlich functionierendes Individuum vorgefunden. t In diese Gruppe gehoren noch : M. bcardi und M. platypus (Graff 3a, pag. 13 u. 14 ; fiir M. platypus siehe auch : Wheeler 8, pag. 214), ferner M. Irlli, M. cryptopodium und AT. rremUn (Wheeler 8, pag. 246-251) sowie warscheinlich auch das M. clm-ki (McClendon 4, pag. 121-122), obwohl es dem letztgcnanntjn Autor nicht gegliiekt ist, bei den von ihm untersuchtcn Individuen Hoden oder Reste von solchen aufx.ufmden. i Ich vermute, dass ahnliche Vcrhiiltnisse auch bei den ubrigen von GralT als " dioecisch " bezciclmeten Arten herrschen. Eine diesbeziigliche Entscheiduug ist allerdings nur init Hilfe der Schuittmethode zu erbringen, die der genannte Autor, \vie aus dem betreffenden Texte und aus den von ihm gelieferten Abbildungen hcrvorgeht, bei dieseu Species nich angewandt hat. x 2 22 DR. RUDOLF EITTER v. STUMMER-TRAUNFELS. Organe bedingen, welche fiir die Eierproduction eine nur indirecte Bedeutung haben : Darm und Excretionsapparat (Stoffwechselorgane). In zweiter Liuie wird der correlative Einfluss der auftretenden physiologischen Unisexualitat bei dem sich zum Weibchen entwickelnden Individuuin auch aiisserlich und zwar an der relativen Dimensionierung, der Consistenz und der Form des Kb'rpers, ferner am Bewegungs- apparate zum Ausdrucke kommen : Die reichliche Auzahl der producierten Eier, welche innerhalb der Leibeshohle infolge der Aufnahme von Dotter zu einem Vielfachen ihrer ursprunglichen Grosse heranwacbsen, bediugt einen verbal tnismassig umfangreichen miitterlichen Korper mit derber dem bedeutenden Innendrucke gewachsener Wanduug. So kornmt es deun schliesslich dazu, dass die Dimensionen des Weibcliens jene des Manuchens weit iibertreffeu. Die Breitenausdehuung des erstereu wird sogar eiue so grosse, class ihr das Cystenwachstum nicht zu folgen vermag, weswegeu die Seitenrander des Tieres gezwungen sind, sich medianwarts in der friiher beschriebenen Weise einzurollen (Graff, 3, pag. 12, abs. l). Da ferner fiir das Weibchen die Bewegungsmoglichkeit innerhalb der dem Korper enge anliegenden Cyste verloren gegangen 1st, so werden die Parapodien als fiir die Eiproduction iiberfliissig gewordene Korperteile eingeschmolzen. Es findet sich von ihnen nur mehr der Hackenapparat, wahrend die hautigen Teile des Fussstummels fast vollstandig in die Leibeswand aufgenommen erscheinen. Dementsprechend ist auch die Stummel- und Hackeumuskulatur rudimentiert. Bei dem sich zurn Mauuchen entwickelnden ludividuum braucht sich die Sexualdifferenzierung fast nur auf die functionelle Ausgestaltung des mannlichen Apparates zu beschranken ; denn der Darm und der Excretionsapparat werden hier jeneu Ausbildungsgrad kaum iiberschreiten, welchen sie bereits bei dem der Geschlechtsform unmittelbar vorangehenden Jugendstadium besassen. Beim Mannchen erfahrt eben das Stoffwechselbediirfnis durch die Erzeugung von Sperma keineswegs eine so wesentliche Steigeruug, wie beim Weibchen durch die Versorguug der Eier mit Dotter. Die Production der kleiuen, wegen ihrer Form in compendio'sester Weise zusarnmenpackbareii Spermien benotigt nur relativ geringe KOTperraume, wogegen fiir die Absatzmoglichkeit des Sameus eine unbehiuderte Bewegungsfahigkeit des Tieres vorteilhaft erscheint. So besitzt denn das Mannchen einen kleinen, zarten und abgeflachten Korper mit wohlentwickeltem Parapodialapparate. Es spricht vieles dafitr, dass sich dasselbe auch im Habitus nicht weseutlich von jener Jugendform unterscheidet, die ihm in der Ontogenese uumittelbar vorausgegangen ist. Die Entwickelungsstadien, auf welchen sich die Sexualdifferenzieruug bei den zwei Geschlechtsformen herausbildet, sind uns leider noch vollig unbekannt und daher bleibt die Frage noch offen : Gilt auch fiir das M. cysticolum die Teorie Wheeler's von den successiven Sexualphasen (8, pag. 288-289), oder herrschen diesbeziiglich bei dieser Art andere Verhaltnisse ? Nach den Beobachtungen des ebeugcnannten Autors ist die Sexualdifferenzierung MYZOSTOMIDAE. 23 der Myzostomen eine successive, das heisst, es tritt im Leben eines jeden Individuums nach Ablauf eines gescklecktlick indifferenteu Jugeudstadiums zuerst eine mannliche, spiiter hingegen eine weibliche Gescklecktsperiode auf. Bei den moisten Arten fand Wheeler, dass diese beiden " Sexualphasen " durch eineu iuterrnediareu functionell hermaphroditiscken Zustand verbuuden sind ; er beobachtete jedock auck Species (z. B. 3[. pulvinar, 8, pag. 289), bei welchen diese Zwischenperiode ausfallt, so dass die mannliche und die weiblicke Gescklecktspkase direct an einander ansckliessen. Ick halte es nun durckaus nickt fiir unwarsckeinlick, dass diese Teorie "Wheelers auck fiir das M. cyxticolum Gcltung besitzt. Das Yorkandcnsein von Ovarien l)eim Manucken und von Hodenresten beini Weibcken lassen diese Annakme zu, insbesondere, wenn man geueigt ist, die Ovarieu des Mannckens als sick erst entwickelnde, aber nock nickt functionsfakige Organe aufzufassen. Weuu \vir demgemass das Manucken als ein frillies Entwickelungsstadium des Weibckens betrackten, so ware aber auck der auffallende Umstand zu erklareii, dass in alien bisker beobackteten Fallen (1G)* in jeder Cyste uur die beideu extremdimorpken Individual, aber keine ontogenetiscken Zwiscken- oder Ubergangsstadien, deren Vorkommeu man ja in Consequeuz der obigeu Teorie voraussetzen muss, augetroffen wurden. Wheeler, \velcher das Bcdiirfhis diesbeziiglich zu einer plausiblen Vorstellung zu gelangen wohl gefiiklt hatte, spricht sick dariiber folgeudermassen aus : " v. Graff's supposition tkat tke young Myzostomes associate in pairs aud together take part in forming a gall seems to me hardly plausible. Judging from my observations on M. ijlabrum and pulvinar, both of which show a distinct tendency to occur in pairs, each consisting of a senior and junior individual, I believe tkat in tke case of tke cysticolous species tke gall must be formed by a single individual, and tkat later a young Myzostome, wkeii it abandons its pelagic trockopkore stage, must enter through tke aperture of tke gall and settle down to a quiet life witk tke senior individual. Tke latter probably dies at tke end of its female stage, and, undergoing decomposition, may perhaps serve as food for its still vigorous junior partner. This one in turn may thereupon become the senior partner of another young Myzostome. and so on. According to this view, all the r >/*//< Wc//x Myzostomes of a given species would not bo <•//*/-///-,»///<•///. 6. R. RITTER v. Sxi'.M.MEU-TuAT'Ni'HLS. Beitrilge zur Anatomic und Histologic der Myzostomeu : I. Myzostoma asteriae Marcnz. Zeitschr. f. wissensch. Zoolog. LXXV. (l'J) ; von der Yentralseite gesehen. Man erkenut die dellenformig einge- buchtete Stelle, an welcher das Mannchen gesessen liatte. Yergr. 10-facb. FIG. 5. — Mannchen (ans Cyste «) ; von der Yentralseite her abgebildet. Das Exemplar ist rostro-caudal etwas contrahiert. Yergr. 27i-fach. FIG. 6. — Weibcben (ans Cyste a). Medianer Liingsschnitt. Yergr. 11-fach. FIG. 7. — Weibchen (au3 Cyste &). Etwas sthief zur Liingsaxe ausgefallener Querschnitt in der die mittleren (dritten) Parapodien verbindenden Trausversauebtne. Von den beiden Ovarien der linken Korperseite ist nnr das riickwiirtige, von den beiden Hoden nur der linke getroffeu. Vergr. 32-fach. FIG. 8. — Weibchen (aus Cyste i). Hinter dern vorigen, in der Gegend der Nephridialcaniile gefiihrter Querschuitt. Nur der reuhte Nephridialcanal ist in demselben getroffen. Vergr. 32-fach. FIG. 9 und 10.— Manuchen (aus Cyste b). Aus Flachenschnitten combinirte und etwas schematisirte Teilbilder. In Fig. 0 sind die mehr dorsal gelegenen Organe, wie der Eruiihrungsapparat, der milnnlicbe Geschlechtsappurat uud'der Dorsalabschnitt des weiblicbeu Geschlechtsapparates, ferner die Xephrostomata dargestellt. Fig. 10 zeigt den A'entralabschnitt des weiblichen Geschlechts- apparates mit den Ovarien, ferncr die Eudblasen mil dern uupaaren Eudabsclmitte der Xephridien. Zwischen den Nephrostornatis (tis in Fig. 9), und den in Fig. 10 mit * bezeichneten Durch- scbnittsstellen durch die Xephridien verlaufen in dorsoventraler Eichtung die kurzcn Xephridial- caniile. Yergr. fiir beidu Fig. 79-fach. 6o' ao .ns Aut del MYZOSTOMA. SIPUNCULOIDEA. By W. F. LANCHESTEI;, M.A., King's College, Cambridge. I 'MA si i H.OSOMA SOC'IUM. THLS collection consists of some thirty specimens, all of small size, which were mostly taken )>y means of a net from holes in the ire. while the 'Discovery' was in Winter Quarters. One specimen, however, was captured with the dredge, the depth being given as 100 fathoms. That the bulk of them belong to a single species of Phascolosoma is quite certain, both from their general appearance and from a study of the relations of the various organs, though it is to be noted that these relations have been found to be far from invariable. Some half-a-dozen, however, have been the cause of considerable difficulty in the exact determination of their specific identity ; yet it has seemed best to include them under the above species. In the first place, they agree in the main details of their structure with the typical forms; and I have not been able to place them without hesitation under any of the other closely allied species (sub-species or varieties) which centre round the Arctic Ph. margaritaceum, namelv. Ph. antarcticum, c. three times as high as wide) ; in Ph. fuscum, he only says that they are ''bis '07 mm. laug, also nicht gauz so laug wie die entsprechendeu von Ph. antareticum" but the comparison of absolute lengths where the difference is so small is valueless, assuming the proportions to be the same ; so that we can only conclude that they are practically identical in the two species of Michaelsen in regard to this point. Now in our species the papillae in some individuals show this ratio of 3 : 1, but in others the ratio of the height is less (2*5 : 1, 2*25 : 1, 2 : 1). In Pit. georgianum the introvert is only half the length of the body, and the papillae arc much longer than in the other species quoted ; and these points, taken along with other smaller differences, seem to clearly separate our form from it. From Ph. Id gen*? Fischer, these specimens are very little distinct ; but this form is itself hardly to be distinguished from Ph. antareticum. The thinness and clear colouration seem to be the main distinction in most of the specimens ; and in all of them the relative unimportance of the system of striation on the hind end. In Pit. lagense, moreover, the segmental organs are as long as half the body. I subjoin a list of measurements taken from a few of the specimens ; the sign " S.O." is meant to indicate the " opening of the segmental organ," and the measurements are in millimetres and taken as accurately as the conditions would permit. The letters A, B, etc., correspond to different localities, while the figures 1, 2, 3, etc., merely indicate different specimens. At the same time it may be pointed out that the A and B specimens are all obviously of one type, viz., thin-skinned and straw-coloured, while those marked E and F are those that I have already mentioned as differing from the rest in general fades, viz., dark in colour and apparently thicker-skinned. The most remarkable difference is to be found in the specimen marked E 2. Here the extended introvert is much longer than the body, 26 • 3 mm. and 8 • 5 mm. On the other hand, in the one marked El, which presents all the general facies SIPUNCULOIDEA. From and to S.O. Distance of retractor origins from S.O. Number of Distance of Length of— Body. Introvert. Dorsal. Ventral. tary canal. auus from S.O. Al 19 22 8 19 1 A 2 1 1; • :, 17-:. 2 7 21 •j:. A3 18 15 2-25 7-7:> I'M 1 A4 1 1 • :< 13-5 2 l'7.'i 17 • 2:. A:. l :, • :, 17-:. 2-:> 1-7:. is l A 6 in 18 2 5 2:. •25 AT 10-5 s 1-25 4-25 17 •25 Bl 21 22 :! 9-5 Hi "5 B2 12 15 •i :, in - 5 E l 9 in 2 6-25 ? EL' ,x • ;> 26-5 l-7.'i 3-5 21 F 1 14 11-5 1-25 4 11-12 and the same internal structure as in E 2, together with closely similar papillae, the retracted introvert is shorter than the body, 14 mm. : 11-5 mm. In El, moreover, the dorsal retractors originate from a point half-way between the opening of the segmental organ and the ventral retractor, while in E 2 they originate at a position only one-third approximately (as in the other specimens) of the distance between these two points. It is a little difficult to see how to deal with those anomalies satisfactorily ; and I have preferred to consider these two provisionally as within the limits of the present species. In two of the specimens I find the segmental organs reaching about as far again beyond the insertion of the retractors. A spindle muscle, not attached to the hind end, is generally present, though in one or two cases I have not been quite able to decide as to its presence or absence. In two cases I have found two distinct muscles attaching the front portion of the gut to the body-wall; in the other cases I have seen no muscles at all, though it seems quite possible that they may easily be torn, and so escape notice, in these small specimens. The following list of localities and notes may be added :— A. in specimens .... Winter Quarters. I. is. 03. No. 12 Hole. I) net. S. of Hut Point. 2.")-30 fins. 100 yds. B. 2 specimens ... „ 28. ii. 02. Up to In fins. C. 3 specimens .... „ ,. ll.xi. 02. I) net. Hut Point. 6 W. F. LANCHESTER. D. 1 specimen .... Winter Quarters. 17. i. 03. Flagon Point. 102 fins. Dredge. E. 4 specimens .... „ „ 2!). viii. 03. Same as A. F. 4 specimens .... ,, „ 3. ii. 04. D net. Hut Point. G. 1 specimen . . . . ,, ,, 19. iii. 02. D net. Hut Point. H. 3 specimens .... „ „ 19. xi. 02. D net. Hut Point. K. 1 specimen .... „ „ 19. iii. 02. Up to 10 fms. Finally, reference should be made to a very brief preliminary description of Phascolosoma charcoti, obtained by the Charcot Expedition, and described by M. Marcel Herubel in the "Bulletin du Mus. d'Hist. Nat," 1906, p. 127, together with Ph. fuseum and Ph. antarcticum. Since Ph. charcoti is there said to resemble Ph. georgianum closely, I do not think our species can be synonymous with it. On the other hand, we are told, in regard to the skin of Ph. charcoti, that it is "a peu pres lisse," with " quelques papilles espacees et petites"; in which it both resembles our species and differs from Ph. georgianum, of which Michaelsen says, " Der ganze Korper ist mit grossen dunklen Papillen besetzt." This discrepancy in one point may not invalidate its general resemblance to Ph. georgianum, but, combined with the brevity of the diagnosis, it makes it impossible to assert similarity or the reverse as between our form and Ph. Charcoti. COELENTEBA. IV.-ACTINI/E. BY JOSEPH A. CLUBB, M.Sc. (3 Plates.) THE Actiuiau collection of tlie ' Discovery ' Expedition consisted of upwards of fifty specimens, which have been allocated to eight species, representing six genera and four families. With two exceptions, all were taken at or near to the Winter Quarters, McMuido Bay. The two exceptions * are Port Harris, Falkland Islands, containing two species, and Enderby Island, Auckland Islands, containing one species, and from both places a considerable number of specimens, more than half the total, was obtained. The specimens were for the most part in a fair state of preservation, but I must express regret that no memoranda were made of the colours of the living animals. In the preserved condition absolutely no trace of colour remains, and while admitting that anatomical characters are the only sure guide in Actiuological studies, the colours of living Actiniaus, when known, serve at least as a valuable clue to identification with the species of the older authorities, who give very little but external characters as their diagnoses. The work has been carried on in the laboratories of the Liverpool Museums, and I have again to express my thanks to the Museums Committee for permission to use apparatus, etc. , and to Dr. Forbes, the Director of Museums, for other facilities. FAMILY ACTINIID.dE, Gosse, 1858. ACTINIARIA with an adherent base ; column wall smooth or provided with verrucas, but never with hollow vesicular outgrowths ; sphincter muscle endodermal, generally diffuse and weak ; tentacles simple ; margin smooth or provided with simple acroragi ; mesenteries in several cycles, of which usually more than one is perfect : longitudinal muscles of tentacles usually diffuse ; no acoiitia. Genus PARANTHEOPSIS, McMurrich. Actinudse without acroragi, but with conspicuous verrucas on flic distal portion of the column ; no collar, but the margin a distinct parapet, within which is a well-marked fosse; tentacles of moderate length and rather slender, capable nf being concealed in contraction ; sphincter diffuse. * These forms arc so interesting that, after some consideration. I hiive allowed tln-ir niti-mrr into this report. — ED. JOSEPH A. CLUBB. PARANTHEOPSIS CRUENTATA. Actinia, rruentata Conthouy in Dana., U.S. Exploring Expedition, Zoophytes* (1S4R), p. 138, PI. 3, Figs. 23 and 23A. t'l-ri'iix n-tifittritiis Milne Edwards, Hist. Nat. Corall. (1857), 1, p. 2G8. Bit nodes cruentata Gosse, Actinologia Britannica (1860), p. 194. Verrill, Trans. Connect. Acad. (186!)), 1, p. 467. Andres, Fauna und Flora des Golfes von Neapel (1884), p. 215. Comlylactis cruentata McMurrich, Scientific Results of Explorations U.S. Fish Commission Steamer 'Albatross' (1893) p. 15<). Carlgren, Zoantharien, Hamb. Maghal. Samrael. (1898), p. lo, Figs. 13 and 14. Parantheopsis cruentata McMurrich, Zoolog. Jabrb. Suppl. VI. (1905), p. 233. I have adopted the course taken by McMurrich (10, p. 233), and place this species, previously known as Condylactis cruentata, under this genus. Six specimens were taken by the ' Discovery ' at Port Harris, Falkland Islands, along with a number of specimens of Bunodes octoradiatus. In my description of the latter species (p. 7) I refer to the extreme similarity in external appearance of these two species. The largest specimen measures 2 • 5 cm. in height of column and 1 • 5 cm. in diameter. Proximally the body-wall is longitudinally grooved, corresponding to the insertion of the mesenteries ; distally the corrugations are replaced by distinct rows of verrucaj. The papillfe or pseudoacroragi terminating the rows have no trace of nematocysts, and are simply outgrowths of the body-wall, being essentially identical in structure (PI. 1, Fig. 3) with it. They vary considerably in size in different individuals, evidently depending on their state of contraction. In the specimen from which the section figured (PI. 1, Fig. 1) is taken the pseudoacroragi are much inflated. Considerable variation exists in the number of tentacles. The largest specimen has 48 tentacles (6 + G + 12 + 24), the smallest has only 26, and an intermediate size 32. This certainly suggests that the adult condition is hexamerous, and that any octamerous condition is simply a stage in development and transitory, as Carlgren supposes. No sphincter muscle is developed, there being no indication in transverse sections through the parapet and adjoining body-wall of any modifications more than the ordinary muscle bands found generally (PI 1, Fig. 1). The. circular muscles of the body-wall are moderately developed, and the mesogloeal layer is relatively thick (PI. 1, Fig. 1). The longitudinal muscles of the tentacles and oral disc are ectodermal, and the longitudinal and parieto-basilar muscles of the mesenteries are well marked. FAMILY PARACTID.E, E. Hertwig, 1882. ACTINIARIA with a mesodermal .sphincter muscle ; no acontia ; mesenteries arranged in several cycles, of which usually more than one is perfect ; longitudinal muscles of the mesenteries usually diffuse ; column wall usually smooth, sometimes with sub- marginal plication and solid ridges : no acroragi. * Dana (Amer. J. Sci. (2| i. (1S46|. p. 178| cites his Zoophyte work as of this year ; the copy in the Zool. 1'ept. ol the Museum bears date 1848. — ED. A< TI.M.K. Genus PAKACTIS. Paractidae with thin and smooth column wall ; tentacles of moderate length and of uniform thickness throughout : margin not lobed ; individual mesenteries of cadi paii' cojiiallv developed. PAKACTIS I-OI.AKIS. One specimen labelled " Winter Quarters, 24. 8. 03," and taken in 25-30 fathoms (PI. 1. Fig. 2). Height of column 2'3 cru. ; diameter of foot-disc 35 cm., diameter of oral disc '2'5 cm. Tentacles of uniform size, about 0'-'! cm. long, in four cycles 12+12 + 24 + 48 = fM>. The base is adhesive and thin, the insertions of the mesenteries being visible through it. It is produced all round wider than the column, which narrows considerably. The bodv-wall is firm, and near the parapet somewhat thick, where it is slightly puckered by contraction. The mouth opening is visible in the centre of the tentacles, crowded together bv contraction. The oesophagus is plicated and the two siphonoglyphs are well marked. The sphincter is fairlv strong, tuesogloeal, and produced to a tine termination. A transverse section (PI. 1 , Fig. 3) shows that it lies nearer to the endoderni. and is reticulate in appearance, giving indistinct traces of layering. (ireatcr details of structure are given in Fig. 4. The mesenteries are membranous, and the longitudinal muscles are somewhat diffuse, but well marked (PI. 1, Fig. 5). The meso1), in his comments on the genus /'. fit. /'in-ai-tix /Hi/inrrf Milne Kilwank-s, p. :M'.i, Imn. tit. A single specimen labelled '' McMurdo Bay, Winter Quarters, 20 fathoms," only slightly contracted, with tentacles, oral disc and resophageal opening plainly visible, the last-named being 1*5 cm. in diameter. -1 JOSEPH A. CLUBB. The height of body-wall is 4' 5 cm., diameter of column 5'5 cm., and of oral disc very slightly less. The body-wall is quite smooth and extremely membranous, giving the animal quite an inflated appearance. The upper margin is slightly crenulated by contraction of the sphincter ; the pedal disc is adherent and a little firmer and thicker than the body-wall ; the oral disc has slight radiating folds running outwards, up to and between the tentacles ; the oesophagus is strongly corrugated, and the two siphonoglyphs are visible, but not markedly distinct. The tentacles are stout, in four cycles (12 + 12-1-24-1-48 = 96); in the innermost cycle about 1 cm. long in the contracted condition, and diminishing slightly in length in the outer cycles. The sphincter is mesogloeal, occupying almost the whole of the mesogloeal layer, and projecting as a distinct collar, with the ectoderinal epithelium, and forming a deep fosse between it and the tentacles. Fig. 7 on PI. 2 shows a radial section through the sphincter. The muscles of the oral disc (PI. 2, Fig. 7) and tentacles (PI. 2, Fig. 8) are mesogloeal. The longitudinal muscles of the mesenteries are in the form of slender strands, which may be seen running more or less parallel to each other over the extremely delicate and membranous mesenteries. In transverse section (PI. 2, Fig. 11) it is seen that the mesogloea is extremely thin throughout, but is slightly thickened and bears short slightly branched lamellas for the muscle strands. The parieto-basilar muscle is small and insignificant. Two cycles of mesenteries are complete, and the pairs of directive mesenteries bear the usual relation to the siphouoglyphs. All the complete mesenteries are fertile, including . the directives, and ova in various stages are seen (PI. 2, Fig. 9), and a figure is given of a section of the somewhat characteristic mesenterial filaments (PI. 2, Fig. 10). I have identified this specimen with Paractis papaver, the Actinia paparer of Drayton, briefly described and figured by Dana (4, p. 143, PI. 4). Genus ACTINOSTOLA, Verrill. Paractidaj usually of large size, with a firm leathery wall, which may be corrugated or folded, but with no verrucas Margin tentaculate. Tentacles relatively thick, and not enlarged at the base. The pairs of mesenteries in certain cycles are unequally developed, having one of each pair smaller and narrower than the other. ACTINOSTOLA CHILENSIS. Actinostola chilensis McMnrrich, Zoolog. Jahrb., Supp. VI. (Fauna Chilensis Hi.), (1905), p. 247, Pis. 15 and 16, Figs. 30-33. Five specimens of large size contained in one bottle labelled " 4.3.04, 254 fathoms, mud and stones." The locality is not stated on the label, but I am informed that the position was 67° 21' 46" S. and 155° 21' 10" E. The specimens vary greatly in form and size. One specimen measures 5 '5 cm. in height and 4 cm. in diameter of column ; another is 4 cm. only in height, but 6 cm. in diameter. The wall is firm and leathery, smooth to the touch, and no verrucas or tubercles ACTINLE. 5 are present ; hut irregular shallow f'urmws are formed by contraction in these preserved specimens. In all cases the tentacles are exposed, and they agree generally with the description given by McMurrich, in his account of the species (10, p. 247) from a specimen from Calbuco, both as regards number and arrangement and relative size. The oesophagus is generally widely expanded, and in the majority of the specimens is almost indistinguishable from the portion of the oral disc inside the tentacles. But in one of the more contracted specimens the lip of the oesophagus is easily distinguished, but the corrugations are continued radially over the oral disc, running between and a short distance up the bases of the tentacles. The siphonoglyphs are iii no case well marked. The foot-disc is well-marked and strongly adherent. The more minute anatomy agrees generally with McMurrich's description. The mesogloea of the body-wall is variable in thickness, and in one specimen, just below the sphincter, is nearly 2 mm. thick, from which in an upward direction it thins rapidly to less than 1 mm. The mesogloeal sphincter exhibits no trace of layering, having a simple reticulate strueture iu transverse section. Transverse sections of the tentacles exhibit the same appearance of portions of the ectodermal epithelium being cut off and apparently enclosed in the mesogloea, as described by McMurrich, due to contraction and the unusual thickness of the mesogloeal layer. The mesenteries in number and arrangement agree with McMurrich's descrip- tion, but I cannot confirm the hermaphroditic condition described for the specie.-. In the specimen selected for histological work no spermatozoa were found, and the ova were large and well-developed. Otherwise the ' Discovery ' specimens agree well with McMurrich's description, and I have no hesitation in placing them under this species. FAMILY ALICIID/E. DUERDEN (1895). ACTINIARIA with a large, flat, contractile base. Tentacles simple, cylindrical and entacmseous. Column wall with simple or compound hollow tubereles or vesicles, covering the greater part of the column, arranged mostly in vertical rows. Sphincter muscle endodermal and diffuse, variable in amount of development. No ciuclides or aeontia, margin with or without acroragi. Mesenteries arranged in several cycles of which usually more than one is perfect. Genus CYSTIMTIS, M. Edw. Aliciidas having the column covered with simple vesicles. Tentacles of variable length, in one, two, or three cycles. Numerous perfect mesenteries ; sphincter muscle moderately well developed. ( 'YSTIAGTIS ANTARCTICA. A single specimen, bearing the label " McMurdo Bay, "Winter Quarters, 28.2.02." Depth, 20 fathoms. z 2 f, JOSEPH A. CLUBB. External characters — Height of body-wall 5 '75 cm., diameter of column 4 cm., diameter of oral disc 3 cm., diameter of pedal disc (contracted condition) 2 '75 cm. There is no trace of distinctive coloration in the preserved specimen, and no record on the collector's label. The single specimen is poorly preserved, and owing to the thin and delicate body-wall is quite collapsed. The column is studded with thin-walled simple vesicles (PL 2, Fig. 12) communicating with the coeleuteron and arranged in twenty-four vertical and parallel rows, corresponding to the niesenteric spaces. The attachment of the mesenteries ma}' be seen in places, between the rows of vesicles. The vesicles of adjacent rows are arranged alternately, and they increase in size from the proximal to the distal portion of the column (PL 2, Fig. 12), where the largest are not much inferior in size to and do not differ much in appearance from the tentacles in the preserved and contracted specimen. The tentacles are twenty-four in number, arranged in two cycles of equal size, short and somewhat club-shaped. The largest measures O1 5 cm. in length. The oral disc is slightly furrowed radially and the mouth is large and bears a well-marked hypostome. The oesophagus is short and strongly plicated, and two deep and well-marked siphouoglyphs are present, and are continued some distance below the rest of the cesophagus as distinct lappets. The coelenterou is large, and twelve pairs of mesenteries, all complete, are present. Two pairs of directive mesenteries bear the usual relation with the siphonoglyphs. The single specimen taken is poorly preserved and much of the histological detail is lost. The sphincter is diffuse and endodermal in character, with slightly projecting mesogloeal lamellae shown in transverse section (PL 2, Fig. 13). The muscles of the tentacles are ectoderrnal. The muscles of the body-wall (PL 2, Fig. 14) are feeble, and sections through the vesicles show a similar structure. The ectoderm and endoderm layers consist of relatively high columnar cells (PL 2, Figs. 13 and 14); but the mesogloea is thin. The mesenteries are very thin and delicate,' but transverse sections show a weak but well-marked longitudinal muscle (PL 2, Fig. 14), the mesogloea in relation with it being thickened and possessing short branching lamellae. The parieto-basilar muscle is small (PI. 2, Fig. 14). The specimen is female, and ovaries are found on all mesenteries, including directives, forming broad bands occupying in their widest portions about a third of the width of the mesenteries. Ova in all stages of development (PL 2, Figs. 14 and IS) are present. FAMILY CRIBRINID^E, McMurrich, (1901.) ACTINIARIA with a well-developed circumscribed endodermal sphincter ; simple tentacles ; without cinclides and acontia ; verrucas usually present ; adherent base ; no true acroragi, but frequently pseudoacroragi present. ACTixi.r.. CKIBRINA. Cribrinida: with strong endodermal sphincter; frequently with pseudoacroragi ; ectodermal musculature of discs and tentacles not imbedded in the mesogloea ; column wall provided with verruca? arranged more or less distinctly in vertical rows : tentacles simple. CRIBRIXA OLTORADIATA. liiniin/fK t>i-ti>ni'tii'tiis Ciirlgren, Hamburg. MagalhaenB. Sammelreise, Zoanth. MSIINI. ],. i>n. i-'j.jx. n ;uid 12, 1898. This species was formed by ( 'arlgren (1, p. 20) for a number of specimens taken from the Straits of Magellan and other localities in the South Seas. In one of the 'Discovery' bottles. Iain-lied "Falkland Islands, Port Harris/' were fourteen specimens of very similar-looking Actinians. Upon dissection and microscopical examination. however, I find two distinct species — Bnn<«lrriini <«•/,, Fig. 17) show strong mesogloeal lamella;. The longitudinal muscles of the mesenteries and the paricto-basilar muscles are exceedingly large and strong, and in the ci,nir;lHed specimens are closely packed into a solid mass, so that the various organs are quite dovetailed together (PL 3, Fig. 18). The mesogloeal lamella? of the muscles are long and branched. The circular muscles of the body-wall too are very strong. The strength of the musculature generally is quite a feature of the species. JOSEPH A. CLUBB. But the most interesting character of these specimens from the Falkland Islands is the presence of " brood pouches." Immediately below the pseudoacroragi is a well- marked constriction of the body-wall, also present, it is interesting to note, in Punui- theopsix cruentata. In this constriction, in the species under consideration, specimens were found possessing sixteen pores, one pore to each line of verrucae, leading into distinct invagiuations of the body-wall, forming characteristic " brood pouches " in the coelenteron. These " brood pouches " agree in all essential points with the arrangement shown to be present in the ' Southern Cross ' specimens (3, p. 299). The drawing (PI. 3, Fig. 16) shows a section of the body-wall, passing through one of these pores, and the " brood chamber " into which it opens. The three layers of the body-wall may be distinctly traced as shown, each of them much thinner — the mesogloea markedly so. Usually each "brood chamber" contains two embryos only, and in the section figured they are well advanced, showing several of the mesenteries complete and others well developed. Dissections were made so that, looked at from below, the sixteen " brood pouches " were seen like so many miniature grapes, lying quite regularly in the body cavity, between the mesenteries. In diameter they average about 3 mm. In the short description of the species by Carlgreu (1, p. 20) no mention of them is made. It is somewhat remarkable if none of Carlgren's specimens possess these "brood pouches," and possibly re-examination may show their presence in some. CRIBRINA HERMAPHRODITICA. llanodfs hermaphroditicus Carlgren, Hamburg. Magalhacns. Sammelreise, Zoantli. (1898), p. 23, Fig. 18, 1898. About forty specimens from " Enderby Island, Auckland Islands, 19. 3. 04" of sizes ranging from 0 • 3 cm. to 2 cm. in height of column. In some cases the oral disc and tentacles are fully exposed, in others the animals are contracted so that the tentacles are entirely hidden, and there are many intermediate stages of contraction. The foot-disc is well marked and strongly adherent. The rows of principal verrucas, usually twenty-four in number, are well seen, especially on the distal portion of the column, where also secondary alternating series are visible. The pseudo- acroragi, terminating each principal row of verrucas, are distinct, emphasizing greatly the parapet. The tentacles are in four (6 + 6 + 12 + 24 = 48), or five (6 + 6 + 12 + 24 + 48 = 96) cycles. The sphincter is endodermal and circumscribed. The oesophagus is longitudinally folded, and two well-marked siphonoglyphs are present. The mesenteries in the specimens examined are all hexamerously arranged, and in the larger specimens in four cycles, of which three are complete. The longitudinal and parieto-basilar muscles (PI. 3, Fig. 19) are well developed. Two pairs of directive mesenteries bear the usual relation with the siphonoglyphs. The longitudinal muscles of the oral disc and tentacles (PL 3, Fig. 21) are ectodermal. Zoanthellse occur throughout the endoderm, being especially abundant in the tentacles (PL 3, Fig. 21). Reproductive elements ACTIXLK. 9 arc present in relation with the mesenteries of the first cycle in small specimens, including direct ivcs, and iu large specimens, with the mesenteries of two cycles ; liut I was not able to determine to my satisfaction if present in relation with the third complete cycle. Both ova and spermatozoa are present, often associated together in relation with the same mesentery (PI. 3, Fig. 19). Occasionally fertile mesenteries are found showing ova or spermatozoa alone, but in all the specimens examined microscopically the hermaphroditic condition is constant. Embryos in various stages of development are present in the body-cavities of nianv. (icnus Until (ACTINIA, Agassiz. Cribrinidu3 (Tealiidae, Bunodidre, Bunodactidse), with well-developed foot disc; distinct verrucfe present on body-wall ; radial muscles of oral disc and longi- tudinal muscles of the tentacles meso-ectodermal to mesogloeal ; tentacles simple ; strongly circumscribed endodermal sphincter. RHODACTINIA rKAssicoiiNis. Aiii /i in i-nixxii-nniix MiilkT, Prod. Zool. Dan. (177f>), p. 231. Aiiiiiiii. I'li'iimitixxiiiiii. ]5rauilt, Prod. duscriptionis animnliuni ab H. Mertcnsio oWrvarormn ( ix:?5), p. i:;. niiiiiliii-tiiiin ilnrixii Agassi/,, I,., Complus Reiidus, XXV. (1847), p. (i77. Uliniliiiiiiiiii ilnrixii Yen-ill, A. E., Mem. Hoc. Nat. Hist. Boston (1Ki/.:/irr//i-/ixis Kwk'tniewski, Zoo]. Jahrb. (Syst.) (1SI1K), p. 1, p. 121. Carlgren in 1902, in his report on "Die Actiniarien der Ulga Expedition" (2, p. 39), thought it necessary to revive the old genus of Agassiz, Illi<>-///.v Carlgren places a number of .synonyms, including Aiiinin elegantissima, Brandt, and Leiotealia spitzbergensis, Kwietniewski. 1 have previously been struck with the variation iu the degree in which the muscles of the tentacles are imbedded in the mesogloea, in specimens of <:ri/*x/<-i>riiix examined by me, from a well-known local habitat. Ililbre Island, at the mouth of the Dee. The text-figures (2, p. 41) given by Carlgren are most instructive, and from llillire Island specimens I can produce examples in which the longitudinal muscles are quite as much meso-ectodermal as Carlgren's figure 4, if not as much as his Fig. 3. In my examination of the 'Southern Cross' Antarctic Actinians (3, p. 294), I was convinced of the many close resemblances to the type species crassicornis, seen in the specimens then under observation ; and notwithstanding that the longitudinal muscles of the tentacles were not imbedded in the mesogloea, I decided to include these species under the genus /"/•//>///ai-li>/rrlieries, so as to form an incomplete arch over a sub-dermal space or channel. A small "silica pearl" was found in one section. Numerous large ova occur, with oval body and thick pseudopodia-like extensions, the body being 130 X '65^, and the total diameter over 300/n. In some instances. the ova are more rounded and compact, with the cytoplasm more drawn together. I had described the specimens as representatives of a new species, but I now find that they belong to < 'nmiJIn viyitta (Lendenfeld). Dr. v. Lendenfeld very kindly sent me the revised proofs of his Report ''Tetraxonia der deutschen Siidpolar-Expedition, 1901-1903,'' thus enabling me to make the necessarv alterations before it was too late. 4 R. KIRKPATRTCK. The 'Gauss' Expedition obtained six specimens, which are all young and small, being from 2-10 mm. in diameter. The difference in the size of the megascleres of the 'Discovery' and 'Gauss' specimens may be attributed to differences in the age and size of the specimens : but the difference in the size of the sigmata of the two sets of specimens is more notable — those of the ' Gauss' being 14-20/x, and of the 'Discovery ' being only 12 '3^ to 13 p. in length as viewed in the C aspect. In my opinion difference in size of sigmata has not the importance that is sometimes attached to it. All the specimens were dredged in the neighbourhood of Winter Quarters in depths of 10-130 fms. Also ' Gauss' Expedition, near its Winter Quarters, 350-385 m. CRANIELLA SAGITTA var. pachyrrhabdus. (PL VIII., figs. 14, 15 ; PI. IX., figs. 17, 18, 19.) 1907. Ti'tli/n sriflit/it. Lendenfeld (lla. p. Sue). This variety is represented by several oblong pieces about 6 cm. in length, deeply blackened by osmic acid, and forming part of a large sponge, which had been cut up for preservation in that reagent. The fragments are sufficient to show that the surface of the sponge was covered with a spicular pile about 4 mm. in height. Mr. Hodgson informs me that the bulk of the specimen was lost. He was under the impression that this sponge, which was obtained from the same locality as the var. microsigma, and which resembled the latter in general appearance, was identical with it in all its characters. An examination of a section, however, shows that the radiating fibres of the skeleton contain numerous large thick strongyles and styles, about 7 x O'llG mm. in dimensions (VIII. figs. 14, 15); the sigmata are 18-20 /x long, and slightly thicker and rougher than in the var. microsigma. Plate IX. figs. 18, 19 show collar cells, stained in gentian violet. The cells are here seen to be separate, and the collars apparently not coalescent ; but the tissues are not very well preserved ; and, though much care was taken in the drawing, a renewed inspection of the preparation from which the illustrations were drawn has shown that the figures of the collars are not satisfactory. The flagellated chambers usually contain only a few collar cells in the normal position (IX. 17), the rest forming detached masses in the centre of the chambers. The flagellum originates from the end of the large oval nucleus, which is situated a little below the surface of the body of the cell. Locality. Winter Quarters, Hut Point, 25 fnis. CRANIELLA LEPTODERMA. (Plate XI., figs. 4-14.) isss. Tetillaleptoderma8oliaa(2l. p. 3). Sponge, club-shaped or pyriform ; with verruculate surface ; with one large oscule near the summit ; with root-tuft. Surface pile of spicules absent in the adult state, and only slightly developed in early stages, large protriaenes being very rare or absent. TKTKAA'oXIDA. 5 SpiculeS. .Megascleres. 1. Large oxeas, !)• 7 X 0' 081 mm. 2. Smaller oxeas, scattered in the choanosome, 540 to 1350/x in length. 3. Cortical oxeas (XI. 8), 770 x 30 n, straight, fusiform. 4. Anatriaenes of three kinds: a. (XI. 9) Cladi 170 n long x 20 p thick at base, slender, sharp-pointed, chorda llOju; rhabdome, about 12mm. long, thick at junction with cladome, then tapering, again thickening, and finally terminating in a filiform extremity. !>. (XI. 11) Cladome with thick conical dadi, 140 X 35 p., chorda 60 //. ; rhabdome with a thick neck, and then nearly uniform till it tapers to a filiform extremity. c. (XI. 10) Cladome with very long, straight, slender cladi, 150 x 10 p, nearlv parallel with, or making an angle of, about 10° with the rhabdome, chorda only 31 p. : rhabdome slender (of uncertain length). 5. Protriaenes. Rare, usually with three slender equal cladi, 90 /A long ; rhabdome of nearly uniform diameter : but slightly diminishing near the cladome. G. Triehodal protriaeues, usually (especially in the case of those forming the inner oscular fringe) with one ray greatly prolonged to 140 p. or more, the other two having almost disappeared ; rhabdome slightly thickened at cladal origin. 7. Sigmata, 14-25 to 15 /j. long, 0'75/x thick, and 12'3/n broad in the c aspect, with slightly and finely granulated surface. There are three specimens of this sponge, the largest (XI. 4) being 12 cm. in total length and 5 '2 cm. in breadth, with a root-tuft 3' 5 cm. in length: the second specimen (XL 5) is oval, 2'9 cm. long and 1'7 cm. broad, and the smallest is U! x 12 mm. The colour of the first two is dirty gray, and that of the last pale but}'. The scale-like, occasionally over-lapping, verrucae, attain a height o|' 2 nun., and a breadth at the base of 4 mm. The oscule is oval-shaped, edged with a barely visible fringe of tridiodal protriaenes ; it measures, in the large specimen, 7'5 x 5 mm. The skeleton. The radiating fibres only vcrv rarely project beyond the surface : near the oscule are a few tufts of oxeas. Uver the rest of the surface of the sponge, the dermal membrane covers over the summits of the verrucae, the distal points of oxeas and the cladomes of anatriaeues showing through ; medium-sized in large protriaenes, so abundant in < 'r<n section, the ectosome is scarcely differentiate,! from the choanosome, excepting that sub-dermal spaces are visible just beneath the dermal membrane. The cortical oxeas are more densely packed than in the preceding species. A tangential section shows the pores in longitudinal areas between the densely serried rows of cortical oxeas, and fan-like tufts of trichodal protriaeues supporting the 6 R. KIKKPATKICK. sieve-like pore-areas ; the pore-areas are distributed over the surface up to the neighbourhood of the oscule. Caual System. The pores lead into sub-dermal channels whence canals descend into the choanosome. The flagellated chambers are eurypylous. Small ova, 60 x 30 ^u, with pseudopodic-like processes, occur in the largest specimen. A young Specimen is pear-shaped with a granular surface, and without a root-tuft. Each " granule " is a sharp-pointed conule, with a protriaene projecting from it. The young specimen of Craniella sagitta has a very different appearance, being quite fluffy on the surface owing to the numerous tufts of protriaenes. Specimens were obtained from : (1) West of Balleney Island in 254 fins., Type specimen (XL 4) ; (2) W.Q., Flagon Point, 10-20 fms. ; (3) W.Q., Hut Point, 25 fins. The ' Challenger ' dredged specimens off Rio de la Plata, 600 fms. ClNACHYRA BARBATA. (Plate IX., figs. 1-14.) 1888. Cinachym larbata Sollas (21. p. 23. Pis. III., XXXIX.). 190G. CinacJujra barliata Kirkpatrick (10. p. 602. PL XIV.). Twenty-seven specimens of this sponge, varying in diameter from a few millimetres up to 14 centimetres, were obtained. In addition to these, the collection includes a massive root-tuft no less than 32 cm. across and 12 cm. in thickness, belonging to what must have been a very large specimen, for the concavity into which the latter fitted occupies nearly the whole area of the upper surface of the root-tuft. The largest specimen obtained by the ' Challenger ' — from Kerguelen — was 10 cm. in its longest diameter. As in the case of the ' Challenger ' specimens there is a considerable variation in the shape, which is usually spheroidal ; some specimens are spherical, the nucleus of the radiating bundles of the skeleton being exactly central, others again resemble an inverted cone, and very young specimens are oval. An interesting feature shown in adult specimens is the division of the sponge into three zones, viz., (1) a basal root-tuft zone; (2) an equatorial zone of porocalyces ; and (3) a polar zone of oscules. These zones are clearly perceptible in the fine series of well-preserved Antarctic specimens, but are not so well marked in those obtained by the ' Challenger.' The surface pile of spicules in the porocalycal zone is longer and looser than in the oscular zone, and directed obliquely downwards ; but the pile in the oscular area is shorter, and more vertical and stubble-like. The root-tuft. A remarkable feature about the root-tuft is its great size in some specimens, in which it may be much more bulky than the sponge body ; TETRAXOXIDA. 7 generally, however, it is of smaller size than the body, especially in large and old specimens. The porocalyces. In adult specimens the porocalyces form a broad belt round the sides of the body. A few, in large specimens, were nearly 2 '5 em. (one inch) in depth. Ae I have already stated (10. p. 662) the porocalyces are, in all species of Cinachyra, inhalant areas perforated by true dermal pores, and are never exhalant or oscular. The OSCllleS. In Cinachyra iinrlmta these structures are arranged in an obscurely spiral manner on the upper or " polar " surface of the sponge in adult specimens. In almost every instance, the oscules are tightly contracted, the spicular fringe being closed over them in form of a conical stack. It is this strong contractibility that has led to their being overlooked in most of the species of this genus, the porocalyces having been regarded as partly inhalant and partly exhalant. The oscules are very rarely found open. Where this happens, the oscular orifice is at the summit, of a slight crater-like elevation. Within the circle of long protriaenes forming the oscular fringe is a circle of fine protriaenes on the edge itself and also on the gentle slope leading inwards. At a short distance from the edge, the slope leads to a vertical barrel-shaped tube ending in a well-marked sphinctrate ring, which is ab'out on a level with the innermost plane of the cortex ; the oscular tube slightly expands below the sphincter into a sub-cortical cavity in the lateral walls of which are the orifices of exhalant canals proceeding from just beneath the cortex. At its lower end the sub-cortical space is continued on into a large main vertical canal, which passes up radially from the central region, receiving in its turn many affluents. The wall of the oscular tube is mainly composed of a thick sheath of concentrically arranged uiyocytes. The vertical section of the oscular tube, when contracted, shows the almost closed lumen of the tube surrounded by a dark zone of sigmata, and with spiral bands of myocytes passing upwards around the lumen. Two of the eight known Cinachyra species, viz., C. voelt:koici Lendenfeld (11. p. 101) and C. malaccensis I. J. B. Sollas (19. p. 219), are described as having scattered pores in addition to the pores of the porocalyces. Some of these " pores" will certain ly be found to be oscules situated, in young specimens, more or less antipodally to the porocalyces, others possibly belonging to developing porocalyces ; for as W. J. Sollas observes (21. p. 29), " in their inception, the porocalyces are simply poriferous areas of the cortex." Young specimens. Very young specimens (IX. 3) are oval, broader at the superior end, and without a root-tuft, though the surface spicules are longer at the narrow end of the sponge. At this stage the sponge lies with its long axis oblique or horizontal. The smallest specimen in this collection is 3 x 4 mm. in diameter. It has one porocalyx situated in the centre of one side, and one oscule a little to one side of the centre of the summit of the broad end. This nearly bilateral symmetry calls to •2 r. R. KIEKPATRICK. mind the species of Fangophilina Schmidt, viz. F. submersa 0. Sch. (17. p. 73), and F. gilchristi Kirkp. (10. p. 667), in which the ovoidal body of the sponge has one large porocalyx and one large oscule situated on the upper aspect. As the sponge grows, the porocalyces increase in number and extend on each side of the original one till they form a complete equatorial belt ; in the meantime, the main axis of the sponge gradually rotates from horizontal to vertical, so that the crown of oscules comes in many specimens to lie in a horizontal plane at right angles to the vertical axis. The cortex. In young specimens the cortical oxeas are arranged taugentially in a single layer. In the largest examples, the cortex reaches a thickness of 3 '25 mm., the densely packed oxeas being arranged vertically and obliquely to the surface. The skeleton. The only additional observations to be made here are on certain bodies which Sollas (21. p. 24) refers to as " Globules ; accessory or accidental forms, 0'0535 mm. in diameter." These bodies, which Schulze terms "silica pearls," are now known to be not uncommon in sponges (Schulze, 18. p. 6, and Weltner, 33. p. 190). Spheres may be normal spicules of the sponge, as in Caminus sphaeroconia Sollas. In many instances, however, spheres or globules result from malformation or incomplete development, as in cases where a tylote spicule is reduced to a knob, or a sphere may result from the reduction of an oxea, as in Epallax callocyathus Sollas. In some of the specimens of C. barbata there are a considerable number of pearls and some of them are double (IX. 6, 7). One example 114 x, 94 /JL is oval, with two nuclei and with concentric layers of deposition round each, up to the point where the spheres come in contact ; later there is a single oval layer common to the two centres, but an annular depression or kink is always visible in the plane midway between the nuclei of the two original spheres. Sollas (21. p. 214, PI. XXVIL, figs. 8-9) figures composite spheres occurring in Caminus sphaeroconia, but here the composite sphere does not possess separate central points round which are deposited concentric laminae, but (apparently) one centre and an axial line or rod round the end of which the layers are deposited. Whether these spheres or silica pearls are always spicules or the result of incom- plete development of spicules, or whether they are sometimes due to deposition of layers of silex round some foreign organic or inorganic body, has not been determined. The nucleus is generally a refringeut point, but is sometimes irregularly shaped and of a faint yellow colour ; attempts to investigate it under high powers generally result in the pearl being crushed. Several of the smallest pearls, only 6 or 7 \i in diameter, are associated with fan- shaped crystalline bodies (IX. 8-12) ; these latter proved to be simply crystals deposited from the sea-water. Sometimes the pearl is in the centre of a spheroidal mass of crystals. Under polarised light, the crystals are doubly refracting and are brilliantly defined on the dark field, while the pearls are isotropic, though usually very faintly visible ; accordingly a spherical mass of crystals surrounding a pearl has a dark central space. In a vertical section of the sponge stained in borax-carmine the spheroidal TETRAXONIBA. 9 conglomerations of crystals, 30-45 /u in diameter, are clearly defined owing to their being much more deeply stained than the surrounding tissues. The appearance of capsules in PI. IX. figs. 13, 14, is due to an optical effect. The deep staining and the well- defined spheroidal shape might cause these bodies to be mistaken for organic structures ; they are barely visible when unstained, and it is not easy to separate them from the dehydrated tissues in which they lie, in order to test the action of reagents ; when separated they are found to be soluble in water. Localities. The specimens come from six different localities in the neighbour- hood of Winter Quarters, from depths ranging from 10 to 25 fms. Also Kergueleu Island, 25-60 fathoms, ' Voy. Challenger.' ClNACHYRA VERTEX. (Plate X., figs. 1-14.) 1907. Cinaclnjra vertex Lendenfeld (lla. p. 310). Sponge, generally oval, ovoidal, or conical, with long diameter horizontal. Surface with conules, usually oblique and more or less appressed to the surface, arranged in spiral rows, and terminating in tufts of spicules, the conules and tufts wrapping round the body. With well-developed root-tuft. Porocalyces, varying greatly in size and appearance, 1 icing hemispherical pits with circular orifice, or obliquely directed pockets with slit-like opening ; surface hispidated with trichodal protriaenes. With several oscules situated in a more or less circumscribed area on the side opposite the area of greatest development of porocalyces, or at or near the summit of conico-ovate specimens. The oscules were open only in one instance ; they were 3 • 25 x 2 mm. in diameter, with a marginal fringe, and a platform-like spicule below the rim. Ectosome, an outer layer of collenclyrnae, and an inner of fibrous tissue, with cortical spicules. Flagellated chambers eurypylous. Spicules. Megascleres. (1) Somal oxeas, 5'5 x '057 mm., fusiform, tapering gradually to sharp points. (2) Choanosomal oxeas 520 x 18 p, slightly curved. (3) Auatriaenes ; cladome, more or less hemispherical, often with apical umbo, cladi at first at right angles, then making a sharp bend ; length 210 /u, thickness at base 70 /j., chorda 300 n, sagetta 200 /u : rhabdome 6'5/x broad at junction with cladome, then narrowing slightly, again thickening slightly, and terminating gradually in a fine sharp point. (4) Protriaenes, cladome usually with one long clad us 1 70 ^ twice the length of the other two; rhabdome 7'5 x '019mm. nearly uniform in thickness in distal half, tapering at proximal end to fine sharp termination. 2 B 2 10 R. KIRKPATRICK. (5) Trichodal protriaenes with rhabdome 550 /x in length, and with longest cladus 50 fj,. Microscleres. (6) Sigmata, 18'36/x in length, 1'8/x in thickness, and 10'5/xin breadth in the C-aspect ; surface finely granular. There are twenty-five specimens of this sponge, the largest being 10 '5 x 8 cm. and the smallest 8x6 mm. The salient external features of the larger specimens are the spiral series of conules and tufts wrapping round the sponge, and the porocalyces obliquely displaced by the spiral growth of the sponge. The root-tuft is often much more bulky than the sponge body. The conules which form a fleshy basal sheath to the spicular tufts attain a height of 5 mm., and the tufts of an additional 10 mm. The porocalyces have an average diameter of about 4 mm., the oscules being about • 5 mm. in the contracted state ; the latter have a fine marginal fringe of small protriaenes. On section, the flesh is reddish in colour ; the cortex indiscernible and can be peeled off in the form of a thin skin, its thickness being about 30 mm. ; the outer third is formed of large rounded collencytes, 18fi in diameter, full of granules, which stain deeply. Covering the outer surface of the sponge is a well-defined layer of signiaspires : a layer of the same spicules also lines the surface of the canals. Canal System. Currents pass through the pores in the porocalyces to large sub-dermal spaces leading to one large inhalant canal. The flagellated chambers are eurypylous. PI. X. fig. 5 shows numerous apopyles opening into a commencing exhalant canal. The collar-cells (X. 6) here have their collars concrescent. Numerous ova are present in some of the specimens, and in various stages — but not in the same specimen — some having pseudopodia-like processes, otheTs being spheroidal and devoid of processes. In one unstained section in balsam the large spherical ova are 330 /j. in diameter, with nucleus 50 n, and uucleolus 9 • 75 ju in diameter ; here the ova can be seen with the naked eye as deep yellow spots, and with a hand lens the clear nucleus can be distinctly made out. Young Specimens. In early stages there is no root-tuft, but in a series of small specimens, the conule tufts can be seen to lengthen at the narrow end of the specimen till they form a root-tuft. At first there is only one porocalyx situated on one side, and a single oscule, surrounded by a fringe of protriaeues, a little below and behind the broad end of the egg-shaped specimen. One small specimen (No. 264, 13, ii. 04) differs from the others in having long tufts each with a long fleshy base, the tufts all pointing downwards from the flat upper end ; a few small contracted porocalyces are concealed in the axils of the fleshy conules. Localities. Winter Quarters. Twenty-five specimens were obtained from ten localities, and from depths varying from 10-30 fathoms. TETRAXONIDA. 1 1 ClNACHYRA VERTEX far. nioiiticularis. (Plate X., figs. 15, 16. Plate XL, figs. 1-3.) 1907. Ginachijra vertex Lendenfeld (lla. p. 310). Two small specimens of this species, obtained from deep water (130 fms.), show a remarkable variation in the porocalyces and oscules. The porocalyces instead of being situated below the general surface are elevated above it in the form of rounded warts or monticules about 1 mm. in height; the oscules likewise form small cylindrical chimneys about 2 mm. in height. The larger of the two specimens is-3'5 x 2' 5 cm. in its diameters, not including the root-tuft, which is about 2 cm. in thickness. A large part of the surface is covered with the little porocalycal monticules, and at one end are several oscular chimneys. Situated at a varying height on each monticule is a semilunar slit which opens into a csecal fold or pocket that has been formed by the upward growth and protrusion of the monticule ; when the lip is near the summit of the monticule, it surrounds the latter like a kind of prtepuce. The pore-perforated floor of the porocalyx itself is, in every instance, closely folded with longitudinal pleats which, however, can be unfolded. The summit of the monticule is formed by the tops of these folds, and bundles of the hispidatiug trichodal protriaeues can occasionally be seen projecting from the summit. The long slender bundles of protriaenes divide into two layers at the inferior proximal edge of the semihmar fold, one set being in the fold itself and extending to the nine of the same and sometimes a little beyond, the other set passing up in to the floor and walls of the porocalyx itself. The edge of the semilunar lip is provided with a band of myocytes. This curious variation appears to have taken place as an adaptation necessitated by the spiral mode of growth of the sponge ; if such growth became excessive the porocalyces would lie in danger of becoming closed altogether from one lip of the orifice overlaying the other. Locality. Winter Quarters. No. 10 Hole, 130 fms. II.— GRADE MONAXONELLIDA, DENDY. There are, in all, forty-three species belonging to this group. Of these, eight belong to the Astromonaxinellida, and thirty-five to the Sigmatomonaxiuellida. Twenty-two species are new, and there are, in addition, seven new varieties of species already described. There are four new genera, of which one belongs to the .•!./•///< ///VA/« . two to the Mycalinae, and a fourth, Pyl»(l<'i-mi<-!•• vis Ridley and Dendy. There are two small basal whorls of spines ; above them is a plano-convex whorl with denticulate edges and deeply cleft along 3-5 radii ; then follow two smaller whorls pointing upwards. The smooth styles are fusiform, with tornote point, 557 p. long, 6 '5 p. in diameter at the head, and 10'5 in diameter at the centre. The specimen was dredged West of Balleney Island in 254 fms. FAMILY POLYMASTIDAE, Vosmaer. POLYMASTIA INVAGINATA. (Plate XII., fig. IB, and Plate XIV., figs. 5-1 5a.) Polymastia invaginata Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 271). Sponge hemispherical, free or attached, covered with a thick pile of pointed spicules. With one large oscular papilla usually completely iuvagiuated, so that the summit of the uscule is 011 a level with, or below the general surface. Under surface with a fleshy basal pad. Pores in longitudinal meridional groups in the cortex. Colour, in spirit pale yellow above, and often gray and semi-transparent on the under surface in free specimens. Consistence dense and firm. Flagellated chambers spherical, 30*5 p, in diameter, diplodal (XIV. 7). Skeleton. Choanosomal, formed of fibres curving upwards from the base to the periphery, penetrating the cortex and forming the thick surface pile ; with stellate clusters of small tyles between the fibres. Cortical skeleton formed of a dense layer of vertical tyles of various lengths embedded in a tough, fibrous layer from '5 to T25 mm. thick. Basal skeleton consisting of spicules transversely arranged, and crossing each other in an irregular manner. Spicules. Large, smooth, slightly curved styles, or occasionally strongyles, 2240 x 40 ft. Cortical tyles, with small spheroidal head, short neck, fusiform straight shaft, varying in length from 140 to 350 p, and in thickness from 12 to 19 /n. A few very slender styles scattered in the choanosome, 70 x 6 p, with head and neck making an angle with the shaft. Some medium-sized cortical tyles in the oscular papilla with long, oval heads. Tyles of the stellate clusters, slender, with the head making an an^le with the shaft, 200 x 15 //. There are fourteen large specimens and five very small ones of this species. The largest is 8 cm. in diameter and 4 • 5 cm. high ; and the smallest, which is triangular, VOL. IV. 2 C Hi R. KIRKPATRICK. is 8 mm. high, 8 mm. ill length at the base, and 4 mm. in thickness. In some the pile has been rubbed off, exposing the smooth, fleshy cortex. Some of the specimens are growing on large stones ; others are free, but with numerous embedded pebbles in the fleshy basal pad. In many specimens the oscule is invisible, being entirely retracted within a cavity below the summit, and with the opening of that cavity, contracted to a point and concealed by the surface pile of spicules ; a vertical section reveals the oscular papilla in its cavity. One specimen has two oscular papillae. The general structure of the skeleton recalls Trichostemma, which likewise has a basal pad, with fibres radiating from I >ase to periphery, and with a cortex of tyles. T. sarsii also has the stellate groups of tyles between the fibres of the choanosome. The basal pad is composed of stellate- celled colleuchyma, the colleucytes with their branched anastomosing processes being embedded in a clear, gelatinous matrix. Most of the specimens were dredged in the neighbourhood of Winter Quarters in depths of 10-30 fms. ; one came from near Mounts Erebus and Terror, 500 fms. SPHAEROTYLUS, Topsent (26. p. 244). Polymastidae, massive ; provided with tylostyles, and with exotyles in the form of spherotyles or spherostyles. This genus was established by Topseut to contain Potymastia cap it at a, Yosmaer (32. p. 16). I have slightly extended the original definition by the addition of the word " spherostyles," because one of the two species of Sphaerotylus in the present collection has exotyles in the form of spherostyles, i.e., exotyles with the proximal inner end simply rounded and not enlarged into a knob, a spherostyle being a style with the distal or outer end enlarged. The difference between a spherostyle and a spherotyle is hardly of generic importance, consequently Sphaerotylus must include forms with spherostyles. Hitherto only three Astrornonaxonellid sponges with exotyles have been described, viz., Tylexocladus joubinii Topsent, Proteleia sollasii Ridley and Dendy, and Sphaerotylus capitatus (Vosmaer). The ' Discovery ' collection contains two species of Sphaerotylus, a new one S. antarcticus, and one which appears to me to differ in no important respect from the Arctic species S. capitatus (Vosmaer). SPHAEROTYLUS ANTARCTICUS. (Plate XII. , figs. U-16 and Plate XIII., figs. 1-7.) • Sphaerotylus antarcticus Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 272). Sponge, dome-shaped or spheroidal, attached or free. Surface beset with a covering of long spherostyles, and with a dense short pile of cortical rnicrotyles. With several usually elongated papillae with or without a large terminal orifice. Dermal pores distributed over the cortex, each pore opening into a single tubular TETi; A. \OXIDA. 17 canal in the cortex ; the mouth or pore of the pore canal guarded by a ring of radiating cortical tyles (XIII. 3). Flagellated chambers diplodal (XIII. 7). Skeleton formed mainly of radiating fibres composed of styles, with diverging brushes of spherostyles near the surface. Cortex with a surface layer of densely packed tufts of small vertical tyles, and a sub-cortical layer of tangential styl - and tyles. Spicules. Spherostyles (XII. 8-12) 8 mm. in length by 30 /j. in diameter in the middle, and 14 n in the region below the distal knob ; distal knob 28 n in diameter, hemispherical, with granular surface and with a few square teeth or serrations on the edge. Styles straight, fusiform, blunt-pointed, 2-8 mm. in length, 41 /t in diameter in the middle, 23 /j. in diameter at the rounded end. Cortical tyles (XII. 15, 15a), curved, 146 fj. long, head, 3' 25 n in diameter : -lender neck, 2'75/it thick with broad oar-blade-like shaft, circular in section, 1 \L thick. Styles of lower cortical tangential layer (XII. 7), also in choauosome, 900 x 20 /*. Tyles of the same layer, nearly straight, 270 /j. long ; with head 7 \i in diameter, and relatively thick neck G'8 M in diameter (XII. 1G-16A). Slender curved tyles, 4GO x 10//, scattered in choanosome (XII. 13). Young specimens are oval with one long closed papilla ; the bundles of divergent exotyles are more or less separate and distinct, and the distal knobs retained and not broken off; the radial bundles of fibres radiate out from a point below the centre of the specimen. There are five large specimens, of which three encrust rocks and two are free, and six very small ones, all of which are free. One of the large free ones (XII. 5) is a globular fluffy ball 6 cm. in diameter, with a few stumpy, much contracted papilla ; another free specimen is dome-shaped, with a flat, fleshy base like a thin pad. The typical shape is that of a dome, with the skeletal fibres radiating upwards and outwards from the base to the surface. The spheroidal form results from the growing round of the edges till they meet ; accordingly a section shows a central core with cortical microtyles still present, but displaced, and with main fibres radiating out all round the core. The largest encrusting specimen (XII. 1), which is growing on a boulder of black volcanic rock, is 10 cm. in diameter and about 3 cm. in height, the papilla1, about twenty in number, rising to an additional height of 3-4 cm. The papillae are coated with the thick pile of microtyles, but there are no exotyles. A few of the papillae have large terminal orifices with apparently cicatrised edges, as if the In-each had arisen from a bursting away of the summit from pressure from within the papilla ; the-' papillaj, at any rate, are oscular; but so also, probably, are some of the closed papilla . which have irregular cribriform patches around the summit or along one side of the papilla. The same difficulty of deciding on the function of the-c organs occurs also in the case of species <>f Potymastia. •1 < -j 18 R. KIRKPATRICK. The radial bundles of styles proceed from base to periphery, and usually do not penetrate the surface ; the exotyles form pyramidal tufts which originate just below the cortex, this arrangement being well seen in young specimens. Specimens were obtained from Winter Quarters, Flagon Point, 10-20 fms. ; from No. 12 hole, 25-30 fms. ; and from McMurdo Bay up to 20 fms. SPHAEROTYLUS CAPITATUS. (Plate XII., fig. Ic, Plate XIII., figs. 8-13, and Plate XIV., figs. 1-4.) 1882. Radiella schoenus Sollas (20. p. 163), Nomen nudum. 1885. Polymastia capitata Vosmaer (32. p. 16). 1808. Sphaeroti/liis capitatus Topsent (26. p. 244). The single specimen (XII. Ic) is attached to a block of volcanic rock on which specimens of S. antarcticus and Polymastia invaginata are growing. The sponge is in the form of a flattened dome 1'5 cm. in diameter and 5 mm. in height, with a small papilla 5 mm. in length, rising from near the centre of the upper surface. From one side of the specimen slender bud-bearing stalks arise to a height of 2-4 mm. ; sometimes the buds are in linear series (XIV. 2), sometimes zigzag (XIV. 4). The axes of the stalks are the prolongations of radial fibres, and consist of tyles. The buds, which vary from '5 mm. to 1*25 mm. in diameter, bristle with the sharp points of small and medium-sized tyles. The largest bud (XIV. 3) has exotyles, and shows all the stages of their develop- ment. Firstly, there is a thickening of the distal end of an ordinary sharp-pointed tylostyle, which becomes cylindrical ; then the end becomes roughened, and finally clavate. Merejkowsky (14. p. 4, PL I., figs. 8, 12, and PL III., figs. 1-3) figures buds forming on stalks at the summits of the papillae of Polymastia mammillaris (Rinalda arctica) from the White Sea. The stalks and buds strikingly resemble those of Sphaerotylus capitatus, excepting that the latter grow direct from the general surface of the body and not from the summits of the papillae. Merejkowsky gives an interesting account of the development of these buds, which drop off from their stalks, and become flattened and disk-like as they rest on the bottom. The surface becomes covered with debris which the spines help to retain. He supposed that the decaying organic debris served as nutriment, which was directly absorbed by the surface of the young sponge. The flagellated chambers are diplodal. 'The colour of the specimen in spirit is pale yellow. The body presents a surface uniform to the naked eye, but under a strong lens the summits of the club-shaped exotyles are visible. These spicules arise in bundles of the shape of inverted cones, the apices of which are a short distance below the cortex. The cortical skeleton is formed of slender tyles. There is no sub-cortical layer of tangential spicules. TETRAXOXIDA. 19 The choanosomal skeleton is formed of fibres radiating upwards from the base to the periphery, and spreading out in the upper third of their course ; they do not pene- trate the cortex. Spicules. Choanosomal tyles of the radiating fibres, 1120 x 20 p., straight, fusiform, attenuating gradually to a sharp point; head long, oval, 20 p. long, 17 p. broad. Tyles scattered between the radial fibres, varying in length from 370 to GOO p., slightly curved. Exotyles in form of spherotyles, 760 p. long and 40 /JL in diameter at the broad distal end, which is clavate, and with a granulated surface ; the heads at the proximal end (in the interior of the sponge) are 15 p. in diameter. The cortical tyles (XIII. 11), '218 x 12'5/n, are slender, tapering, curved, and with small oval heads and a thin neck ; there is a shorter, straighter variety of cortical tyle (XIII. 12, 12a) with a relatively thicker neck, and abruptly pointed. Although there is some uncertainty as to the actual size of the spicules in the specimen described by Vosmaer, yet the relative proportions and characters of these spicules are very similar in the Arctic and Antarctic specimens. The Arctic specimen was globular and 2 cm. in diameter. Topsent mentions Radiella schcenus Sollas, as a synonym of Vosmaer's species. Sollas gives the only names without generic or specific definition. The specimen was obtained from Winter Quarters, off Flagon Point, 10-20 fins. It has also been found at Lat. 72° 14' 8" N., Long. 22° 30' 9" E., 165 fms., Vosmaer, Willem Barents Expedition. FAMILY SUBERITIDAE, Schmidt. SUBERITES MICROSTOMUS var. stellatus. (Plate XV., figs. 8-13.) Suberitfs microstomus Ridley and Dendy (15. p. 199). There are four small specimens in the form of smooth, pale-coloured, whitish rounded masses, smooth to the eye but slightly rough to the touch, encrusting the stems of branching Polyzoa; the largest is about 4'5 cm. long and 2'5 cm. broad, and forms a nodulated mass on the branch of the Polyzoou. There are two or three minute conical pointed oscular papilla) about 1 mm. high. The pores occur in stellate areas among the cortical tyles which occupy the rest of the surface. The skeleton is composed of radiating fibres and of a dense cortical layer of vertical or oblique tyles. Spicules. Megascleres. Large straight fusiform tylrs with an oval head, gradually attenuating to a sharp point, 1130 x 24 p.. The head (XV. 9a) is usually sub-tylote or even stylotc. and has a sub-terminal oval <\\vl]iii'j 1 3 p. in diameter. The cortical tyles vary considerably, the li«_rure- showing tluve kinds. The largest 500 x 30 /u 20 R. KIRKPATRICK. (XV. 10) with a small spherical head 20 /u in diameter, with a slender neck, and a thick fusiform shaft, blade-like in optical section, and with tornote end ; a few of these spicules are scattered in the choanosome between the radiating fibres. A second kind (XV. 12) 220 X 20 p. is straight, with a short, thick neck and cylindrical shaft with blunt- point. A third kind (XV. 11) 220 X 7 /* is slender, slightly curved, and sharp-pointed. The new variety differs from the typical form in having stouter cortical and choanosomal spicules. This is at once obvious on looking at the vertical sections of the two forms, the cortical spicules especially being much thicker and denser in the new variety. Again, the poral areas on the surface of the type are small and circular (XV. 14), whereas those of the new variety are stellate (XV. 13). The specimens were dredged near Winter Quarters, at No. 10 hole, 130 fms. The typical form was obtained from between Kerguelen and Heard Island from 150 fms. (Voy. 'Challenger'). SUBERITES CAMINATUS V(tr. papillatus. (Plate XV., fig. 16, and Plate XVI, figs. 11-14.) Suberites caminatus Ridley and Dendy (15. p. 198). There are two specimens, each firmly attached to a piece of rock ; one has two oscular chimneys, the other only one. The body of the larger specimen is 2' 5 cm. in diameter and 1 f 5 cm. in height, the oscules being 7 mm. in height. The upper half or more of the surface is covered with small flattened papillae, each about 1 to 1'25 mm. in diameter, and about '7 mm. high. These structures carry the pores in stellate grooves (XV. 16). At the base of the sponge is a chitinous lamella with tangential tyles scattered irregularly and intercrossing. At the base of the larger specimen the basal lamella is produced into a fringe of little processes formed of flattened bundles of tyles, the distal ends of which have become rounded. The skeleton is formed of radiating choauosomal fibres and of a dense cortical layer of dressed tyles. Spicules. Straight fusiform tyles (XVI. 14), 1530 x 20 yu, with small oval head 15 x 10 ju. Cortical tyles mostly of two kinds; one (XVI. 12) with small spherical head, with relatively slender neck and thick cylindrical shaft, blade-like in optical section, with tornote pointed end ; the other (XVI. 13) shorter and stouter and with thicker neck. A fourth kind of spicule, rather rare (not figured), is a sub-tylote, 1,530 x 20 /* long, with a very slender curved distal end projecting beyond the surface, resembling the distal end of the heteroxea of Stylocordyla. The chief variation from the type lies in the poral papillae. In the typical form the pores are in stellate grooves. The papillae of the new variety called to mind the same structures in Trichostemma irregularis R. & D. On examination, the papillae in this species also proved to be poral, with the pores in radiating grooves. The two specimens were dredged from a depth of 254 fms., due west of Balleney TETRAXONIDA. 21 Island. The typical form came from off' the Rio de la Plata, GOO fm.s. (Voy. ' Challenger '). Topsent records it from near Fayal, 130 metres, and 55 miles N.N.W. of Fayal, 1900 metres. • PSEUDOSUBERITES HYALINUS. (Plate XXVI., figs. 7a-k) 1887. Hymeniacidon? hyalina Ridley and Dendy (15. p. 108). 1S98. Pseudosuberites Uijalinus Topsent (27. p. 103). 1900. Pseudostilerif/'x Jii/nlinus Topsent (28. p. 170). The single specimen is of a compressed cylindrical shape, G cm. long and 8 mm. in diameter. The colour is white. There does not appear to be any area of attachment, both ends being complete and rounded. Two thin walled oscules, each about 2 mm. in diameter occur along one edge of the specimen, the exhalaut canals proceeding towards them being clearly visible. On one side of one of the oscules is a wall of spicules formed by a continuation and flattening out of some of the lateral or secondary skeletal bundles. A longitudinal section shows clearly a central loose core of longitudinal fibres each about 100 n thick, anastomosing slightly and giving off at right angles bundles of spicules which support the dermal membrane ; in the thinner parts of the specimen these bundles are one spicule in length, but at the thickest part they may be two or three spicules in length and traversed by longitudinal bundles. The original specimens obtained from Kergueleu by the ' Challenger' are " massive and amorphous," and the skeleton is more of the " halichondrioid type," but here also the longitudinal bundles and those supporting the dermal membrane can be distinctly made out. In the Antarctic specimen the cylindrical shape has brought about the more regular arrangement. The Mediterranean sponge, identified by Topsent (27. p. 103) as P. hyalinus, is massive, amorphous, and encloses foreign bodies. The surface is mammillated and a little hispid, this condition resulting from the prolongation of the lateral bundles or fibres of the skeleton. The tyles of the Antarctic form are about 1000 x 19 n, those of the Kergueleu form 1100 x 25 ^, and those of the Mediterranean form from 300 x 10 p to 1200 x 26 /x. An interesting feature is that all the spicules point in a direction upwards or upwards and outwards. Two other species of Pseudosuberites are P. sulp]mr>'tt.x (Bowerbank), from the seas of N.W. Europe, and P. andrewsi, Kirkp. (9. p. 135), from Christmas Island ; this last species forms a cake-like crust, and its spicules are much smaller than those of P. hyalinus, being only 350 x G fj.. The specimen was dredged from W.Q. No. 10 hole, 130 fins. The species has been found off S.W. Patagonia, Voy. 'Challenger,' St. 311, 175 fms., and off the Mediterranean coast of France in 500 to GOO metres, Topseut. R. KIRKPATRICK. TRIBE AOICULIDA, Topseut. FAMILY STYLOCORDYLID.E, Topsent. STYLOCORDYLA BOREALIS var. acuata. (Plate XVI., figs. 6-10.) 1868. Hyalonema lore-ale Loven (Ofvers. Vetensk Akad. Forhand., Arg. xxv, No. 2, p. 105, pi. ii.). 1873. Stylocordyla lorealis Wyville Thomson (' The Depths of the Sea,' p. 113, fig. 13). The small specimen representing this variety has a slender stalk 6 • 2 cm. long with an oval head 7x5 mm. A second broken stem arises from the common base which has a few grains of gravel and a fragment of the horny tube of a Hydroid attached to it. The following spicular elements occur :— 1. Large oxeas with a central swelling (XVI. 10), in the axis of the stem, 1450 x 60/i. 2. Smaller oxeas without central swelling (XVI. 8), in the radiating fibres of the head, 900 x 20 /z. 3. Heteroxeas (XVI. 9) 1000 x 10 /j, in the radiating fibres of the head. 4. Microstyles (XVI. 7, 7a) 110 x 4 /x vertically dressed at the surface of the stem, and not found in the h'ead. In the typical form there are microxeas, which may be centrotylote. The variety is named " acuata " from the presence of the microstyles. Topsent (25. p. 286) considered that Stylocordyla stipitata Carter, differs from S. borealis in not having microxeas, which the latter possesses ; and he based his opinion on the absence of these spicules from certain preparations of S. stipitata lent to him by Canon Norman ; but I have found the microxeas in abundance in Carter's type specimen. Accordingly there is probably only one known species of Stylocordyla, viz., the typical S. borealis, and two varieties, var. globosa R. & D., and var. acuata nov. The figures of Loven and Sars do not show any indication of the microxeas being centro-tylote, but this condition is found in specimens from the Bay of Biscay. The Antarctic variety has no dermal tangential microscleres in the head, but microxeas occur in this position in the typical forms from the North Atlantic. The ' Discovery ' dredged the specimen from off Erebus and Terror in 500 fms. The species has been obtained from the following localities : — North Sea (Loven) ; between Scotland and Faroe (Carter, Schulze) ; Grenada (Schmidt); South of Nova Scotia, 85 fms. (Voy. 'Challenger'); Bay of Biscay, 1710 metres (Topsent) ; Bahia 7-20 fms. (Voy. ' Challenger ') ; var. globosa — Southern Ocean 145 fms. (Voy. ' Challenger') ; off Kerguelen 10-100 fms., Voy. ' Challenger.' TETRAXONIDA. 23 SUB-ORDER HALICHONDRINA, Vosmacr. FAMILY AXTNELLID.E, Ridley and Dendy. AxiNELLA SUPRATUMESCENS. (Plate XXII. , fig. 8, and Plate XXVI. , figs. Ga-b.) 1907. Annelln supratumescens Topsent (31. p. G). The specimen, which is a small conico-cylindrical fragment 3-5 cm. long and 9 mm. in diameter, is the broken-off end of a branch. The surface is finely hispid, and the broken end shows the dense but flexible central axis. The straight or slightly curved styles are mainly of two sizes, the larger (XXVI. 6a) being 594 x 12'5/x, and the smaller (XXVI. Gb), which forms the surface tufts, 30G x 6'25/u. The specimen was dredged near Winter Quarters in 10 frns. The ' Frangais ' Antarctic Expedition obtained numerous specimens from Booth- Waudel Island and Wiencke Island, from low water up to 30 metres (Topsent, 31. p. 74). SIGMAXINYSSA Kirkpatrick. 1907. Sigmaxinyssa Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 272). Cup-shaped Axinellidae with longitudinal skeletal fibres joined by transverse ones on the inner aspect, and with tufts given off at right angles to these on the outer aspect. Megascleres, oxeas ; microseleres, sigmata and toxa. SIGMAXINYSSA PHAKELLIOIDES. (Plate XVIL, fig. 6, and Plate XXIV., figs. 4a-c.) ]!)07. Sifjmaxinyssa phaMlioidcs Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 272). Sponge sessile, cornucopia- or cup-shaped. Inner surface smooth, outer surface coarsely pilose. Consistence rather hard, but flexible. Colour in spirit, grayish drab. Inner surface with numerous small oscules, each about 1 mm. in diameter ; outer surface pilose, with dermal membrane perforated by round pores 95 p. in diameter. Skeleton. On inner surface formed of close set longitudinal liui's joined by cross bars, and giving off tufts of fibres, which proceed outwards at right angles to the outer surface, pushing up the dermal membrane, but barely projecting beyond it. Spicules. Oxeas, 835'5 x 42 '25 fi, curved at centre, sharp-pointed. Sigmata, 81 '25 fj. long, 35' 75 /j, broad, and 3' 25 fj. thick, often with an angular bend at centre of shaft. Toxa, 130 n long, and 3'25/x thick at cent re, with smooth surface. This species bears in its outward aspect a very close resemblance to cup-shaped species of J'/uiki ll'm • also the skeletal arrangement is like that of Phukcttiii ; I he oxeas, sigmata and toxa are those of a typical Gellius. The Axinellid genus Siui 1000 x 50 ,u. Also smooth curved kind G25 /x long. Ectosomal styles, straight, smooth, tapering gradually to a point, 40G x 9 /u. Microscleres, toxa smooth, 638 M long, G'25 M thick at the centre. These spicules occur in nests or groups of 5-10. The specimen is attached to a stone by a narrow base about 2 cm. in diameter. The height is 6'5 cm., and the greatest breadth on the upper surface 7'5 cm. The upper surface is triangular, each angle being slightly produced and provided with an oscule, there being also an oscule in the centre. The spines, which are simply the ends of skeletal fibres, are about 1 cm. in height. * Inadvertently the specific name has been badly chosen, the colour — in alcohol— being that of pale brown mud. 2 D 2 26 E. KIRKPATRICK. At the base of the spines is the thin dermal membrane, generally torn away, thus exposing the circular openings of inhalant channels. The new species comes well within the genus Ophlitaspongia Bk., as amended by Dendy (5. p. 36). 0. seriata Bk., 0. subhispida Carter, and 0. membranacea Thiele, all have toxa, but the first and third species are encrusting, and the second has long slender branches. The chief characters of the new species are the strongly spiued surface, and the great development of the spicular core, the spougin not being so abundant as in other species, and not forming distinct fibres. The single specimen was dredged off Coalman Island in 100 fms. LISSOMYXILLA Hanitsch. This genus was established by Hauitsch (8. p. 194), to include Ectyoniue Sponges with fibres having a core of smooth styles echinated by acanthostyles and with special ectosomal megascleres ; with or without microscleres. Unfortunately the species he selected as type of the genus ( Tethea spinosa, Bowerbank) in no way fell in with the definition, since, as Topsent points out (28. p. 265), this species has neither echinatiug spicules nor special ectosomal spicules, and Topsent refers Lissomyxilla to the limbo of useless names. Among the ' Discovery ' sponges, however, is a specimen which fits in with Hauitsch's definition of Lissomyxilla, which runs, " Skeleton fibres of the choanosome, formed of smooth monactinals echiuated by spined styles. Megascleres of the ectosome smooth diactinals or monactinals. Microscleres (isochelae, &c.) may be present." Accordingly, I propose to revive the name. LISSOMYXILLA HANITSCHI. (Plate XXII., fig. 7, and Plate XXVI., fig. 4a-c\) 1907. Lissomyxilla hanitschi Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 275). Description. There are two much-worn pieces of this sponge of a dark, dirty-gray colour, and a third young small specimen, whitish in colour, growing on a specimen of Hornera. The largest specimen is 4 cm. high and 5 cm. in diameter at the base ; the dermal membrane is worn away, exposing several openings of exhalaut canals, 4 mm. in diameter. The dermal membrane of the smallest specimen is transparent, smooth, and raised up at one place into a small conical oscule, with radial tangential spicules in its walls. The skeleton of the choanosome is formed of branching fibres on an average about 150 fj. thick, echinated by spined styles in an obscurely verticillate manner, the whole skeleton, as seen in sections, having a somewhat confused appearance. The ectosomal spicules partly proceed obliquely from the main fibres to the dermal membrane, and partly lie tangeutially in that membrane. Spicules. Megascleres. Smooth styles, 500 x 19/i, smooth, curved near the head, sharp-pointed. TETRAXONIDA. 27 Echinating acanthostyles, :219 x 18'75/t (without including spines), larger spines situated on the head 9 fj. long. Ectosomal amphityles, 35f> x-11 n straight, very slightly fusiform, subtylote, and with a small mucro at each end. Microscleres, none. Myxilla victoriana Dendy (Plalichondria pustulosa Carter), (5. p. 30), would come under this genus, although, at the same time, it is in possession of isochelae, and the heads of the styli of the main fibres occasionally have a slight indication of spination Two fragments (No. 123) were dredged off Coulman Island in 100 fins. A third specimen (No. 38) on Ilornera was obtained from east end of Barrier, 100 fins., bottom mud, stones, and rocks. II. SUB-FAMILY MYCALINAE, THIELE. I. GROUP MYXILLEAE, LUNDBECK. MYXILLA DECEPTA. (Plate XXII., figs. l-2a, and Plate XXV., fig. 3a-f.) 1907. Myxilla derejitii Kirkpatrick (10a. p. -'I*.) Description. There are two very small specimens of this species. One is in the form of an extremely thin incrustation on a piece of rock ; the surface is pilose owin- to the projection of vertically dressed acanthostyles, each surrounded by tufts of ectosomal spicules. The other, which incrusts the branch of a Poly/oon, is thicker, and the surface here is partly smooth, partly provided with minute sharp-pointed conules supported by acanthostyles. The colour of both specimens is reddish brown. The skeleton in the very thin incrustation, at first sight, resembles that of a Hymerrhaphia ; each vertical acanthostyle is isolated, and with its head on the base and its pointed end projecting. In the thicker specimen it is possible to make out primary and secondary lines of skeletal fibres. The ectosomal spicules are partly arranged iii paniculate tufts, partly lying tangentially in the dermal membrane. Spicules. Mcgasderes. ( 'hoanosomal acauthostyles, 4G8 X 23* 5 /it, curved, spincd at the head only, with sub-tornote points. Ectosomal strougyles 238 X 4'G/i, straight, smooth, cylindrical, usually with a pointed inucro at one end. Microscleres. Arcuate isocliehu, 19-5/i long, 5'6/x broad, palmate tooth 8 /* long ovoid, with rounded distal edge; with thick curved shaft : with tongue-shaped ala; about 8 fj. long. Isaucorae uuguiferae, 15'3ju long, with slender, curved, sometimes wavy shaft, with three sharp claw-like teeth at each end. Chelate bipocilla 8 /x long, with deeply curved shaft with spatlmlatc ends each with three triangular denticles ; these spicules arc fairly common and not accidental. R. KIRKPATRICK. There are also several isochelse arcuatse in which the alse and denticle are replaced at one end by a spoon-like lamella. The presence in Myxilla of chelate bipocilla similar in many respects to those found in the new species lophon spatulatus and /. flabeUo-digltatus is exceptional ; some- what similar structures occur, however, in Myxilla iophonoides Svartzevsky (Mem. Soc. Nat. Kieff, Tome XX., p. 340, PI. XV., fig. 27g-l) from the White Sea, but there are no isochelse arcuatse. In other respects the spiculation of the new species is that of a typical Myxillu. The isochelse arcuatse, though only half the length, resemble in shape those of Myxtlla nobilis R. and D., from off the Rio de la Plata, and M. dli>7. lophon spatulatlts Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 27(1). Sponge slender, cylindrical, branched. Colour, pale brown in spirit. Oscnles oval, about 1 x • G mm. in diameter, slightly raised ; surrounded by a radiating zone of tyles. Pores in sieve-like areas 2-3 mm. in length and about 2 mm. in breadth, on a level with the general surface. Flagellated chambers 26 x 23 p. Skeleton. Dermal ; a closely packed layer of dermal amphityles. Choanosomal, a loose network of 3-6 spicules thick, forming the core of the cylinder; multispicular fibres, giving off strands at right angles; the longitudinal fibres are joined obliquely or transversely by fibres one or two spicules thick, which support the dermal membrane. Spicules. Megascleres, smooth styles, 462 x 25 /*, with a mucro at the basal end. Ectosomal sub-amphityles 225 X 12'5/u,, fusiform with the swelled ends smooth laterally, and with the extremities only slightly convex, in fact almost truncate, and covered with spines. Microscleres. Palmate anisochelae 18"7/u long, G'2^ broad (front view). Bipocilla, rare, 13'6/i long, I'l5fj. thick, shaft deeply curved, slightly twined, and with ends almost similar, spatulate, with crenulated edges; occasionally with live relatively large denticles in place of the finer crenulation. A second kind of bipocilla have a longer, less curved shaft with scoop-like rather than spathulate 30 R. KIRKPATRICK. ends, each scoop having four or five denticles. One example has three sharp prongs at one end and the spathulate prolongation at the other. The species, is represented by numerous small, for the most part fragmentary, slender cylindrical pieces. Many of the fragments came from the same locality as the specimens of /. radiatus and were mixed up with them. Generally it was easy to separate the two by the colour, that of /. radiatus usually being of a much darker brown ; but in one or two instances the specimens of the new species were also dark coloured. Several of the fragments are branched. The specimen figured (XXI. 5) is 4 cm. long and 5 mm. in diameter. The oscules are provided with a ring of radiating amphityles, whereas /. radiatus is devoid of such structure. A glance at the spicules at once enables one to distinguish the two species. The ectosomal amphityles of /. radiatus have well-marked knobs spined all over, and not merely at the ends. The choanosomal spicules of /. spatulatus are apparently modified acanthostyles, smooth along the shaft, but with the spines at the rounded end gathered into one large spine situated on the summit, thus giving it a tornote aspect. In one instance, the single spine is represented by a little tuft of the spines. The axial canal terminates some distance below the base of the spine. Several spherical embryos 268 fj. in diameter were present in one fragment, but there were no special spicules in them. Since writing the above description, accounts of two new species of lophon from the Antarctic have been published by Topsent (31. pp. 4-6), viz. /. unicornis and /. pluricvrnix. The two new species described in the present Eeport and Topsent's two species all possess the curious modified acanthostyles. /. unicornis Topsent, has no bipocilla, and /. pluricornis has bipocilla apparently with pocillate ends ; the ' Dis- covery ' species have spathulate bipocilla with creuulated ends ; and further, there are differences, viz., in the shape of the body, the arrangement of the skeleton, and the character of the ectosomal spicules, which lead me to regard the ' Discovery ' specimens as belonging to distinct species. A differential diagnosis of the four Antarctic species with modified acauthostyles is given at the end of the description of the next species. Fragments were dredged at No. 11 hole, 28 fms.; at No. 12 hole, 25-30 fms., and off Coulman Island, 100 fms. lOPHON FLABELLO-DIGITATUS. (Plate XXL, figs. 6, GA-C, Plate XXV., fig. 6a-f, and Plate XXVL, fig. la-c1.) 1907. lophon flaMlo-cligitalus Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 277). Sponge forming a large palmato-digitate or digitate growth in one plane ; branches compressed, usually with oscules along one edge. Surface finely verruculate ; with elongated pore areas supported by fan-like wisps of ectosomal spicules. Colour dark brown ; consistence soft, the sponge being readily broken. TETRAXOXIDA. 31 Skeleton typically formed of a network of splenic-fibre, tlio primary lines of which proceed upwards and outwards from the inner surface of oscular tulies to the outer surface of the sponge, where their ends form the verrucae ; the secondnrv libres join the primary at right angles forming rectangular meshes about T25 nun. square. The thickness of the primary fibres is about "7 mm., that of the secondary about '5 mm. The ectosomal skeleton consists of fan-like bundles and wisps of spiculcs, isolated or proceeding upwards and spreading out from the terminal main fibres. Spicules. Megascleres. Smooth styles, 590 x 25 /u, curved, with a niucro at the head end. Ectosomal spicules, 344 x 12'5 n, sub-amphitylote, fusiform, with a manJn.-il ring of vertical spines at both ends and a terminal central spike at one extremity. Microsderes. Palmate anisochelae of two sizes, a large kind 35 M long and 10 '7 M broad, with thick shaft ; with triangular palmate tooth, 17'5 M long, at the large end. not quite as long nor as broad as the alae ; lower margin of alae convex. Lower central tooth with a curved upper edge produced into a spine. A small kind 17'5 n long, 6'2 M broad ; upper palmate tooth triangular, rounded above, as broad and as long as the alae ; lower border of alae concave; lower tooth with simple rounded upper edge. Bipocilla varying in length from 5'5 to 11 /u., according to the convexity of the shaft which is usually deeply curved ; both ends spathulate, nearly similar, and with crenulate edges, or with 5-7 teeth. The fine specimen (No. 184) which constitutes the type of the new specie-. is 24 cm. wide and 25'6 cm. high. Unfortunately, owing to the very soft nature of the tissues, the sponge has been broken into many fragments. A short stein expands into a palmate portion, from the edge of which arise several compressed digitate branches, usually with round sphinctrate oscules along one edge ; the oscules lead into a pseudogastral cavity extending nearly to the opposite edge of the branch. The bipocilla of the new species somewhat resemble those of /. .^jinlulatuft, but the difference in the body form, skeletal arrangement and spiculation are too many to necessitate detailed enumeration. A second specimen (No. 202) has two compressed branches rising from a flattened contracted lia.se, the under surface of which is coated with pebbles. The oscules face each other along the edges of the entering angle. The branches are each about 10 cm. in length, the greatest breadth being 4'5 cm. A third specimen (No. 287) of this species, which might, indeed, be rc'janled as a variety, forms a discoid crust on a small Ophiurid. There are embryos, 340 M in diameter, present, and some, but not all, of these have a plug of peculiar tylote spicules in them, with a ring of anisocheles round the outer end of the bundle. The tylote spicules of the embryo, Kil x 7'8 M, have a smooth rounded end surrounded by spines, the other end being evlindrical with marginal spines, aiid a single central spine. 32 R. KIRKPATRICK. The auisocheles of the embryos nearly resemble the smaller kind of these spicules found in the choanosome of the type specimen. The type specimen (No. 184) was dredged near Winter Quarters, No. 11 hole, 28 fms. ; specimens 202, 287, and 289 were dredged from No. 10 hole, 130 fms. DIFFERENTIAL DIAGNOSIS OF THE FOUR SPECIES OF IOPHON WITH MODIFIED ACANTHOSTYLES. * Shape. Ectosomal Spicules. Bipocilla. lophon unicornis . Massive, of irregular con- figuration ; h'stular os- cules rising from upper surface. 240 x 10/i. Heads with a bouquet of spines at extremities. Absent. lophon pluricornis Plate-like ; oscules appa- rently level with surface. 280 X 10 /x. Heads elliptical, with spines at extremities, or over the whole surface of head. Apparently with po- cillate end or ends. lophon spatulatus . Slender cylindrical ; with oscules slightly raised. 225 X 12-5 /x. Ends truncate, with spines at extremities only. Having spathulate ends with crenulated edges. lophon flabello-digitatus Palmato - digitate, with oscules along the edges of branches. 344 x 12T> /x. Ends truncate, with ter- minal marginal rim of spines at both ends and terminal central spike at one end. Having spathulate ends with crenulated edges. TEDANIA VARIOLOSA. (Plate XXL, figs. 1, la, and Plate XXV., fig. la-b.) 1907. Tedania variolosa Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 279). Sponge in form of a mass of thick rlabellate or digitate fronds arising from a common base ; with circular sphiuctrate oscules, each about 1 cm. in diameter, situated at the summits, or along the upper edges of the branches, the canals into which they lead extending nearly to the base of the branches. General surface of the sponge covered with circular pore areas each about 4 mm. in diameter, the oval or circular pores being about 90 n in diameter, and the strands of the poral reticulum about 30 /j. in breadth. Colour in spirit, pale brown. Consistence, soft and fleshy, being easily torn. Flagellated chambers, 42 x 35 M, oval, aphodal, with aphodus (in a measured example), 13 M long- Skeleton. Choanosomal skeleton formed of loosely agglomerated compound, longitudinal or main bundles about 1 mm. in diameter, curving out to the surface as TETKAXOXIDA. 33 they pass upwards; the separate fibres of the main lnmdles altout 80 /m thick. The main bundles joined at right-angles by secondary fibres, 1-3 spicules thick. Spongin not perceptible. Ectosomal skeleton formed of circles of strongyles, the spicules isolated or in fan-like wisps, arranged partly vertically, partly tangeutially round the pure areas : the vertical spicules usually isolated, and the tangential ones in wisps. On drying tin- sponge, the edges of the pore areas stand up sharply, the areas themselves sinking in, giving a pock-marked aspect to the surface. Spicules. Megascleres. Choanosomal styles, 402 X 13 /", curved at about one- fourth of the length from the round end, smooth, but occasionally with a few spines about the head. Ectosomal strongyles, 261 x G'5 /u, smooth, occasionally slightly swollen at each* end. Microsclerea. None. The single specimen is in the form of a squarish mass of thick fleshy flabello- palmate or digitate lobes ; the height is 18 cm., and the breadth 13 cm. The flabellate fronds are obviously formed of fused tubular digitations, as can be seen from the oscules along the upper edge and from the faintly indicated longitudinal grooves down the sides. The walls of the oscular canals are smooth and lined with numerous orifices of exhalant canals, about 3 mm. in diameter. The arrangement of the pores in circular areas each surrounded by a zone of ectosomal spicules is not common in Tedania ; it occurs in the second new species described below, and something of the kind is found in Tcdnn'ui tenuicapitata Ridley (15a. p. 124), from the Straits of Magellan. In the present species this feature is so well marked as to give the surface a pock-marked appearance. The rhaphides, usually so characteristic of TrJiuiln, have entirely disappeared ; but the loss of microsclcres is of such frequent occurrence that it has not seemed necessary to create a new genus or subgenus to include such forms ; though, perhaps, the more or less definite arrangement of the ectosomal spicules might, in the present instance, necessitate such a course. The specimen wa.s dredged near Winter Quarters, 10 fms. TEDANIA COULMANI. (Plate XXL, fig. 2. Plate XXV., lig. 2a-b\) I'.inT. Ti'ilanlti coiiliiiiini Kirkpiitnrk (10a. p. -Si>). Description. The single specimen is in the form of a finger-like IVagmeni 5*5 cm. long and 17 cm. in its greatest thiekness. The colour is dirty gray, and the consistence soft. The surface shows the same circular pure-sieve areas as in 7' rl<»«i. Along one side of the sponge the surface has been turn away, exposing an exhalant canal running along the length of the specimen, but the terminal oscule has apparently been torn away. 2 E 2 34 R. KIRKPATRICK. Skeleton. Rings of spicules partly vertical, partly tangential, isolated or in tufts, surround the pore areas. The choanosomal skeleton is formed of primary longitudinal fibres about 120 jj. thick, joined by secondary fibres one spicule in length and 2-3 in thickness, joining the former at right angles. Spicules. Megascleres. The choanosomal acanthostyles, 475 x 18 /*, curved, smooth, or with sparse spines, usually on the upper and lower thirds of the length. Dermal ectosomal tornotes, 319 x 12 '5 //, smooth, straight, fusiform, larger at one end than the other. Under a high power each end shows a rounded shoulder "prolonged into a mucronate spine. Microscleres absent. The present species resembles T. variolosa in having the circular pore areas, and in the absence of rhaphides, but differs widely in the character of the dermal toruotes. Both species differ from all other species of Tcdania in having no microscleres. The nearest species to the present one are Tedania tenuicapitata Ridley, from the Straits of Magellan, and Trachytedania spinata Ridley, from the same locality ; both of these have rhaphides, and neither have the circular pore areas, though in T. tenuicapitata there is a tendency to a radial arrangement of bundles of dermal spicules. The spination of the acanthostyles recalls a similar character in Trachyte- dania spinata. The specimen was dredged off Coulman Island in 100 fms. II. GROUP MYCALEAE, LUNDBECK. ARTEMISINA APOLLINIS. (Plate XX., figs. 4, 4a-c.) 1887. Amphileetiis apollinis Ridley and Dendy (15. p. 124). 1894. Artemisina apollinis Topsent (24. p. 13). 1905. Artemisina apollinis Lundbeck (13. p. 114). 1907. Artemisina apollinis Topsent (31. p. 70). The single example is a massive cake-shaped specimen 8x8 cm. in area, and 4 ' 5 cm. in its greatest thickness. The colour is dirty white in alcohol. One of the surfaces is smooth and opaque, and probably the sponge lay free on the bottom on this side. There is a large oval oscule (l'5x '5 cm.) on one of the edges, and several much smaller oscules on the upper surface. The sizes, in /A, of the spicules are :— curved styles 600 x 16 ; straight styles 400 x 6 ; chelae 13 ; toxa 300 (or less) x 3. The flagellated chambers, 29 x 23 n in diameter, are eurypylous. An interesting feature, not occurring in the type specimen from Kerguelen Island, is the presence of small fusiform villous processes (XX. 4a) on the surface, especially round the margins of the oscules ; similar villi, but larger, are found in the nearly related sponge named Esperiopsis edwardii, var. americana R, and D. The finding of this sponge in the Antarctic adds another to the list of bipolar species. TETRAXONIDA. 35 Topsent (31. p. 70) records a new species, Artemisina olt!»!x. The 'Discovery' specimen resembles A. dianae in having curved styles of the same length, but they are narrower ; and the spiued toxa are much smaller in the first species. The specimen was dredged near Winter Quarters, off Hut Point, 25-30 fms. The 'Challenger' obtained specimens from Kerguelen Island, 20-60 fms.; and the Danish Ingolf Exp. from East Greenland, depth ? , Lundbeck. ESPERIOPSIS VILLOSA. (Plate XX., figs. 3, 3a-c, and Plate XXIV., figs. 9a-lr.) 1*71. Esperiopsis villosa Carter (1. p. 21;)). iss7. Exfirriii/isix rUlnsfi- Fristcdt (7. p. 451). 1904. Espcrinpsis villosa Topscnt (30. p. 211). 1905. Esperiopsis villosa Lundbeck (13. p. 9). The single specimen, which has been broken off from its attachment, is massive below, but divides above into two cylindrical lobes. The colour is pale brown in spirit. A few small oscules, evidently much contracted, occur at the summits of the lobes. The surface is finely villous, from the presence of the projecting points of fan-like lines of oxeas. Here and there the flesh has become macerated away, leaving fluffy lines of fine skeleton fibres. The only difference worthy of mention that I can find bet \veen the Northern and Antarctic specimens is the absence of the placocheles or isochelae palmatae with broad shafts. I can only discover two kinds of isochelae palmatae. The sigmata occur in many sizes. Some have bifurcated terminations, as figured by Fristcdt, and Lundbeck. Spicules. Megasclcres. Styles 671 x 18 M, fusiform, straight, occasionally with head slightly bent. The styles in Carter's type from Faroe arc almost identical in character. Mieroscleres. Larger palmate isochelae, 43 /u long, 9'75/u broad, length of teeth, 16 M. Smaller palmate isochelae, 18/u long, 4 M broad. Sigmata, numerous, varying from small up to very large sizes. The distribution of this species is very interesting, occurring as it does in Arctic and sul)- Arctic waters ; then, as an intermediate link between Arctic and Antarctic, in deep water off the Azores. The specimen was dredged near Winter Quarters, in Ab-Munlo May, -'0 fms. This species has been found (l) Between Scotland and Fame, 440 frns., Carter; E. Coast of Greenland, 2f>4 in. (140 fms.), Kristedt ; off Iceland, Denmark Strait and Davis Strait, 44-553 fms., Lundbrrk ; Azores 2,252 m. (1,196 fms.), Topscut. 36 R. KIRKPATRICK. MYCALE "MAGELLANICA. (Plate XX., fig. 2.) 1881. Esperia magellanica Ridley (15a. p. 117). 1887. Esperella mafjellanira Ridley and Dendy (15. p. (i7). 1905. Mijcale magellanim Thiule (23. p. 142). The ' Discovery ' collection contains one large piece, much damaged. The figure (XX. 2) shows the smooth surface in contrast to the hispid surface of the new species M. acerata described below. The specimen was dredged near Winter Quarters, from No. 10 hole, 130 fms. The species is also recorded from Sandy Point, 7-10 fms. ; from Otter Island, Patagonia ; and from east of Cape Virgins. MYCALE ACERATA. (Plate XX., figs. 1, la-b, and Plate XXIV., figs. lOa-e1.) 1907. Myxitta acerata Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 280). Sponge large, massive, with numerous small rounded mammillae ; surface finely reticulate and finely hispid. Colour, creamy-white in spirit. Consistence, soft, the tissues being easily torn. The flesh reddish (but soon decolorised), and showing the glistening white strands of the skeleton. Oscules in form of wide thin-walled cylindrical chimneys with rather jagged upper edges, about 1 cm. in height, and 1-2 cm. in diameter. Skeleton. Ectosomal : — A network of triangular meshes formed by bundles of oxeas, the strands being from '35 mm. thick and the meshes about '5 mm. across. Main skeleton formed of long thick anastomosing fibres which attenuate gradually from 1'5 mm. in thickness and break up a' little below the surface into panicles of much finer fibres which support the dermal membrane and penetrate the strands and nodes of the dermal reticulum, giving rise to a finely hispid condition of the surface. Parallel groups of oxeas scattered in the choanosome. Spicules. Megascleres. Oxeas 850 x 16' 25 M, slightly curved, rather abruptly pointed at one end, and more tapering at the other. These oxeas form the fibres, and also are gathered into bundles, one spicule in length, of parallel oxeas, scattered in the choanosome. Microscleres. Large anisochelae palmatae, 105 x 50 M, separate or in rosettes, usually with an angular bend in the shaft ; with a triangular upper tooth GO M long, about the same length as the upper alae, which latter are very wide. With the lower tooth oblong, 12- 8 M high, with a slightly convex edge; in one of the specimens this edge is produced into a long denticle (XXIV. 10 c). A smaller kind of auisochelae palmatae (fig. lOd, d1), 47 M long and 17 M broad, at the upper end, with a long oval tooth 20 /u long, extending below the alae. Trichodragmata, 02 x 12 /u, the trichites being very fine, sharply -pointed oxeas. There are three fine specimens of this species, the largest forming a thick TETRAXOXIDA. 37 massive flabellate body 17 cm. high, tl cm. broad, and 7 cm. thick; a second specimen is massive and spheroidal, 1 icing about 15 cm. in diameter. The white maiumillatecl surface covers a reddish flesh in which the glistening fibres of the skeleton are visible. The mammillae are on an average about • 75 cm. in height, and 1 cm. in diameter at the base. The new species bears a very close resemblance to Mycale magellanica Ridley, which likewise has a mammillated, finely reticulate surface and glistening skeletal fibres, but in the latter the surface is smooth and not hispid (XX. 2), and the megascleres are styles, or sub-tyles, such as are normally found in the genus Mycale. The microscleres also are different in the two species. A second species of Mycale with oxeate megascleres is Mycale intermedia (0. Sch.), from East Greenland (16. p. 433) and Thiele (22. p. 381, fig. 12). The specimen consisted only of a fragment ; the spicules, which are all considerably smaller than in the Antarctic species, have the following dimensions: — Oxeas, 450 M long, 10-12 /* thick; large auisocheles, 50-60 n long; small anisocheles, 18 /u long. Specimens were dredged from three separate localities near Winter Quarters, viz.: (1) No. 6 hole, 125 fins.; (2) No. 12 hole, 25-30 fins.; No. 5 hole, seal hole, 178 fins. MYCALE, sp. Several pieces of glistening white skeletal framework were dredged from No. 12 hole. The largest is cylindrical, 7 cm. long and about 3 cm. in diameter. A very small quantity of the body substance still remains in some of the angles of the meshwork. The spicules are: — Styles, fusiform, straight, abruptly pointed, 5G2 x 17'5/u; large palmate auisochelae, separate or in rosettes, 100 /x long and 35 M broad, with the larger tooth 47 M long, nearly the same length as the alae, triangular, with straight lower border; with the central tooth at the smaller cud squarish, with straight upper edge; small anisochelae, 14x48/u, with oval tooth 28 n long, extending further than the alae; sigmata 224 /u long, 104^ broad, and G'5/u thick. This species resembles in many respects a form described by Thiele (23- p. I !•"•. fig. 61, a-d) as Mycale sp., from Puuta Arenas, Straits of Magellan ; but the sigmata are much smaller in the South American form, being only 15 /j., and the small anisochelae are smaller and with a narrower and shorter upper central tooth. No specific name is given, owing to the incompleteness of the specimens. Dredged near Winter Quarters, No. 12 hole, 25-30 fins. DESMACIDON KERGUELENENSIS var. antarctica. (Plate XIX., figs. 1, IA, and Plate XXIII., figs. la-dl.) Desmacidon hfirguelenmsis Ridley and Dendy (15. p. 110). Sponge ovoid or cylindrical, with hispid or finely conulatcd surface, the couules surmounted by fine tufts of spicules, couules and tufts rising to a height of 1 to 2 mm. Consistence, soft ; colour in spirit, dirty white. 38 R. KIRKPATRICK. A single round osculc at the summit. Pores round or oval, scattered, 20 M in diameter. Dermal layer not detachable; sub-dermal spaces 190 M in depth. Flagellated chambers about 30 M in diameter. Skeleton composed of rather thick main fibres about 10 spicules broad viewed en face, about 190Mor more in thickness, with a few loose spicules between the main fibres, scattered, but with a tendency to be parallel to the surface, and forming distinct horizontal bundles just below the surface. Spongin is present, but not easy to detect. Spicules. Megascleres. Oxeas 676 X 26 /m, slightly curved at centre, terminating gradually in fine points. Microscleres. Isocheles 1 9 • 5 /« long, 6 • 5 M broad in lateral view, with slender convex shaft without perceptible alae ; with broad saddle-shaped teeth with their distal edges not far from each other, but not touching or overlapping. Four small specimens of this sponge were obtained. The largest is 4 cm. long and 1 • 4 cm. in diameter. The surface has a finely hispid aspect in two specimens, but is finely conulated in the third, and smooth and worn down in the fourth. The variety differs from the type (15. p. 110) in having much larger megascleres, those of the type being only 350 x 18 M- The isocheles of the type, again, are longer, viz., 28 /*. After a careful examination of the isocheles of the Kerguelen specimen in a good light and with the spicules slowly rotating in balsam, I found that the median sub-dental continuation of the shaft did not bend backwards from the tooth as in Desrnacidon (Homoeodictya) palmata ; the appearance of bending back (see 15. PI. xxiii., fig. 36) being due to the lateral bend of the palmate tooth ; accordingly, even if Homoeodictya be a true genus or sub-genus, D. kerguelenensis would not belong to it. Three specimens were dredged near Winter Quarters, from No. 12 Hole, 25-30 fms. ; off Hut Point, 100 fms. ; and off Coulman Island, 100 fms. DESMACIDON KERGUELENENSIS var. cactoides. (Plate XIX., fig. 2, and Plate XXIIL, fig. 2a-b1.) Sponge pyriform, laterally compressed ; surface prickly, with an Acanthella-like aspect. Consistence rather firm. Colour in spirit, pale yellow. Skeleton formed of rather stout main fibres proceeding to the surface, where they conspicuously push up the dermal membrane, with scattered spicules in between the main fibres. Spicules. Megascleres. Slightly curved strongyles, but sometimes with rather blunt pointed ends (i.e. oxeas), 768 x 31 '25 p.. Microscleres. Isochelae palmatae 17 M long and 6'25/u broad with the wide saddle-shaped palmate teeth almost in contact or even overlapping. The single specimen is attached to a worm tube by a contracted stalk-like base ; the length is 5-5 cm., and the greatest breadth 3'5 cm. It was a matter of doubt whether to regard this form as a distinct species ; but it will be obvious from the TETKAXONIDA. 39 figures of the spicules that the differences between the var. antarctica and var. cactoides are merely those of degree ; the teeth of the isochelae, for instance, are more approximated in the latter than in the former ; further, the rounding of the ends of the oxeas is not an important distinction ; and lastly, the cactus-like surface would result from a branching of the ends of" the skeletal fibres just below the surface, so that the dermal layer would stretch over the points of bifurcation. If the new variety were devoid of clieles it would be placed under Bntzella, thus justifying Thiele's observation (23. p. 438) that the latter genus might be regarded as a Dusmacidon which had lost its chelae. One specimen was dredged from Winter Quarters, No. IL! hole, '25-30 fms. DESMACIDON SPINIGERA. (Plate XIX., figs. 3, 3A, and Plate XXIII., figs. Sa-c1.) 1907. lii'xmafulon spinigera Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 2s:'.). Sponge digititbrm, or knob-like ; surface coarsely spinous. Consistence rather hard: Colour pale red. Several small oscules about 2 mm. in diameter. Dermal membrane spread like a delicate net between the spines, and at some distance from the floors of the sub-dermal spaces. Flagellated chambers oval, 46x32 p. Skeleton formed of coarse, longitudinal, main strands, about 180 /A thick, radiating out to the surface, with loose scattered spicules between, united in horizontal bundles only beneath the surface. Spicules. Megascleres. Oxeas 731 x 2G/A, curved at centre, mostly sub-toruote, though some attenuate gradually, with sharp pointed ends. Microscleres, of one kind, viz., isochelae palmatae, 24 '64 p. long, and 5'28ju broad on side view ; pointed at each end ; with straight axis ; with palmate teeth 8 ' 8 ft long, and with narrow alae 8 • 8 ft long. Four specimens were obtained. The type specimen (XIX. 3) from 10 hole, 130 fms., is digitate, 7'5 cm. in length and 2 cm. in diameter. The spines are •2- '5 cm. long, those at the lower end pointing obliquely upwards, but above becoming vertical to the long axis. Another specimen forms a spheroidal knob encrusting the stem of a zoophyte. A third specimen is in the form of cylindrical fragments. A fourth specimen, much macerated, is massive and bifurcated, and about 12 '5 cm. long ; further there is a considerable amount of spougin present, sometimes appearing as distinct fibres, where the spicules have become lost or dissolved away. The spicules are in all respects identical with those of the foregoing forms. This species bears much resemblance to Desmacidon setifer, Topsent, obtained by the ' Belgica ' from the Antarctic. The isocheles are of much the same character, but those of D. setifer are very much larger, viz., 75-100 M by 18-20 /x. Further, 2 F 40 R. KIRKPATRICK. the consistence of D. setifer is soft, the colour yellowish in spirit, and the surface hispidation much finer. The four specimens were dredged : (l) No. 48, from 10 hole, 130 fms. ; (2) No. 124, near Winter Quarters, 20 fms. ; (3) No. 124b, off Coulman Island, 100 fms. ; (4) No. 126a, from 12 hole, 25-30 fms. DESMACIDON MAEANDRINA. (Plate XIX., figs. 4, 4a, and Plate XXIII. , figs. 4a-bs.) 1907. Desmae-idon maeandrina Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 282). Description. — The material consists of three sub-cylindrical fragments tapering at the distal end. The consistence is hard and dense. The colour in spirit is dirty brownish-gray. The surface is fairly uniformly level, and presents flattened papillae or meandriue ridges, slightly roughened at the top by projecting oxeas (best seen on side view with a lens). The dermal membrane roofs over the grooves and spaces between the papillae and ridges. The pores are mostly circular and about 95 n in diameter. The small circular oscules, numerous and scattered, are about 1 mm. in diameter. The skeleton is formed of a thick, main axis, consisting of rather loose, longitudinal strands ; from this are given off at right angles cylindrical or lamellar bundles of loose strands, which proceed to the surface and form the papillae and ridges. SpiculeS. Megascleres. Oxeas, 579 x 39 /x, curved (usually) or bent at the centre, with sharp, pointed ends. Microscleres. Isancorae uuguiferae, 26 p. long, and 15 ' 8 M broad, shaft strongly curved and 3 • 52 M thick. With usually five teeth or claws, about 5'28M long, at each end, viz., a central, single, and two lateral bifurcated teeth. The largest of the three pieces of this sponge is 6 • 2 cm. long and 1 6 mm. in diameter. The fragments appear to be broken off from some branched specimen, and I shall refer to them as branches. They are sub-cylindrical, being slightly compressed in one plane. The chamber system is aphodal, the flagellated chambers (44 x 29 /JL) being pyriform. There is a considerable amount of variation in the teeth of the isancorae, the number varying from three to six, the most usual number being five. In some respects the new species resembles Desmacidon($) ramosa (R. and D.) (15. p. 107), obtained by the ' Challenger ' from the Cape of Good Hope and Marion Island. In both species there is a central axis of longitudinal fibres, whence fibres proceed to the surface at right angles, but here the resemblance ends. In the' ' Challenger ' species the radiate bundles branch in a fan-like manner, finally forming an almost uniform surface layer of vertical oxeas. The microscleres in D. (?) ramosa are isochelae arcuatae. As in the case of D. (?) ramosa, it is doubtful whether the new species, with its Haspailia-like skeleton of axial and radial fibres, should be placed under Desmacidon or under a new genus. The specimens were dredged off Coulman Island, 100 fms. TETRAXOXIDA. 41 JOYEUXIA BELLI.* (Plate XVI., Figs. l-5a.) 1H07. Joyeuxia belli Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 283). Sponge attached, ovoid, with a thick firm rind enclosing a soft pulp. With short conical oscular, and long trumpet-shaped poral papillae. Surface finely pilose. Colour of surface yellow, of the rind whitish, and of the pith deep yellow. Flagellated chambers '23 X 20 /u, ; diplodal. Skeleton. Cortical skeleton formed of layers of strougyles crossing each other at right angles. The walls of the oscular and poral papillae supported by a layer of longitudinal strongyles. The surface of the sponge hirsute, with a fine pile of strongyles standing out at right angles or obliquely. Choanosome without spicules. Spicules. Slightly flexuous smooth strongyles 850 p. long, 10 p iu diameter at the ends, and 13 p in diameter at the centre. There is one adult specimen 5 cm. long, 3 • 5 cm. broad and 3 cm. thick, with a deep groove on the under aspect, by which it was probably attached to a worm tube or stem of a Hydroid. There is also a small conical specimen 6 mm. high, attached to a piece of rock. I was at first disposed to regard this remarkable species as a member of a new genus, partly on account of its very thick rind, which is in places over a millimetre in thickness, and partly because of the highly specialised poral papillae ; but apart from these characters, the new form evidently shows the closest affinities to Joyeuxia. The three hitherto described species all have a rind enclosing a soft pulp, the latter being without or almost without a skeleton ; then too the pulp is highly coloured. Joyeuxia tubulosa Topsent and /. ascidioides (Fristedt) have fistulae, which, however, appear to be oscular. Two of the species, .7. virldis and J. tubulosa. have strougyles; J. ascidioides has tyles and also cheles. Accordingly Topsent places the genus near Desmacidon. The poral papillae attain a height of 1 to 1 "2 cm. ; they are expanded at the end, the margin being sharp, usually a little jagged, and showing the ends of strougyles. The mouth is closed by a sieve-like funnel-shaped membranous pore-area, which is supported on its under surface by strands of tissue passing from the wall of the tube to the poral membrane. The tube passes through the thick cortex into the choanosome, where it expands before branching into four or five inhalant canals. Between certain parts of the inner surface of the cortex and the choanosome is what appears to be a space (see XVI. 2) ; but in other parts the choanosome abuts on to the cortex ; probably these peripheral spaces do not result from contraction of the tissues, but form part of the exhalant canal system. * Named in honour of Emeritus Professor F. J. Bell, of the Zoological Department of the Natural History Museum, and editor of the " Reports on the Natural History Collections " brought home l>v the ' Discovery ' from the Antarctic. 2 K 'J 42 R. KIRKPATPJCK. The inconspicuous oscular papillae are only about 4 mm. high, and are tightly contracted. The tissue of the cortex is crowded with branched collencytes immersed in a gelatinous matrix. I am indebted to Professor Dendy for pointing out to me certain resemblances between the poral and oscular papillae of Latrunculia and the present species ; in the case of both genera, too, the tissues are rich in pigment. Possibly we may have here a clue to the true position of Latrunculia, the discasters of which appear to be spined oxeas, or styles, the spines of which have become verticillate. The specimens were dredged near Winter Quarters, Flagon Point, 10-20 fms. Joyeuxia viridis Topsent was obtained from the Azores, 454-845 metres ; /. tulndosa Topsent, also from the Azores, from 200 metres ; and /. ascidioides (Fristedt) from Baffin Bay, 169 fms. (7. p. 445). CERCIDOCHELA Kirkpatrick.* 1907. CercidocMa Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 2*4). Mycalinae with peculiar shuttle-shaped chelte or canonochelae,f with the single central teeth from each end of the shaft joined together, and with a semi-circular vertical lamella extending inwards from the shaft and from the dental bridge, so as nearly to meet. CERCIDOCHELA LANKESTERI.| (Plate XIX., figs. 5, 5 A, and Plate XXIII. , fig. 5a-l.) 1907. Cercidochela lankesteri Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 284). Sponge elongated, slender, fusiform. Colour white ; consistence soft. Surface smooth to the naked eye, but finely hispid under a lens. With several small scattered oscules about 1 mm. in diameter, level with the surface. Flagellated chambers aphodal, oval, 31 x 21 fj.. Skeleton formed of long longitudinal lines of spicule fibres about 100/« thick, not forming a definite central axis, radiating out in plumose manner to the surface ; with a few isolated spicules arranged in a scalariform manner at right angles to main fibres. Spongin not perceptible. Spicules. Megascleres. Oxeas 452 x 19'5/j, curved at centre, attenuating gradually to sharp points slightly planed away on inner aspect. Microscleres. Canonochelae, somewhat shuttle-shaped,§ 45'5/x long by 22'75/w broad, with the two teeth fused to form a bridge, and with a semi-circular lamella passing upwards from * KfpKis, t'So?, a shuttle. t Kavtav, ovos. a shuttle. f Named in honour of Professor Sir E. Ray Lankester, K.C.B., F.R.S. § The canonochelae are, in this species, shaped like an oval basin with a truncated bottom, but they look shuttle-like as commonly seen in balsam slides, viz., lying on one side with the lamellae uppermost (see XIX. Of). TETUAXOXIDA. i:'> the shaft and downwards from the dental bridge, both lamellae being mearly on the same plane and nearly meeting, the lamellae sometimes with basal tubercles. Developmental forms in shape of thin oval linear bodies, the oval at first not being complete. The unique specimen representing the new genus and species is 12 '5 cm. long and 1 cm. in breadth at the centre. The body attenuates to fine ends, and apparently has not been attached to anything. The remarkable canonochelae recall to mind the spherancorae of Melonanchora, but the latter spicules have three pairs of fused teeth. The cauonochelae are scattered about in the choanosomc in considerable numbrrs. The shape may be compared with an oval basin with the bottom cut out, and with two semi-circular lids or lamellae passing horizontally from the upper edge of the basin. so as to nearly meet ; further it is necessary to imagine such a basin turned up on its side. The earliest developmental forms have an elongated C shape ; then the open Q becomes a closed oval ; by this time the falx at each end is perceptible, and the beginnings of the lamellae appear. A further change leads to a marked asymmetry, the thin oval ring becoming a broad baud by widening in a direction away from the edges whence the lamellae arise. If the widening of the baud were to continue the growing edges would meet and a sort of lateral dome would result, but growth does not go so far as this. It is often difficult to make out the real form of a transparent body, with its lines, curves, lamellae, &c., crossing each other in various directions and altering their appearance with the slightest shifting of position. In the present instance the figures will show the remarkable variations in form corresponding to change in position, and it was only after a very prolonged examination that the real shape became apparent, a result finally due to Mr. Highley's ingenuity in devising a medium of suitable consistency in which the spicules could be made to slowly rotate on their long and short axes. Fig. 5 f is the position in which, in spicule preparations, the spicules commonly lie, viz., on the detruncated bottom of the basin and with the lamellar edges uppermost. Fig. 5 h, which resembles the Diatom Amphora, shows the aspect when the shaft portion or the dental portion of the band is uppermost and viewed in its breadth ; the axial canal which traverses the shaft and part of the dental bridge is best seen in this aspect. When a spicule in this position continues to rotate a little more we see either the lamellae along one side or the free growing edges of the band on the other. Fig. 5g shows the growing edge of the dental bridge nearly meeting the edge of the shaft. Fig. 5k shows half of a spicule broken across, with the axial canal (which forms nearly a complete circuit) exposed at each lower CUI-IHT ,,(' the figure. Lastly an end view is seen in fig. 5 1. The specimen was dredged near Winter Quarters at No. 10 hole, 1.30 fms. 44 R. KIRKPATRICK. HOPLAKITHARA Kirkpatrick.* 1907. HnplakUhara Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 285). Mycalinae possessing exotyles with large spherical spined heads, and with fim- briated placocheles. HOPLAKITHARA DENDYI. (Plate XIX., figs. 6, Ga, 6b, and Plate XXIII., fig. 6a-c2.) 1907. Hoplakitliiira dnuliji Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 286). Sponge in form of a small cushion, attached by a narrow base. Surface smooth to the naked eye. Colour, pale brown in spirit. Consistence, hard externally, soft within. Flagellated chambers 32 * 5 M in diameter, spheroidal, curypylous. Skeleton with protective armour formed by gigantic spheroidal heads of exotyles, the exotyles being arranged as radiating bundles in form of inverted cones, with the apices a little below the cortex ; with scattered strongyles. Spicules. Megascleres. Exotyles f with the heads a little inclined to the long axis of the spicule, the proximal end (in the interior of the sponge) rounded, the distal end swollen into large spherical heads, with short cylindrical spines covering the distal three-fourths of the head. Total length 358/u, the shaft enlarging in diameter from 6 • 5 ^ at the proximal end .to 16 M just below the head. Head, 55 /x in diameter ; cylindrical denticles, 1 • 76 to 3 • 52 p. in height, with finely denticulate edge, and with cup-like depression at the summit. Strongyles straight, fusiform, smooth, 467 ' 5 /u long, 9'75M iu diameter at centre, 6 ' 5 M in diameter at ends. Microscleres. Placocheles, fimbriated, 84 • 5 M long, 29 • 25 p. broad ; length of tooth, 37-75 n. Sigmata very small, slender, Q-shaped, 8 • 8 n long, 5 ' 28 M broad, • 9 /j. thick. The minute spheroidal or cushion-shaped specimen was 2 • 2 mm. in height and 3 mm. in horizontal diameter ; it was growing on the side of an Alcyonarian, creeping- over a branched Cellepora. No pores or oscules were discernible. The under surface, which was narrowed to the point of attachment, was paler in colour than the upper. The new genus is closely related to the Mycaline genera Rhaphidotheca and Guitarra, to the former by its exotyles, and to the latter by its fimbriated placocheles. The distal knobs of the exotyles of E. marshall-hallii Kent, 49 M in diameter, are smooth and spherical, and those of 7?. rhopalophora Schmidt (/?. affinis Carter, s^Thiele 22. p. 383) are 104 n long and 30 /u broad and club-shaped. Lundbeck (13. p. 32) regards these two species as probably identical, and certainly the differences are slight. In the centre of the heads of the exotyles of //. dendyi is an oval granular zone, which at first suggests a cavity filled with protoplasm, but that there is no cavity is * oTrXn (pi. of u7rXm<), armour; Kidupn, a guitar. t 1'rot'essor ]>fndy. to whom I showed these remarkable exotyles with their large spined heads, regarded them as possible examples of spieules which might form a surface layer of pseudasters by reduction of the shafts. TETRAXONIDA. 45 evident from the fact that the axial canal can be seen traversing the granular zone. Some of the exotyles have one or more swellings in the length of the shaft. The single example was dredged near Winter Quarters, at No. 6 hole, in 130 fins. FAMILY HAPLOSCLERIDAE TOPSENT. SUB-FAMILY GELL1INAE RIDLEY AND DENDY. GELLIUS RUDIS. (Plate XVII., figs. 1, IA, and Plate XXIV., fig. i a-l>.) r.HiL'. 6V/////S null's, Topsent (29. p. 14, PI. I., fig. 0, and PI. III., fig. 4). The type of this species, described by Topsent, was a small globular specimen 27 mm. in diameter. The present collection contains six pieces of this sponge, some of them of large size ; accordingly 1 am enabled to slightly supplement the original description. The largest fragment, 18 x 5 x 2'5 cm. in dimensions, is massively lobate and closely resembles Petrosia similis var. massa R. and D. (15. plate III., fig. 6).* The other specimens are in the form of thick sub-cylindrical unbrauched or branched fragments, the largest (PI. XVII., fig. 1) being 14 cm. in length and '2' 5 cm. in diameter. Several of the pieces have oseules about 7 mm. in diameter with circular raised rims. The surface, where the dermal membrane is intact, is to the naked eye quite smooth ; though, where the dermis is rubbed off, the surface appears very finely hispid as Topsent describes, and feels rough to the touch. A vertical section of a branch in the plane of the axis shows main longitudinal lines of fibres curving outwards from the axis to the surface as they pass upwards, and dividing in a more or less paniculate fashion near the surface ; the secondary fibres, one or two spicules thick in the centre of the specimen, become much thicker a little below the dermal membrane. The oxeas (XXIV. la), 403 x 20 M, are sub-tornote. The C-shaped sigmata have a uniform curve almost in one plane ; they are 37 M long, 19-4^ broad, and '8 /u thick, * In this variety the skeletal arrangement is very similar to that found in Gelliiis ntdis; the terminal branehlets of the main fibres arc spread out beneath the dermal layer, and anastomose with branehlets from neighbouring main fibres ; this sub-dermal reticuluin, then, is due solely to the spreading out of the periphery of the paniculate ends of the main fibres (as in G. rutlis), and is not as one might at first suppose a special dermal skeleton ; the central tufts of the main fibres proceed vertically up to the surface ; also, not a few scattered oxeas pass obliquely or vertically upwards from the subdermal network of spicule fibres ; accordingly the dcniial membrane is to a great extent supported on the tips of vertical oxeas. Though Ridley and Dendy elearly saw that the dermal reticulation was only the uppermost layer of the main skeleton (15. p. 11), it was not quite correct to state that the dermal membrane was not supported on tufts of spicules ; a vertical section shows that it is sup- ported in this manner, viz., by the central tufts of all the main fibres, as wt-11 a-; by oxeas from the subdermal reticulum. The spicules of P. similis var. massa resemble those of G. rutlis in shape, but are smaller t\i/. '2'.K> x 9-75 p.). Accordingly P. similis var. massa is closely similar to G. rutlis in form, in skeletal arrangement, and in spiculation ; in fact it very probably represents an example of a GiUiiix which has lost its sigmata. I have gone into this matter in some detail because it is always interesting to trace the probable line of descent of a Renierine sponge from some form with microscleres. Further, an instance of this kind furnishes some support to part of Dendy's recent scheme of classification, viz., that of making the Gclliinae the starting-point of the Halichondrina. 46 K. KIRKPATRICK. aud frequently have a small central knob. (Figures are given for convenient comparison with the nearly related new species, G. fimbriatus, described below.) The pores, abundant over the areas roofing over the spaces between the main fibres, are circular or oval and vary from 30-70 /u in diameter ; the subderrnal spaces are about a millimetre in depth ; there are also smaller and shallower subderrnal spaces between the more central terminal branches of the main fibres. The flagellated chambers, which are unusually small, viz., about 23 n in diameter, are spheroidal and eurypylous ; as seen in section they line labyrinthine folds and spaces. The cellules spheruleuses attain the large size of 35 /« in diameter, the spherules also being of considerable size, viz., 8 p.. Sections of the branches show nests containing 30-50 embryos, forming conspicuous red patches in the sections in balsam ; each embryo is about 235 p. in diameter, and of yellowish colour, though red in masses. Some contain rhaphide-like oxeas. On the surface of the figured specimen are several little hemispherical pits from 2-5 mm. in diameter ; these are probably the exposed surfaces of the embryo-containing cavities, and not due to parasites. The specimens were dredged in McMurdo Bay, in depths up to 20 fms. The 'Belgica' obtained a specimen from Lat. 70° 23', Long. 82° 47' W., from 500 metres. GELLIUS FIMBRIATUS. (Plate XVII., figs. 2, 2a, and Plate XXIV., fig. 2a-b.) 1907. Gellius fimbriatus Kirkputrick (10a. p. 286). Sponge in form of a thick triangular cake, or conico-cylindrical. Texture soft, easily broken. Colour in spirit, pale buff. Surface level, or almost imperceptibly hispid ; showing through the dermal membrane a somewhat areolated pattern, each areola being formed by the end of a main fibre giving off fimbriated twigs which roof over the subdermal spaces between the main fibres. A few circular oscules about 5 mm. in diameter and with slightly raised rims occur. Skeleton formed of longitudinal lines of flat, loose, band -like main fibres, with an irregular and obscure reticulation of single spicules between. The main fibres spread out in a paniculate manner a little below the dermal membrane. Spicules. Megascleres. Oxeas, 537 x 16'25/A, slightly bent or curved at centre, attenuating gradually to sharp points. Sigrnata varying in size, the largest being 40 p. long, 17' G /A broad, and l'7G/x thick, with one or more angular bends in the curve, usually one end of the shaft with an angular bend, the other end curved. The specimen selected as the type of this species has a flattened angular pad-like body, 10 cm. long. 4*5 cm. broad, and 2' 5 cm. thick; it apparently lay free on the bottom. TETRAXONIDA. 47 The upper surface alone shows the areolated appearance below the dermal mem- brane, the under surface being nearly opaque. A second specimen is conico-cylindrical in shape, 1 1 cm. long and 3 cm. in diameter, the lower end being broken off. This specimen also apparently lay on the bottom along part of its length, as the pore surface extends all round only at the upper end of the specimen. A third specimen from Coulmau Island is fan-shaped, 7 cm. high, 3'5 cm. thick, 7 cm. broad at the upper edge, and 3 cm. broad at the base, where it is attached to two small stones. The surface is quite worn away, and the body of the sponge full of debris. An " areola " with its central node (the end of the main fibre) and lateral branchlets occupies on an average an area of G x 4 mm. The ends of the main til ires are arranged in linear series. The dermal membrane is separated about 3 mm. from the Hours of the large sub-dermal spaces, and the baud-like supporting pillars are about 2 mm. broad. A vertical section gives the appearance of a miniature "hall of a thousand columns." The dermal membrane on the under surface of the sponge contains scattered oxeas arranged taugentially. The pores vary a good deal in size and shape, being oval or round, and 45-1 20 p. in diameter. The flagellated chambers are spheroidal, eurypylous, and about 25 p in diameter. The triangular cushion-like shape of the type recalls to mind Gellius flagellifer (R. and D.), but there are no flagellate sigmata in the new species. G. rudis (Topsent) has a much firmer and denser structure ; the oxeas are shorter, thicker, and with tornote ends, and the sigmata are more slender and with uniform curve. Dredged near Winter Quarters, off Hut Point in 12-20 fms. ; also off Coulman Island in 100 fms. GELLIUS PILOSUS. (Plate XVII., figs. 3, 3a, and Plate XXIV., fig. 3a-c.) 1907. GeUius pilosus Kirkpatrick (lOa, p. 287). Sponge in form of an erect flattened triangular or elongate lamella divided or digitate at the upper edge. Consistence soft, fleshy, compressible. Colour in spirit, dirty white or very pale yellow. Surface finely conulose and pilose owing to the projection of the ends ot the main skeleton fibres about 1 mm., the conules being about -6 mm. apart from each other. A few osculcs about 1 mm. in diameter, on a level with the surface. Skeleton formed of slender main axial fibres on an average about 2 ."> spiciilo thick, curving out to the surface where they form the pile, and of secondary fibres, usually one, but sometimes two or three spicules thick, at right angles to the main ones, with which they form oblong scalariform ineshes. Spongin well developed at the nodes of the network. VOL. IV. 2 G 48 E. KIEKPATRICK. Spicules. Megasderes. Oxeas, 537 x 22 '7 5 p., sharp pointed, sub-tornote, a few being distinctly tornote. Microscleres. Signiata, very abundant both in choanosome and ectosome, C-shaped, 39 x 16 '25 ju, in length and breadth, and 1 '5 p, thick. There are two specimens. One of them is in the form of a triangular lamella dividing into two sub-terete branches, the total length being 10 '5 cm., the breadth 3' 5 cm., and the thickness 1 cm. The second specimen is 11 cm. long and 3 cm. broad, with little more than a notch at the upper edge, indicating a division into branches. The fleshy matter is nearly all macerated out, leaving a flexible skeletal framework. In the first specimen the surface shows the little conules penetrated by spikes 2-3 spicules thick, with squarish concave depressions about • 5 mm. between any four- con ules. The dermal pores are imperceptible. There is a thin collenchymatous ectosome about "15 mm. thick, excavated by shallow sub-dermal cavities; the eurypylous flagellated chambers are ovoid, 26 x 23 p.. The new species bears some resemblance to Gellius flagellifer (R. and D.), but differs from it in the absence of the peculiar flagellate sigmata. Further, G. flagellifer has an even surface, and a dermal skeleton network of spiculo-fibre ; but in the new species the secondary fibres, usually not more than one spicule thick, are often not present at or just below the surface. Dredged near Winter Quarters, off Hut Point, 25-30 fms. ; and at No. 12 hole, 25-30 fms. GELLIUS CUCURBITIFORMIS. (Plate XVII., figs. 5, 5a-c, Plate XXIV., figs. 5a-b.) 1007. Gellius cwurbitiformits Kirkpatrick (lOa. p. 288). Sponge small, free, bulbous with fistular prolongations. Surface smooth, showing under a lens a fine white reticulum. Colour in spirit, pale brown. Consistence, rather soft. Skeleton. With a distinct dermal layer of irregularly arranged tangential oxeas. Choanosomal skeleton a reticulum (with square or triangular meshes) of spiculo-fibre, the strands 2-3 spicules thick, with a faint indication of main fibres radiating to the surface. Spicules. Megascleres. Oxeas, 342 x 9'75/x, slightly curved, sub-tornote. Microscleres. Sigmata varying in size, the smallest being about 20 //, long, C-shaped and with uniform curve, and the largest 39 p. long, 19'8/u broad and 1 • 2 p, thick. There are two small specimens, both of which were found in a tangled mass of debris surrounding a worm-tube. The larger, the type specimen, consists of a basal bulbous portion, 13 mm. long, 7 mm. broad, and 8 mm. high, from one side of which arises a rather thick-walled fistula 13 mm. high and 5'5 mm. in diameter; at the opposite side is a broken circular area, from which, in all probability, a second fistula TETRAXONTDA. 49 arose ; lastly, between these two, is a small raised knob with a rounded orifice on one side of it. The narrow oscular canal is not central, but along one side of the thick walled complete fistula. The second specimen is tubular, with a slightly enlarged solid base, whence arises a fistula; the total length is 2'2 cm., and diameter '6 crn. No pores are discernible; the subdermal spaces are about • 2 mm. in depth. The eurypylous flagellated chambers are 23 p. in diameter. Cellules spheruleuses, 8-9 p. in diameter, are common. There is no bast-like subdermal layer as in Occanapia mollis Deudy (4. p. 248), and the spicules of the latter are smaller, the oxeas being 200 x 8 p., and the sigmata only 1C p.. Lundbeck (12. pp. 64, 6G) describes two species of GMus with fistulae, and with a well-developed dermal bark, viz. : G. luridus and G. microtoxa, but both these species have toxa in addition to sigmata. The two specimens were dredged off Hut Point (Winter Quarters) in 25-30 fms. GELLITJS GLACIALIS, var. nivea. (Plate XVII., fig. 4.) 1887. Gellius rjlacialls var. nivea Ridley and Dcndy (15. p. 42, PI. VIII., fig. 8, etc.). The one example is in the form of a small spherical knob attached to a branched Polyzoon, resembling in these respects the ' Challenger ' specimen from Prince Edward Island. The sponge, which is 17 mm. iu diameter, is brittle, and has a well-marked ectosomal skeleton formed of tangential oxeas. The megasclerea and sigmata are smaller than those of the ' Challenger ' specimen, but are in other respects of the same character ; accordingly I have not regarded the Antarctic specimen as a new variety. The larger sigmata are often united in bundles of sigmadragmata. The following table gives the dimensions in M of the spicules of G. glacialie, and of the ' Challenger ' and Antarctic specimens of var. nivea. G. glacialis. var. nivea ' Challenger.' var. liiiva 1 Discovery.' Oxeas G7ii X 4ii 704 x i".i--':. .-.I'l' X 19 Sigmata 7J X 4f> X 3'5 209 X 74-5 x 5-7 110 x G7 x i;-:> Dredged off Coulman Island. 100 fms. The 'Challenger' obtained G. t/lacialis from Agulhas Bank, 150 fms., and var. nivea from Prince Edward Island, 140 fms. •2 t; 2 50 R. KIRKPATRICK. OCEANAPIA TANTULA.* (Plate XVIIL, figs. 5, 5a, 5b, and Plate XXIV., fig. Sa-e1.) 1007. Oceanapia tantula Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 289). Description. — The sponge consists of five small fragments of tubes, the longest of which is 8 mm. in length, by 4 mm. in diameter ; three of the pieces are hollow, thin- walled and tubular ; the other two are solid. One of the solid pieces seems to belong to the top of a fistula. The colour is transparent white. Skeleton. The dermal layer is composed of a chitiuous-looking membrane with strongyles lying tangentially, usually in one layer and densely packed, but sometimes more or less scattered. The white strands of the loose subdermal reticulum are visible through the surface. They are longitudinal, and only anastomose occasionally. The strands are less than • 1 mm. in diameter. They vary in composition ; in some parts being composed of strongyles smaller than those of the dermal layer, in other parts of smooth tricho- dragmata, or again of strongyles, amphityles and trichodragmata. The pale transparent choanosomal tissues are crowded with small spiued rhaphides. Spicules. Megascleres. Strongyles, 437 x 19 /A, slightly fusiform, curved once or sometimes twice. Occasionally one end is pointed, the spicule becoming a style. Amphityles, 395 x 7 '25 /A, slightly fusiform, heads 13 /A long, 9 '75 mm. broad. Microscleres. Long, smooth raphides, separate or in bundles forming part of the subdermal reticulum, 650 x 2 ' 5 /x. Short scattered spined raphides, usually stylote, 1G2 ju, long, and about 2 • 5 M broad. H. V. Wilson describes (34. p. 128) a species of Oceanapia, viz. 0. bacilli/era with strongyles, but it has the usual sigmata. Oceanapia (Pldoeodictyon) singaporemis (Carter) has strongyles in the dermal layer, but oxeas as well as strongyles in the skeleton fibres, and there are no micro- scleres. The species of the Gelliine genus Rhaphisia have oxeas, trichodragmata, and, in one species, toxa ; but there are Jio fistulae, and there is no subdermal reticulum of spicular fibres. It is regrettable that there is so small an amount of material on which to base a new species, but the marked characters of that which is available seem to render such a proceeding justifiable. Dredged near Winter Quarters, from No. 10 hole, 130 fins. * Tantiihis, ever so little. TETRAXOXIDA. 51 SUB-FAMILY RENIERINAE, RIDLEY AND DENDY. PYLODERMA. Halichondaria (pars) Ridley and Dendy (15. p. G). Ri'iiicr'niiie with a parchment-like, easily -separated, dermal membrane in which are situated closely-packed tangential oxeas, and with distinct round or oval pore areas. PYLODERMA LATRUNCULIOIHKS. is,s7. Halirliiniili'iii /H/ni/ii-nliiii/li's, Ridley and Dendy (15. p. (I, PI. I., fiij. ">, Ac.). Tli ore is DUO flabellate specimen attached in a small stone. The height is (> cm., the width at the upper rim 5 '5 cm., and the thickness 1'8 cm. The oscules, generally contracted into little white conules, are scattered about among the pore areas, and not collected on the edges as in the ' Challenger ' examples. Each oscular opening leads into a smooth funnel-like cavity with a sharp-edged circular sphincter-like opening at the base. The strongly marked characters of this peculiar species seem to me to necessitate its removal from Halichandria and its inclusion under a new o-enus. In the ' Challenger ' O O Report Ridley and Dendy state that they were at first doubtful whether tho arrange- ment of the pores in definite areas would prove to be a character of generic importance, and finally decided that this feature was only one of adaptation. Prof. Dendy has since told me that he now thinks that this species should be placed in a distinct genus, and in this opinion I concur. , There are no microscleres to help in tracing its affinities and the body skeleton is Renierine in character ; accordingly it is for the present placed among the Renierinae. Dredged off Coalman Island in 100 fnis. The 'Challenger' obtained specimens from a depth of GOO frns. off the mouth of the Rio de la Plata. PETROSIA FISTULATA. (Plate XVIIL, figs. 4, 4a-b, and Plate XXIV., fig. 7.) 1007. retrain tixliilitii Kirkpatrick (10a. p. :.".><>). Sponge tubular. Surface smooth, showing the round openings of the inhalant canals aliotit '4 mm. in diameter and close together. Inner surface of the tube of the sponge finely or rarely coarsely pilose, and showing the round openings of the exhalant canals about 1 mm. in diameter. ( 'olour in spirit, pale yellow. Texture firm, but slightly compressible. Eurypylous flagellated chambers sphornidal, 24 '5 n in diameter. Skeleton formed of main fibres proceeding from the inner to the outer surface. joined by secondary fibres one spicule thick, so as to form obscurely quadrangular or hexagonal tubes about • 5 mm. in diameter ; ends of spicules cemented with spongin. Spicules. Oxeas, 492 x 24*4 ju., bent usually, or curved at centre, sub-tornote. 52 R. KIRKPATRICK. There are four specimens, the two larger being uniformly cylindrical and the smaller ventricose. The largest is 6 cm. long, the diameter being 2 • 1 cm. and the thickness of the wall 5 mm. The dermal membrane roofing over the inhalant orifices is usually supported there by two or three single spicules radiating to the centre. The pores are '95 M in diameter. Small embryos about • 76 mm. in diameter occur. The new species comes nearest to the species from Kergueleu, which Carter (3. p. 287) identified as Thalysias subtriangularis Duch. and Mich., but which Eidley and Dendy (15. p. 9) regarded as synonymous with Petrosia similis * (Ridley and Dendy). The spicules of the Antarctic species are very much larger than those of Carter's, and partly in consequence of this the skeletal network of the latter is much denser from a closer approximation of the fibres. The dimensions of the oxeas of four nearly related species of Petrosia are as follows : — Petrosia similis (R. and D.), 225 x 16ju. Thalysias subtriangularis (D. and M.), Carter, 190 x 12 p.. Petrosia (Sehmidtia) aulopora, 0. Sch., 175 x 7 p.. Petrosia Jistulata, 493 x 24'4/z. Dredged near Winter Quarters, No. 12 hole, 25-30 fms. ; McMurdo Bay, 96-120 fms. RENIERA scoTTi.f (Plate XVIII., figs. 1-2, and Plate XXIV., fig. 6.) 1907. Reniera scotti Kirkpatrick (10a. p. 291). Sponge consisting of one or more fistulae. Texture very soft and easily lacerated. Colour iu spirit, varying from yellow to pale reddish. Outer surface varying from being finely hispid to having large couules and meandrine ridges. Inner surface of fistulae very finely hispid in the spaces between the numerous orifices of exhalant canals. Flagellated chambers large hemispherical, 60 x 40 p.. Skeleton formed of parallel longitudinal lines of main fibres, about 2-6 spicules thick, curving outwards from the inner to the outer surface, where they pass into the conules and ridges ; secondary fibres at right angles to the main ones, one or two spicules thick. The spicules are not closely united, and spongin is only present in very small amounts. Spicules. Oxeas 343 x 14 '6 p., curved or bent at centre, sub-tornote. * The specimen from Kerguelen Island which Carter identifies as Thalysias subtriangularis Duch. & Mich, is, I believe, specifically distinct from Petrosia similis B. & D. The fine spicular network of the former, with its slender main fibres, and still more slender unispicular secondary fibres, contrasts strongly with the thick cable- like longitudinal and transverse strands of the latter. Carter's specimen appears to me to belong to a new species. t This fine species is named in honour of Captain R. F. Scott, E.N., C.V.O., the leader of the Expedition. TETEAXONIDA. 53 There are six specimens and fragments. The outward appearance varies according to age and size. In one small specimen the surface is finely hispid, in larger ones conulose, and in very large ones conulated and with high meaudrine ridges. The largest specimen No. 118 (PI. XVIII., fig. 1) is in the form of a wide thick-walled tube, 12 cm. high and 6 cm. in diameter, and with walls 1 • 5 cm. thick, but attenuating towards the rim of the tube. This specimen is incomplete below. The orifice is circular, and within the rim is a diaphragm contracted to a white line. The surface is covered with largo conulcs and mcandrine ridges rising to a height of nearly I cm. The dermal membrane, in the spaces between the conules and ridges, shows as a fine lace-like reticulum, with circular pores 133 n in diameter, and beneath it the orifices (1-1 '5 mm. in diameter) of the inhalant canals are visible. The exhalaut orifices on the inner wall of the tube are much larger than the inhalant ; they vary from 1 to G or 7 mm., their edges are smooth and rounded. In the second largest specimen, these orifices are arranged in longitudinal rows, and are oval with the long diameter vertical. This arrangement results from the way in which the contraction of the tubular sponge body is restricted by the main longitudinal skeletal fibres running beneath the inner surface. In a third specimen (No. 132), the outer surface of the wall is almost smooth to the naked eye, though under a lens it is seen to be finely hispid, with the top of oxeas projecting from minute conules. In another specimen the basal part of the sponge divides into two tubes, one of which is nearly smooth, and the other with ridged surface. The species closely resembles 7?. spinosella, Thiele (23. p. 459), from Punta Arenas. In Thiele's species the body is tubular, with conulated surface, and the texture is very soft ; but the skeletal framework is irregular, and the oxeas, though similar in form, are much shorter, smaller and more slender, being only 150-170 ft long and 7-8 /A thick. Another species showing certain resemblances to R. scotti, viz. Ii. aquaeductus Schmidt, var. iit/tnn/ifnt/nris (R. and D.), has a unispicular skeletal network. Specimens were dredged near Winter (Quarters, in No. 12 hole, 25--50 fins. ; S. K. of Cape Armitage, 100 fins.; off Flagon Point, 5-25 fins. ; off E. end of Ice Barrier, 100 fins., mud and stones. RENIERA DAXCOI. (Plate XVIIL, fig. 3.) I'.inl. Reiiirm dtincoi, Topsent (29. \>. li', PI. II., tiir. 1, and PI. III., fig. 3.) There are two specimens. One is of a compressed digitate form, 10 cm. long. 2' 5 cm. wide, and 1 cm. thick. About the middle of one side is a projecting shoulder with an oscule. Near, but not i|iiito at the summit, on (lie opposite edge, is a second osculc. The specimen is contracted ai the centre; the alternate osculcs 54 II. KIRKPATRICK. and contracted waist give the impression of a budding of the upper half of the specimen from the lower. The colour is pale brown in spirit, and is due apparently to the abundance of masses of cellules spheruleuses ; the specimens described by Topsent are grayish or whitish. The ' Discovery ' specimens have, in parts, a hispid rather than a conulose surface, the spicules standing above the level dermal membrane like sticks out of water ; but in other places the surface is finely conulose. The oxeas are 642 x 18 M, those of the 'Belgica' being 630 x 18-20/x. By deep staining of a portion of macerated skeletal network a small amount of spongin becomes discernible at the nodes. The flagellated chambers, 55 x 40 //,, though rather large, are smaller than those of Topseut's specimens, in which they are of unusual size, viz. 70 x 50 /x. The second specimen is merely a shapeless fragment. Dredged near Winter Quarters, off Hut Point, 25 fnis. ; No. 12 hole, 25-30 fms. The 'Belgica' Expedition obtained several small specimens from 450 metres, in Lat. 71° 19' S., Long. 87° 37' W. TETRAXOXIDA. 55 MEMOIRS REFERRED TO. 1. CARTER, H. J.—DeBcriptions and figures of Deep-sea Sponges . . . from the Atlantic- O'van. dredged . . . H.M.S. Porcupine. Ann. Mag. Nat. Hist. (4) xiv., 1*7 I. 2. CARTER, II. J. — Some Sponges from the West Indies and Acapulco in the Liverpool Free Museum. Ann. Mag. Nat. Hist. (5) ix., ISSL>. 3. CARTER, IT. J. — Spongiidae from Kerguelen Island. Transit of Venus Exp" Phil. Trans, vol. 138 (extra). London, 1870. 4. BENDY, A. — Catalogue of the Non-Calcareous Sponges . . . Port Phillip Heads. Part i. Proc. Roy. Soc. Victoria, vol. vii., n.s., 1895. 5. DENDY, A. — Catalogue of Non-Calcareous Sponges . . . Port Phillip Heads. Part ii. Proc. Roy. Soc. Victoria, vol. viii., n.s., 1800. 6. DENDY, A.— In HERDMAN, Ceylon Pearl Fisheries. Supplementary Report, xviii. London, 1905. 7. FRISTEDT, K. — Sponges from the Atlantic and Arctic Oceans and Behring Sea. Vega-Expeditionens vetenskapliga jakttagelser Arbeten. Bd. iv., 1887. 8. HANITSCH, R. —Revision of the Generic Nomenclature and Classification in Bowerbauk's "British Spongiadae." Trans. Liverpool Biol. Soc., vol. viii., 1894. 9. KIRKPATRICK, R. — On the Sponges of Christmas Island. Proc. Zool. Soc. London, 1900. 10. KIRKPATRICK, R. — On the Oscules of Cinachyra. Annals and Mag. Nat. Hist., T.IM.'I (7). vol. xvi. 10a. KIRKPATRICK, R. — Preliminary Report on the Monaxonellida of the National Antarctic Exhibition. Ann. and Mag. Nat. Hist. (7), vol. xx., September 1907. 11. LENDENFELD, R. VON. — Spongien von Sansibar. Abhand. Senckenberg. Gesellsch., 1899, Bd. xxi. 11 a. LENDENFELD, R. VON. Deutsche Siidpolar-Expedition, 1901-1903. Bd. ix. Zoologie I. Tetraxonia. Berlin. 1907. 12. LUNDBECK, W. — Porifera (Part i.). Homorrhaphidae and Heterorrhaphidae. The Danish Ingolf- Expedition, vol. vi., Copenhagen, 1902. 13. LUNDBECK, W. — Porifera (Part ii.). Desmacidonidae. The Danish [ngolf-Expedition, vol. vi., • Copenhagen, llloi. 14. MEREJSKOWSKY, C. — Etudes sur les Eponges de la mer Blanche. Mem. Acad. Imp. Sci. (7), xxvi., N°- 7, St. Petcrsbourg, 187*. 15. RIDLEY, S. O., and DENDY, A. — Report on the Monaxonida collected by H.M.S. 'Challenger.' London, 1887. 15a. RIDLEY. S. O. — Account of the Zoological Collections made during the survey of H.M.S. 'Alert' in the Straits of Magellan. Proc. Zool. Soc. London, 1881. 16. SCHMIDT, O. — Die zweite deutsche Nordpolarfahrt, 18G9-70. Zweifcer Band, Zoologie, Kieselspongien. Leipzig, is 7 4. 17. SCHMIDT, 0. — Die Spongien des Meerbnsen von Mexico. Jena, 1879. 18. Scun.ZE, F. E. — Uber die Ableitung der Hexactinelliden-Nadelu vom reguliiren Hexaetine. Sitz- ungb. Akad. Wiss., Berlin, xlvi., 1893. 19. SOLLAS. I. B. — On the Sponges collected during the Skeat Expedition to the Malay Peninsula, 18H7-1900. Proc. Zool. Soc. London, vol. ii., 1902. 20. SOLLAS, AV. J. — The Sponge-fauna of Norway. Annals and Mag. Nat. Hist., 188:.', (.r>), vol. ix. 21. SOLLAS, V,'. J. — Report on the Tetractinellida collected by H.MT.S. ' Challenger.' Zoology, vol. :.'.">. London, 1888. 22. TIIIELF,, J. — Beschreibung cinigiT anzoreichend |p'jkannten Monaxonen Spongien. Arehiv. Naturg., 19(i3. Band i. Berlin. 23. THIELE, J. — Die Kiesel- und Uornsehwamnie der Sammlung Plate. Zool. Jahrb. Snppl. vi., Dr. L. I Mate, Fauna Chilensis : Bd. iii.. Heft 3. Jena, 19n:,. VOL. IV. 2 H 56 R. KIRKPATRICK. 24. TOPSENT, E. — Une reforme dans la Classification des Halichondrina. Mem. Soc. Zool. France, tome vii. 1891. 25. TOPSENT, E. — Resultats scientifiques de la Campagne du 'Caudan' dans le Golfe de Gascogne, 1895. Eponges. Annales de 1'Universite de Lyon, xxvi., (4). Paris, 1896. 26. TOPSENT, E. — Eponges nouvelles des Acores (premiere seric). Mem. Soc. Zool. France, vol. si., p. 225-2 ,r)5. Paris, 1S98. 27. TOPSENT, E. — Introduction a 1'etude monographique des Monaxonides de France. Archiv. Zool. Exp. et Gen. (3) vi. 1898. 28. TOPSEXT, E. — Etude Monographiqne des Monaxonides de France. Archiv. Zool. Exp. et Gen. (3). tome viii. 1900. 29. TOPSENT, E. — Expedition Antarctique Beige. Resultats du Voyage du S.Y. 'Belgica'en 1897-99. Zoologie. Spongiaires. Anvers, 1902. 30. TOPSENT, E. — Resultats des Campagnes Scientifiques du Prince de Monaco. Spongiaires des Acores. Monaco, 1904. 3 1 . TOPSENT, E. — Poecilosclerides nouvelles recueillies par le ' Frangais ' dans 1'Autarctique. Bulletin du Museum d'histoire naturelle. Paris, 1907. No. 1. 32. VosiiAEE, G. 0. J.— The Sponges of the Willeni Barents Expedition, 1880-81. Bijdragen tot de Dierk. Afl. 12. Amsterdam, 1885. 33. WELTNER, W.— Susswasserspongien von Celebes. Archiv. fiir Xaturgeschichte, 1901. Beiheft. 34. WILSON, H. V.— Reports on an Exploration off the West Coasts of Mexico, Central and South America, and off the Galapagos Islands, by the ' Albatross ' during 1891. The Sponges. Mem. Mus. Comp. Zool. Harvard, vol. xxx. No. 1. Cambridge, U.S.A., 1904. PLATE VIII. FIG. 1. — Craniella sagitta (Lendenfeld) var. iiiiirosif/niti. n. var.. f n,at. size, p. 1. FIG. 2. — Surface at junction of poral and iion-poral or oscular zones (X 2). FIG. 3. — Section showing poral areas and sub-dermal spaces ( x 6). FIG. 4. — Eurypylous flagellated chambers opening into terminal exhalaut canal (x 425). FIG. 5. — Anatriaene(x 50). 5a, Cladome of same ( X ICO). FIG. 6. — Cladome of anatriaene with straighter cladi than 5a ( X 1 60). FIG. 7.— Anatriaene with short, thick cladi (x 50). Cladome of same (x 16<>). FIG. H. — Protriaene (x 50), Sa, cladome of same (X 160). FIG. 9. — Cladome of protriaene with equal cladi (X 160). FIG. 10. — Large oxea (x 50). FIG. 11. — Trichodal protriaene ( x 160). FIG. 12.— Sigmata (x Too); 12a, the same (x 14on). FIG. 13. — Cortical oxea (X 50). FIG. 14. — Cranifllii sagitta var. pachyrrhiibd us, n. var. Style (x 5o). FIG. 15. — Stronsryle ( X 50). x. 4 'j*': F f •• « fe . PLATE IX. Fin. ]..— Viiuti'hyr0). FK;S. 5-7. — Single and double "silica pearls"' (x TIHIJ. FICJS. 8-12. — '' Silica pearls" around which crystals of sea-salts have become deposited ( X 42f>). Fios. 13, 14.— Spheroidal masses of sea-salt crystals (in optical section), which stain deeply in carmine (X 425). Fie. l.j. — Cittnit'll/i xtti/itttt var. inirroxignm. vertical section of cortex in poral region, showing radial cortical oxeas aivhing over sub-dermal spaces (x 12). Fie. 16. — franieUfi niiijiltn var. »i<<'rom't/>n.r Lendenfeld, nat. size, p. 9. Fid. 2. --Vertical section of ;i porocalyx (x 10). FIG. 3. — Vertical section of an osonle ( x in). FIG. 4. — Vertical section of cortex (x 25). FIG. 5. — Flagellated chambers, apopyles opening into beginning exhalant canal (x 160). Fin. (I.- - Collar cells ( x IGOO). — The section shows the cut edges of the concrescent collars of the collar cells ; the diffused coloration beneath these cut edges apparently represents Sollas's membrane torn down in the course of section cutting. The material from which the section was cut was deep black from the effects of osmic acid, and was not good from a histological point of view. Fio. 7. — Large somal oxea (x Kin). FK;. x. — Choanosonial oxea (x Joo). Fin. !i. — Anatriaene with bend in cladi (x loo). FIG. 10. — Anatriaeue with uniformly curved cladi (x 100). FIGS. 11, IL>. — Protriaenes. FIG. 18. — Trichodal protriaene (x 100). FIG. 14.— Sigmata (x 700) ; 14a, the same (x 1400). FKI. 15. — Cinachyra verier var. monticularis, n. var., nat. size, p. 11. Fid. 1(>. — Oscular chimney of the same (x 10). J ~ PLATE XI. . \—Cinacl0). FIG. 9. — Anatriaene (x 100). FIG. 10. — Another kind of anatriaene (X 100). FIG. 11.— A third kind of anatriaene (x 100). FIG. li'.— Distal end of protriaene from root-tuft (x Hid). FIG. 1:3.— Trichodal protriaene (X loo). Fn;. 14.— Sigmata (X 700) ; 14a, the same (x 1400). V 'I • PLATE XII. FII,. 1. — A. Sphaerotylus antarcticus Kirkp. Nat. size ; p. 16. B. Polymastia invagiiutta Kirkp. ; p. 15. (Note. The surface pile is, in the natural condition, more upright than in this specimen, where it has been crushed down.) C. The larger of the two small specimens above C is Sphaerotylns capitatw Vosmaer, nat. size ; p. 18 ; the smaller is S. antarcticus. FIGS. 2, o. — fyhaernfylm antarcticus, young specimens. Nat. size. FIG. 4. — Portion of another young specimen ( x 25). Fiu. 5. — Sphaerotylus a/itttn-t/i-t/x. A spheroidal specimen. Nat. size. FIG. 6.— Style from radiating main fibre (x 100). FIG. 7.— Style from inner cortical tangential layer (x 100). FIG. 8. — Spherostyle ( x 100) ; Sa head of same (x 425). FIGS. 9-12. — Heads of various spherostyles (x 425). FIG. 13. — Slender curved choanosornal tyle (x 100). FIG. 14. — Beaded tyle from radial fibres (x 425). FIG. 15. — Curved cortical tyles of outermost layer of cortex (x 100) ; 15a, the same (x 160). FIG. 16.— Straight tangential tyle of lower cortical layer (x 100) ; 16a, the same (x 425). PLATE XIII. FIG. 1. — SplMfrolylus antarcticus. Section of young specimen (x 3). FIG. 2. — Section of same ( x 20). FIG. 3. — Dermal pores (x 100). FIG. 4. — Inner surface of cortex showing terminations of pore canals (x 100). FIG. 5. — Horizontal section of papilla ( x 15). FIG. fi. — Vertical longitudinal section of papilla (x 15). FIG. 7.— Diplodal flagellated chambers ( x 400). FIG. 8. — Syihaerotylus rupitutn-s (Vosmaer) choanosomal tyle (X 10<>) ; 8a, head of the same (x 100). FIGS. 9, 10. — Smaller tyle and sub-tyle from spread out ends of radiating fibres of skeleton (X ll!(i). FIG. 11. — Cortical tyle, also found in choanosome between the main fibres (x 100). FIG. 12. — Smallest kind of cortical tyle (x 100) ; 12a, the same (xlGO). FIG. 13.— Exotyle (x l»>0j ; l:ia, clavate head of same (425). f: 11 . PLATE XIV. FIG. 1. — Sphrur). FIG. 5. — Polymastia invagnata, specimen cut in half ; nat. size, p. 15. FIG. (I. — Vertical section ( x 25). FIG. 7. — Flagellated chambers (diplodal) (x 100). FIG. s. — Stellate group of tyles in choanosotne (x 100) ; 8a, separate tyles of stellate groups (x loo) FIG. 0. — Straight style (x KIOI. FIG. 10. — Curved style (x 100) ; Ida, narrower head of another spicule (X 100). FIG. 11. — Sfcrongyle (x 100). FIG. 12. — Long slender tylu (X 100). FIGS. 13, 14. — Cortical tyles ( X 100). FIG. 15. — Choauosomal tyles (x 100) ; 15a, the same (x 100). III" . PLATE XV. FIG. 1. — L'tri'iii-iilii/ ifjii'i'!/* !;. A- D. var. biformi* var. n., jj nat. size. p. 14. Fid. 2.— Style of same (. X I0o). FIG. 3. — Discaster with apical spine ( x 700). FIG. 4. — Discaster without apical spine ( X loo) ; 4;; ( x 7oo). FIG. 5. — Reduced discaster ( x looj. FIGS. C, 7. — Reduced discasters from another specimen ( X Ifio). FIG. 8. — Suberitfx inifrostoinit* R. & 1). vai1. xti'Uatnx. vav. n.. uat. size, p. 19. FIG. 9.— Sub-tyle of same ( x loo); 9a ( x 4oo). FIGS. 10, 11, 12.— Cortical tyles ( x 100). FIG. 13. — Surface of S. Micriixtviini* var. .v/c//(///«.s, showing stellate poral areas (X -•>}• FIG. 14. — Surface of typical S. iiiirrnxtontux, showing circular pural areas (x io). FIG. 15. — Surface of typical S. cciiitinntv* R. & I)., showing stellate poral areas (x 25). FIG. 16. — Surface of 6'. caminatus R. & 1>. var. /xijiiUdtus, var. n., showing papillated stellate poral areas (x 25), p. 20. »s» . '. *S^3 0 c,o J ' ° , =* • ,* •>.';*' A. '.^ • - ' . • • •' • - PLATE XVI. FIG 1 .lin/ina:i stnm^yle ( x 1 00) ; 5a, fmthCT enlarged. Pl(1 c, Stylocordyla /HWWI/W Loven var. «f«f«<« var. «., nat. size, p. FII;' 7 Krtosoma I micro-styles (X 100); 7a ( X :.OdV FIG. H. Smaller ox.-;, of thu head of the sponge ( • FIG 0. Hrteroxea (x 100). FIG in Lsinrc oxca of stem, with central BwclliiiK ( X FIG,;. . ., . iSftLta >™^ R. * i(- -•• «*"«• n- vat" n;a- Bize' p- FIG 1-. Cortical tyle ( X 100). FIG. l:i. l>itto (X 100 1. FIG. H. Tyle from radiating skeletjfi fibre (X ~«*tf . • ' PLATE XVII. FIG. l.— il-'liutf: null* Topseut, p. ±*>. FIG. la. Section of same (x .">). FIG. 2.- GeHiiafimtriatus Kirkp., nat. size. p. 4C>. FIG. I'H. Section of same ( X ;">)• FIG. 8. ftr/tins pflosits Kirkp., nat. size, p. 47. FIG. /.a.— Section (x •">). FIG. 4. (irlliitx glac.iali* var. nimi llidlry an-1 Dcixly. nat. size, p. 4!>. FlG. 5.- OdUiK cucurbitifornri* Kirkp.. nat. si/.c. p. 4X. FIG. "ia.-- Another specimen of same. nat. si/c. FIG. :.b.— Surface (x 65). FIG. TH-. Section (X Go). FIG. 0. Sigmtitemyasa phtdeellioides Kirkp., nat. *i/e. p. 23. JfpSii ' 2 a Ante i is covery ') Exp ages PI 17. P. Highley. London ' : ' 1 • I'LATH XV HI. i. — Reniera sciitti Kirkp., nui. six.'1. p. • •!!. ja% — Surface, showing pores ( X -'")• pIG_ i\,. — Vet^cfl longitudinal scotion (X :-). YIG. 2. — Reniera scntti, another specimen. FIG. 3.— Reniera ilnvrni. 'IVipneiil, nut. size, p. 53. ).'IG- 4. — pttTOslafmtiilitl'i' Kirkp., imt. siw, p. ol. FIG. 4a. — Surface of simie ( x ti. FIG. lb.— Section ( x H'I. FlG< 5—Onanayia tan/ "In, Kirkp., fm.mnrtils of fibulae, p. 5 PIG- 5a.— Closed end of one of the fistulae Tx T). FIG. 5b. — Section ( x si. ' X .' j®& -a * 5 a ^L ! ! K^L r^. " ' ' 5fa 4 b Antarctic ( Discovery) Exp Sponges PI 18 . P Highley. London 1 • . H-ATK XIX. Fin. 1. -Dfxmaculon Irergueleiifiisls TJ. A: I). v:ir. ini/iintic-' var. n. Nat. nize, p. 37. Fin. l;i. —Section of same (x f>). l-"ic. L'. 1 iesmac-idon Icergudenensis I!. & D. v;ir. <-iii-tni. Nat. si/.t-. ]i. 4n. Fin. 4;t. -Section (x 2). Fin. ."i. I 'frridocJiela lurikfsteri Kirkp. Ni.r. size, p. 4i'. FM:. ."m. Section of same (x 15). Fin. i;. -JfnplakitlMra den:lyl Kirkp. Nat. fi/.f, p. 44. Fin. c,a. The same (x ft). Fin. i;b. Oblique section across the upper hnlf of tlic spi-cimen (x i'-"'j. Antarctic (Discovery)Exp Sponges PI. 19 . P Highley. London. PLATE XX. Fie;. 1.- M//I-II/' acerata Kirkp. -; int. size, \>. 3<; ; n. surface (x •r)) ; b, vertical section, nat. size. FIG. '1. M/fi-'tlr niiii/i-lliiiiii-ii (Ridley). Dermal reticulum showing the uniformly level surface, p. 3(i. Fie. 3. K?/irrii>/isix I'illiisti i(';irU-n. Nat. size, p. 35 ; a. b. villous ami pilose surface (x lit) : <; vorical 'i-i-lion ( X :"•). Fir;. ^..— -Aiit'iiiixiiui '//milt, iix ( li. & 1). i. -: nat. size. p. 34 ; a. villous process on the surface nf the (X 5) ; //, surface (x -ri) ; /•, vertical section ( x •<). Antarctic ( Discover/) Exp - Sponges PI 20 P Highley. London i'l.ATB XXI. FIG. 1. Tula a in I'liriiilnKit Kirkp. .sji. n. | nat. size, p. :->•-'. FlG. la. — Pore areas of same (x Id). FIG. 2. — Ti'iliwiit fiiiiliiiaiii Kirkp., p. S3. FIGS. :'., k 4n. -1(1/1/111/1 rniliittiix Topsent. Nat. size, p. L'«. .'iff. closed «Kciilf. X -'. Fm. 4/». — Open oscule of same (x 10). FIG. 4r. — Pore ana of same ( X 1<>). FIGS. ;">, r>a. — Li/ihmi. x/,ittnl.— Oscule of same fully contracted, side view ( x Hi). FIG. oJ1. — Oscule of same, front view (x 10). Fin. 5''. — Pore area of same (x 10). FIR. G.—Iophonflabelk-digitatus Kirkp. ^ nat. size. p. :-'•l/it). FIG. -t. — Hi/mf. — Hymfrrii/ijihn/ rnfn Kirkp., nat. size, p. 25. Fn:. 0. — Ophlitaspongia itnlijimia Kirkp., nat. size, p. 2."i. FIG. 6«. — Section of half of echinated fibre (x 20). Fn.. 7.- -Lissom ij.iilln Ininitxi'hi Kirkp., nat. size. p. 26. Fin. la. -Vertical section of same ( X -11). Fin. x.--A.ri/}i-IIi< sii/irti/itii/rxiriiK Topsent, nat. size, p. 2:1. Fin. s«. - Longitudinal vertical section of same (x 2(i). Antarctic ( Discovery )Exp Sponges PL 22 P. Highley. London PLATE XXIII. Fid. 1.- - l>rsn«K-iilrni ki'iym Iriie/isis R. & D. var. antantii-n var. n. ; a, oxea (x 1BO) ; ft, side view; ft1, front view of isochela ( X 1700) ; c, a variety with smaller palmate tooth (x 1700) ; J., ill, side and front views "I isurhc'la from type of D. kerffuelenensis, R. & D. ( X 1760) ; p. ?>7. FIG. 2. — Desmacidvn knyiirlrnenxis var. cactoidvs var. n. ; a, strongylate oxea ( x 160) ; ft, ft1, front and side views of isorhelu ( X 17lio) ; p. 3H. Fie. §.—Desmacidon spinigera Kirkp. ; //, //, oxeas ( X 160) ; c, c1, side and front views of palmate isochela (X 1760), p. 39. Fid. 4.—Desntnri.—('erntJiH-/if1,/ L;,ilH>xt/-ri Kirkp.; a, oxea (x 160); ft, c , d, f, ('anonochelae, developmental forms (X 7(>0) ;/. lateral view showing lamellae (x 700); //, lateral view of side opposite to lamellae (X 700); /, luM'k view, />., of the shaft, showing straight line of axial canal within the right edge ( X 7i»" i ; /, half of a spicule broken across ( X 700) ; /, end view ( X 700), p. 42. V\c,.C,.—Hotjl~, |jnd view of a spine; c, r1, f3, side, front, and baok views of a fimbriated placochele, p. 44. Antarctic ( Discovery) Exp Sponges PI 23 P. Highley. London. PLATE XXIV. FIG. 1.— f'fi'l/iita ruilia Topsent ; a, oxea (x Kin) ; I, sigma (x 7no), p. 45. FIG. L'.- (ifllhis /;i,ii>/;',/ti/s Kirkp. ; «, oxea (x 1GO) ; b, sigiua (x 700), p. H'>. FIG. :!.- Gelliits pilosus Kirkp. ; a, oxea ( x 160); " •'. sisjmata ( x 700), p. 47. I'n '. Xi'ti/Ki.i-i/itissti [liitikrllixiili'x Kirkp. ; ". oxea ( X IfiO) ; b, sigma (x 700); c, toxon (x l(jn), p. i';l. Fn.. 5.- (M/in-s i-iii'iirliit/fiirinix Kirkp. ; <>, oxea (x ItiO) : //, sigma ( X 700), p. 4s. Fir;, li. - Ili'iiii-nt sniff i Kirkp. ; oxea ( x 160), p. "ii'. FIG. 7. — Pi'trtisid fixtiilatu Kii-kji. : oxea ( X Kio), p. ">1 . Fir;, s. Offiiiiiiinii tuntiilii Kirkp.. sp. n. : n, strougyle (x li;«i) ; b, style (x ICO) ; e, amphityle (x Hio) ; <1, long smooth rhapbide C X 1 Co) ; e, shorter spined rhaphide ( X 160) ; rl, the same ( X 700), p. 50. Fn;. '.'. h'.--,-n /-in/I*/* viUosci (Carter) ; n. palmate isochele, larger kind (x 700) ; l>, smaller kind, side view (X 7i»i) ; I'1, front view (x 7<»ii) ; //-'. front view (x i'9ou), p. 35. Fn;. I". -Jfycak acerata Kirkp. ; , ectosomal strongyle (x IGd), p. 32. FIG. 2. — Ti.'ilfni:i coulmani Kirkp. ; «, slightly spined style ( x 160) : /', ectosomal tornote ( X 160) ; b1, ends of same ( x 700), p. 33. FIG. 3, — My.ri11, amphityle (x 380); r, the same (X 17iin) : <•, front view ; c1, side view of palmate anisochele (X 1760), p. 28. FlG. 5. -fi'ji/io/i spatula-tils Kirkp. ; a, smooth, modified acanthostyle (X 160); I, amphityle (x 160) ; bl. end of the same (x 17(5<>) ; c, front view; c1, side view of palmate anisochele (x 1760); . tyle of embryo (x 380) : b1, the same (y 1760) ; '. '•', anisochele of embryo, front and side view (x 17(10), p. 30. FIG. 2. — H//t,n'i/is,,/in f.i-ii/ini Kirkp. : a, tyloto (x KiO) : a1, the same (x 380) ; l>, acanthostyle (x liJO) ; e, pluridentate isanoora spatulifera (x 17(10) : r\ the same from above : d, f, the same, with central aln,f on shaft (x 17(50) , /, sigma (x 1700), p. i'4. Firs. :!. — HymerrhapMa n/fn Kirkp. : //. larger acanthostyle (x 160); l>, smaller • acanthostyle ( x 160) : c. ectosomal auisotornote ( x 160) ; //. isancora spatulifera (x 1700) ; c, a variety of the same with cup-like ends (x 700), p. 2fi. FIG. 4. — Lixxiuii/i.i-i'ln lirmitsi-ln Kirkp.: a, smooth style (x KiO): //, echinating acanthostyle ( x 160): '•. ectosomal umphityle (x 160) ; c1, end of same (x 1760). p. i'6. FIG. 5. — Ophlitaspongia nidaficata Kirkp.; c, smooth style (x 160); />, a smaller curved style (x 160); e, :\ still smaller straight (? ectosomal) style (x 160) ; (/, toxon (x 160), p. -•">. Fn.. ('». — A.rini'llfi au/»-ittii>ii<-*-i'iix Topseut'; «, large style (x 160) ; b, small ectosomal style (x KiO), p. :.'::. FIG. 7. — Pseudosuberites Injnlinus (Ridley and Dendy) ; a, specimen, natural size; b, vertical longitudinal ( X 10), p. i'!. Antarctic^ Discovery) Exp. Sponges PI 26 P. Highley. London POBIFEEA. III.-CALCAREA. By C. F. JKNKIX, B.A. (12 Plates.) PAET I. INTRODUCTION AND CLASSIFICATION. INTRODUCTION. THE preparation of the Report on the ' Discovery ' collection of calcareous sponges was, in the first instance, entrusted to Professor E. A. Minchin. He had partially examined the Homocoela and made some drawings of them, when he was unfortunately obliged to abandon the undertaking, owing to the pressure of other duties. The collection was then entrusted to the author, who has had the advantage of using Professor Minchin's notes on the Homocoela and his lifelike drawings (Figs. 12 and 14), showing the habit of growth of the two new species of Leucosolenia, The author desires to record his indebtedness to Professor Minchin for much valuable advice, to Professor Dendy for valuable suggestions as to the classification of the new genera, and for specimens of Grantiopsis cylindrica, to Mr. R. Kirkpatrick for constant help and particularly for permission to examine the British Museum collection of calcareous sponges, to Professor R. von Lendenfeld for specimens of Sycon tenellum, and to Professor Jeffrey Bell, to whose kindness he owes the privilege of undertaking this most interesting investigation. The collection consists of 109 specimens. Of these, 39 belong to the grade Homocoela, and are divided among five species, of which two are new to science. The remaining 70 belong to the grade Heterocoela, and are divided among 18 species and one variety of an existing species, all of which are new to science.* Of the five species belonging to the grade Homocoela, two belong to the genus Clathrina and three to the genus Leucosolenia. Of the 18 new species of Heterocoela, five belong to the genus Leucandra and the remaining 13 are distributed among six new genera. CLASSIFICATION. The classification here used, which is shown in the following table, is that proposed by Polejaeft' (4) for the Homocoela and by Dendy (2) for the Heterocoela * With the possible exception of three of the species, which can only be considered as provisionally settled. 2 H 2 0. F. JENKIN. and adopted with slight modifications by Minchin (1) ; it has been considerably extended to include the new species. The last column in the table gives the number of species in each genus found in the ' Discovery ' collection. Families. 1. Clathriuidte 2. Leucosoleniidii? 1. Sycettidic 2. Grantiidffi :i. lleteropidte 4. Amphoriscidi-e 5. Ghijiliuriihr G Staurorrhaphida. Genera. GRADE A.-HOMOCOELA. [Clathrina < Ascandra. (.Dendya. ( Ascyssa. (Lencosolenia GRADE B.— HETEROCOELA. I Sycetta. species. 5 and 1 variety. 2 18 species and 1 variety. In the above table the names of the new families and genera are printed in italics. * The genus Sycantha is omitted for reasons stated on p. 4. f Grantiopsis is transferred to the family Staurorrhap}iid(e. CALCAREA. This classification is based primarily on the arrangement of the spicules, as is shown in the following diagram, where the families are arranged in four columns to show their dependence on the spiculation. The families on the same horizontal line correspond more or less in their canal systems. NO SUBI>EKMAL SPICOLKS. SrilliKKMAL TlURADIATIX SCBDKKMAL I}I-AI>KIP.AMATKS. CHIAOTIXKS. Family. Genus. Family. Genus. Family. <"nus. Family. Genus. 1. Sycettids 2. GrautiicL-e Sycon. Tenthrenodes 'Grautia. Ute. Synute. Utella. Anainaxilla. Sycissa. 5. Chiphorida;. . < 3. Heteropidae ( fGrantessa. Heteropia. Vosmieropsis Hcteropcgraa Ampboriscus. Syculmis. 4. Amphoriscidte , Achramorpha. Grautiopsis. G. Staurorrhaphidse ( Megapogou. Lelapia. Leuoyssa. Dermatrctou. NEW FAMILIES. — The two new families, Cltij>h<>riII. The latter is transferred to the new family Staworrliaphidse, tlie generic name being retained. In order to make the present report a complete record of all species in the two new families, brief descriptions of Megapogon crucifcm and Grantiopsis cylindrica, with drawings of the spicules, are included. In some of the new species this type of spicule occurs in conjunction with the ordinary types, but in several it forms the whole gastral and body-wall skeleton, to the exclusion of the ordinary quadriradiates and triradiates ; its importance, therefore, can hardly be over-rated, and fully justifies the formation of the new1 families. All the species containing chiactines might have been included in one family instead of two, but as they fall into two groups, which differ from cadi other in the same way that the ,S'//opetv, to bear. 'i a cross ; OKI-IS, a ray. t (rravpos, a cross ; {K>(J>!S, a needle or spiculc. § For a detailed description of the chiactines see Part III. 4 C. F. JENKIN. NEW GENERA. — The new genera, Hypodictyon* Dermatretonfi and Tenthrenodes^ are introduced to contain the five new species which have " linked " flagellated chambers. The term " linked " is here used to describe the peculiar arrangement of the flagellated chambers in an open network or honeycomb pattern, so that a large number surround each of the very large incurrent canals (intercanals). In Sycon and Grantia the incurrent canals are usually smaller than the flagellated chambers, and are each surrounded by only three or four flagellated chambers. Three of the new species have freely projecting distal cones ; two of these are included in the new genus Tentkrenodes, in the family Sycettidse, and the third, which contains chiactiues, is in the corresponding genus Hypodictyon, in the family Chiphoridse. The two remaining species have distinct dermal cortices, and are, therefore, included in the new genus Dermatreton, in the family Grantiidse. The dermal cortex is not continuous, but takes the form of a network covering the top of the flagellated chambers, and is pierced by large holes corresponding to the spaces (incurrent canals) between those chambers. The " linked " arrangement of the flagellated chambers appeared to resemble closely the " grouped " arrangement described by von Lendenfeld (6) as occurring in Sycantha tenella. As doubts existed concerning the accuracy of some of the details of this description, it seemed advisable to re-examine the specimens. The author was enabled to make this examination by the great courtesy of Professor von Leudeufeld, who sent him all the remaining material he possessed. This material is considerably macerated (as is stated by von Lendenfeld in his original description), but is in quite good enough condition to allow the general structure to be ascertained with certainty. The results of the author's examination show that all von Lendenfeld's figures represent the structure correctly except Figs. 53, 54 and 56, which, though no doubt accurately drawn, are quite misleading. The interpretation placed on the figures by him appears, however, to lie erroneous, and would seem to be due to the unfortunate cross-section shown in Fig. 56. The true structure is best shown in Fig. 57, representing a tangential section near the gastral cortex. This figure shows the regular rectangular network formed by the chamber walls. The rectangles are alternately flagellated chambers and canals, arranged like a chess board, exactly in the manner shown in Haeckel's " Kalkschwauime," Fig. 13, Plate 60, as typical of his sub-genus Sycocubus (sub-genus 3 of Sycandra). Haeckel's figure shows (correctly) the arrange- ment of the flagellated chambers and inter-canals of Sycon schmidti; this arrangement only differs from that of Sycantha tenella in the shape of the flagellated chambers, which in Sycon schmidti are approximately square (in tangential section), whereas in Sycantha tenella, though still rectangular, they are much longer in one direction (parallel to the axis of the sponge) than in the other (circumfereutially). Sycantha t i'ii 1 1 la is, therefore, a typical Sycon, remarkable for the size and regular arrangement * VTTO, under ; bixrvov, a net. f beppa, skin ; TIITJTI'IS, holed. J TfvdpiixaSr,!, honeycombed. CALCAREA. 5 of the flagellated chambers. The flagellated chambers touch each other only at the corners and have no intercommunication canals. Serial tangential sections show that each flagellated chamber opens independently into the gastral cavity. (See Plate XXXVIII, Fig. 137.) This may also be inferred by comparing the distances between the openings into the gastral cavity, shown in von Leudenfeld's Figs. 56 and 58, and the distances between the flagellated chambers shown in Fig. 57 (remembering that the rectangles are alternately flagellated chambers and canals). The cross-sections made by the author correspond exactly with the structure above described. It is, therefore, evident that there is no similarity between Syc»n tcni'llum, as it should now be called, and the new genera with " linked " chambers. The new genus Streptoconus* in the family Staurorrhaphidse, corresponds with Sycon in the Sycettidse, The new genera Achramorpha f and Megapogon J in the family Staurorrhaphidse correspond with Grant/a and Leucandra in the Grantiidse. Dendy's sub-genus Grantiopsis is transferred from the Grant lid as to the StVOS, a cone. t < P"l"t> ^ p.tyas, great ; nwyw, a beard, G C. F. JENKIN. (d) The development of the gelatinous mesoderm in Leucandra gelatinosa. (e) The duplicate ovum, apparently a new type of egg cell, in Megapoyon raripilus. Locality. — All the specimens were taken, at various dates, in Winter Quarters and most of them from shallow waters. PART II. DESCRIPTION OF THE SPECIMENS WITH DEFINITIONS OF THE NEW GENERA AND SPECIES. GRADE HOMOCOELA POL. FAMILY CLATHRINIDAE MINCHIN. CLATHRINA PRIMORDIALIS. Ascetta primoniialis Haeckel (3), Vol. II., p. !(!. There is one small broken specimen of this species in the collection. In colour it is yellow as preserved in spirits. The spicules agree exactly with Haeckel's description. CLATHRINA CORIACEA. Ascetta coriacea Haeckel (3), Vol. II., p. 24. There are two small broken specimens of this species in the collection. In colour they are yellow, as preserved in spirits. The spicules agree exactly with Haeckel's description. FAMILY LEUCOSOLENIID^E MINCHIN. LEUCOSOLENIA COMPLICATA. Lemosolenia complicata Minchin (8), p. 360. There are five pieces of sponges of this species in the collection. The spiculation agrees closely with the revised description given by Minchin. LEUCOSOLENIA DISCOVERYI. (Plate XXVIII. , Figs. 12-13.) There are about twenty-five specimens of this new species in the collection. Its appearance and habit of growth are admirably shown in Fig. 12, drawn by Professor Minchin. Its colour is white as preserved in spirits. The oscular tubes in some specimens attain a length of 9 mm. and a diameter (flattened) of 1 mm. CALCAREA. 7 Spicules (Fig. 13). The following description is due to Professor Mim-hin : — O.rea. — The monaxon spicules of this species are very constant and characteristic. They are divisible at the outset into («) ordinary and (f>) refriugeut monaxons :— ('/) The ordinary monaxons are curved and vary greatly in dimensions, from about 100 p. to 450 /u or more in length, and from 3 p. to IG/u in thickn> Every possible gradation is to be found between the greatest extremes in size, so that it is not possible to divide these spicules into dill'orcnt classes. The shaft is thickest near the proximal end, which is also nearly straight for rather* more than half the length ; from this point the shaft curves evenly, and tapers slightly, towards the distinct lance-head, which usually shows very plainly the form of a double bond, especially in the smaller examples of this type of spicule. Among the ordinary monaxons there are always a very few T type monaxous : these are very rare, and only one or two arc usually found in a whole spicule slide. (/>) The refringent monaxons are much scarcer than the ordinary type, but they are easily found, as their optical peculiarity makes it easy to distinguish them from the others, especially under a low power of the microscope. Like the ordinary mouaxous, they show a wide range of variation in size, from small to very large. Their form is similar to that of the ordinary monaxons in a general way, but shows certain constant peculiarities ; the shaft is very slightly curved, sometimes nearly perfectly straight ; the proximal swelling of the shaft contrasts more sharply with the distal extremity, which is often very slender and tapers down rapidly about half- way from the proximal end ; and the lance-head tends t<> be rudimentary or even quite absent. By these special features the spicules can easily be recognised as a distinct class, apart from their characteristic appearance under the microscope. Triradiates. (c) The ordinary triradiatcs are of fairly large size, in form very similar to those of Leucosolenia i't>nij>li<;i/,i, with the unpaired rays markedly longer than the paired rays. The unpaired ray is straight and slender, varying in length from about 110/i to as much as 185/x. The paired rays are generally slightly thicker than the unpaired, sometimes distinctly so; they curse symmetrically, first in a backward direction fur the proximal two-thirds of their length, then forwards for the distal third ; in length they vary 1mm 100 p. to 145 M) the average length being about mid-way between these two extremes. The anterior angle is an open one, but the lateral angles are always greater than right angles, the spicules never being T-shaped as in VOL. IV. ! I C. F. JENKIN. lioii-i/i'ndtfi. In young specimens the triradiates are generally smaller and more slender than in the larger colonies. Quadriradiates. (<1) These spicules are generally much scarcer than the simple triradiates, but can always be found. Their facial rays are similar to the triradiates, with perhaps slightly less tendency to elongation of the unpaired rays. The gastral ray is short or of moderate length, laterally compressed, and set well back on the unpaired facial ray ; its proximal end runs straight upwards for about two-thirds of its length, then the shaft curves forwards, the distal extremity, however, being again nearly straight. Spiculation of the Oscular Rim. The skeletal spicules of the oscular rim appear to be quadriradiates alone. They are of relatively small size and slender dimensions ; the lateral angles are very nearly or even quite right angles, so that the spicule is more or less T-shaped ; the unpaired rays are always distinctly longer than the paired, the latter being strongly curved, and the gastral rays are relatively long. The monaxons of the oscular rim are, writh rare exceptions, of the smallest size. Both ordinary and refringent monaxons are found ; the former differ from those in other parts in the slenderness of the shaft, the proximal end of which is scarcely or not at all swollen. The refringent mouaxons in this region are also very slender and sharp. LEUCOSOLENIA MINCHINI. (Plate XXVIII., Figs. 14-15.) There are about eleven specimens of this new species in the collection, most of them being oscular tubes only, with very little root tube. Their appearance and habit of growth are well shown in Fig. 14, drawn by Professor Minchin. The oscular tubes, which are 3 mm. to 4 mm. long, are usually largest towards the middle of their length. Diameter, flattened, about 5 mm. The bulk of the skeleton spicules are triradiates, regularly arranged and often in rather open order, so that the walls have a transparent appearance. The oxea, which are small, usually about 90 i*. long and never exceeding 160 M, are usually scarce, and in some specimens almost, if not entirely, wanting. In the specimens with plentiful oxea there is a fringe round the oscule, see Fig. 15, but in the specimens with few oxea there is little or no fringe. Spicules (Fig. 15). Oxea. — There are two sorts of oxea, ordinary and refringent :— (a) Ordinary oxea, straight or slightly curved, with a lance head which is usually bent slightly to one side, 60 M to 160/* long x 3/x to 6/u. thick. OALOAEBA. 9 The commonest size is 90 /u long x 4 /u to OM tliirk. In some specimens the maximum size is 90 M long. Among the ordinary oxea there are a very few r type oxea. It is uncertain whether these are always present. It seems probable that in those specimens in which the oxea are very scarce there may he none of F type. (l>) Refringent oxea, similar to the smaller and thinner sizes of (a) and usually nearly straight. The Triradiates are of one sort :— (c) Alate triradiates, with the basal ray longer than the paired rays. Basal ray straight, tapering, fairly sharply pointed, 90 M to 140/u long x 5 /u to 10 M thick. Paired rays equal, bent very slightly downwards, tapering slightly for about two-thirds of their length, then fairly sharply pointed, 50 n to 90 M long x 5/x to 7yu thick ; oral angle 130° to 140°. The Quadriradiates are of one sort : — ('/) Alate quadriradiates, facial rays the same as the triradiates (c). Apical ray sharply pointed. Oscular spicul-x :- (e) Oxea from the fringe, like (a) but shorter, with bluntly pointed lance heads, 55 yu to 65 M long x 5 /u. to G /u thick. (/) Quadriradiates from the oscular edge like (r:iiL'.tta fruticosa, gives the ratio 12 to 15. The new variety has the ratio 25 to 40. The spicules are shown in Fig. 34, with one of the ' Challenger' specimens of Leucetta primigenia for comparison beside them. Haeckel does not describe the alate oscular spicules, which, in the new variety, differ widely from the normal spicules, as will be seen from the figure. These spicules lie with the basal rays circumfereutially round the oscule, and not, as might have been expected, symmetrically. Polejaeff s species, Leucetta dura, cannot now remain, since it is only based on the existence of an oscule which was supposed not to be always present in Leucetta microraphis. . 15 Spicules (Fig. 34). The Body .y>iculi'# are of one sort :— ('/) Regular triradiates. Hays straight, very slender, parallel, Uuntly pointed, 140 M to 200 M long x 4 n to ZM thick. Ratio of length to thickness, 25 to 40. The Ocular .sy//) Alate triradiatcs, strongly folded. Basal ray straight, nearly parallel, Uuntly pointed, 55 p. to 90 M long X 7 /« to 8 M thick. Paired ravs nearly straight in facial view, and twice bent when viewed parallel to the hasal ray. Tapering, moderately sharply pointed, 00 /u to 140 /u lung x 8 M to 10 M thick. Ural angle 105° to 115°. Angle of fold 110° LEUCANDUA KI;I<;IJ>A. (Plate XXVII., Fig. f,, and Plates XXIX. and XXX., Figs. 35-40.) There are eleven specimens of this new species in the collection. They are all liu- shaped, with the oscule at the thick end (see Fig. G). The surface is smooth, pure white and rather chalky in appearance. They varv in size from 10 mm. x •'! mm. to 30 mm. x 10mm. (see Fig. 35). They are all solid to the touch, though thev varv very much in texture when 'cut open. All liut one of the specimens have the oscule completely closed, and its presence is only indicated externally by a slight protuberance. < me specimen. 21 mm. long x 7 mm. diameter, has the oscule open. ; it is 2 mm. in diameter, and is surrounded by a short spiculated membranous collar (see Fig. 39). Tlie canal system varies considerably in the different specimens ; in some there is a wide gastral cavity with large branching canals opening into it, while in others there is no gastral canty, the excurrent canals all converging to the oscule. In cross-section the specimens differ less than might be expected, for the gastral cavity appears to be divided by delicate septa, which give the whole section a meshwork appearance even when longitudinal sections show a large cavity. The excurrent canals are usually surrounded with a fairly distinct skeleton of triradiates, among which are a few quadriradiates. The incurrent canal system is made up of a series of very irregular spaces leading from the surface into the rather more regular longitudinal canals ; these run parallel to the excurrent canals, from which they may be distinguished by their less pronounced skeleton, which never contains quadriradiates. The bulk of the skeleton consists of regular triradiates ; the quadriiadiates round the gastral cavities and excurrent canals are very constant in size. In some specimens they are so rare that thev can onlv be found with great difficulty. The apical ray-, which are slender and crocked, project into the canals. 2 R 16 C. F. JENKIN. Spicules (Fig. 40). The Triradiates are of oiie sort :— («} Approximately regular triradiates. Ra}rs straight, tapering, rather bluntly pointed, 130/u to 310 /x long x 10 M to 20 ,u thick. One of the rays is occasionally rather longer than the other two, the maximum ratio observed being 5/4. Very rarely one of the rays is shorter than the other two, the maximum ratio observed being 3/2. The angles in all cases are almost exactly equal ; T forms are occasionally found. The rare Quadriradiates are of two sorts :— (b) Approximately regular quadriradiates from the lining of the excurrent canals and gastral cavities. Facial rays straight, slender, slightly tapering, bluntly pointed, 160," to 200 M long x 9 ^ to 12 n thick. Angles equal, 120°. Apical rays slender, wavy, sharply pointed, 280 n long x 8 M to 9 M thick. (t) Abnormal quadriradiates apparently due to the growth of a very short apical ray on one of type (a) triradiates. LETJCANDRA BRUMALIS. (Plate XXX., Figs. 41-43.) There are five specimens of this new species in the collection. They have no very definite shape (see Figs. 41 and 42), but all are considerably longer than they are broad, and each has a single small gastral cavity, surrounded at the upper end by a small membranous collar about 2 • 5 mm. long. They are smooth and white as preserved in alcohol. The consistency of the sponge is fairly solid. Canal System. — There are small incurrent chambers under the dermis, communicating with irregular, more or less radial, iueurrent canals. The excurrent canals are also more or less radial, opening into the gastral cavity. The Skeleton consists of slender regular triradiates with a few regular quadriradiates round the gastral cavity. The apical rays, which project into the gastral cavity, are very slender and crooked, the point being usually bent rather sharply. This species resembles Leucalti* pinnila, var. Bleekii (II), but the triradiates are much smaller and slenderer, while the quadriradiates are regular instead of irregular. Spicules (Fig. 43). The Triradintes are of one sort :— (a) Regular triradiates, rays straight, tapering uniformly to a fairly sharp point, 170 /^t to 180 /A long x 6 /u, to 10 /A thick. 17 The Quadriradiates are «\ one sort : (f>) Regular ({iiadriradiates of varying size from the lining of the exninvnt canals. Facial rays almost straight, tapering to a ]inint GO M to 180 M long X 4 M to 8 /« thick. Apical ray very slightly wavy, sharply pointed. The point usually bent a little to one side, 50 M to 120 // long x 3 M to 4 n thick. LEUCANDRA GELATINOSA. (Plate XXX., Figs. 44-53.) There arc two specimens of this new species in the collection ; one fixed in osmic acid, which is therefore brown, and the other in spirits, which is (juitc white. The consistency is firm and the surface smooth. The general shape of the larger specimen shown in Fig. 44 is irregular and contorted, suggesting a tuberous root ; the oscule, which is entirely closed, is at the top of the dome-shaped end. The diameter of this part of the specimen is 11 mm. ; the smaller specimen is in the form of a rod 24 mm. long, nearly straight, rounded off at the oscular end. which is 4 mm. diameter, and tapering gradually to the lower end, which is 2 mm. diameter. The mass of the sponge is formed of the solid gelatinous mesoderm. which is remarkably developed in this species, and the iiiciirrent and excurreut canals are reduced to definite pipes lined with epithelium in this jelly. There is no gastral cavity, the numerous excurrent canals converge to the oscule in the top of the domed end. These canals are regular circular pipes of small section lined with an extremely elastic epithelium, which has contracted to such an extent as to almost close the lumens of the canals (see Figs. 45 and 46). The flagellated chambers are scattered throughout the body of the sponge and communicate with the excurrent canals by means of narrow outlet pipes. The outlet pipes from several flagellated chambers usually join together before they open into tin- main excurrent canals. These small outlet pipes are lined with elastic epithelium, which is continuous with the lining of the main excurrent canals, so that when the main canals close the small pipes are stretched out lengthwise in order to maintain their connection with the central lumen of the main canal (see Fig. 46). There are a large number of small ostia (see Fig. 48), close together all over the dermal surface (see Fig. 47), which communicate through narrow passages (see Fig. 49) with irregular branching chambers under tin- dermal cortex: these in turn lead into the iwurn-ut canals which run as irregular pipes radially inwards, and communicate with more regular circular canals running parallel to the axis of the sponge. These canals have not contracted. The flagellated chambers arc often situated close against the incurrent canals, so that the communication is direct, presumably through a pore cell which, in the contracted condition of the sponge, is closed. \\ hen there is no incurrent canal near the chamber a narrow branch leads from the incurrent canal to the flagellated chamber (see Figs. 51, 52 and 53). 2 K 2 18 C. F. JEXKIX. The Skeleton is built up almost entirely of regular triradiates, but among the triradiates lining the excurreut canals there are a very few regular quadriradiates with slender, wavy, apical rays projecting inwards. The oscule is closed by the folding in of a thin oscular collar which, when open, probably stands erect as a short tube. The collar has a thin skeleton of triradiates. Spicules (Fig. 50). The Trirai/inti.'X are of one sort :— ('/) Regular triradiates of widely differing sizes. Rays almost perfectly straight, but not quite, tapering moderately to near their ends, then sharply pointed, 140 M to 320 fj. long X 10 M to 20 M thick. The rare Quadriradiates are of one sort :— (b) Regular quadriradiates from the lining of the excurrent canals. Facial rays equal, straight, tapering moderately to near their ends, then sharply pointed, 110 fj. long x 8 M thick. Apical rays wavy, sharply pointed, 80 p to 100 M long X 3 M to 8 ft thick. LEUCANDRA CIRRATA. (Plate XXXI, Figs. 54-56.) There are two specimens of this new species in the collection, one complete, the other much distorted, and possibly only a portion of a complete sponge. The follow- ing description applies to the complete specimen. The sponge is ovoid in shape, 8'5 mm. x 3 mm., and is white as preserved in spirits. It is completely covered by long, angularly bent projecting oxea, which to the naked eye give the surface the appearance of being covered with curling hair. The structure of the body wall which surrounds a larg'e gastral cavity is shown in Fig. 54. The gastral skeleton consists of triradiates and quadriradiates lying tangentially with their basal ray downwards ; the body skeleton consists of sub- gastral triradiates and the inner ends of the projecting oxea ; the dermal skeleton is strong, consisting of about eight layers of triradiates, irregularly placed. The oxea and sub-gastral triradiates are arranged in groups up which the body substance (flagellated chambers) creeps to the dermis, forming as it were columns supporting the cortex. Between these columns under the cortex is a large space forming an incurrent chamber which is continuous over the whole sponge. There are only two or three layers of the flagellated chambers, which are roughly spherical, between the gastral and dermal membranes. The excurrent canals are short and simple. The oscule has a fringe of stumpy oxea (Fig. 56) ; there is no diaphragm. r.U.t'AHKA. 19 SpicuIeS (Figs. 55 and 56). The Oxea are of one sort :— (n) Very large bent projecting oxea, of all .sizes from 400 M to l,830/x long, x 20 M to 33 M thick, pointed at both ends, usually straight for about two- thirds of their length, then bent at two or three points angularly, the cud being often bent through a total angle of 125° from the axis of the straightcr portion of the spicule. The points where the angular bends occur are often marked on the convex side by flattened areas, as if the spiculc had been deflected by contact with a plane surface. The Triradiates are of one sort :— (ft) Alate triradiates of very variable ,-hape. There is no distinction between the gastral, body wall and dermal triradiates. Basal ray straight, tapering, sharply pointed, 190 M to 360 M long x 10 /u to 14 M thick. Paired rays straight or bent slightly up or down, 160 M to 220 M long x 10 M to 14 M thick. Tapering slightly and rather bluntly pointed. Oral angle 110° to 145°. Qufidriradiates. — There is one sort of quadriiadiate :— (c) Alate quadriradiates from the gastral cortex, basal rav straight, tapering to a sharp point, 280 M long x 12 /u thick. 1'ahvd rays equal, slightly bent upwards, 140 to 220 M long X 10 to 12 // thick. Oral angle about 130° folded backwards, i.e. away from the face bearing the apical rav. An^Ie ..)' fold about 170°. Apical ray 40 M long X 8 to 10 ^ thick, sharply pointed, bent orally. Oscular xj>ic/ifi-x. (/) The oscular fringe consists of short club-shaped oxea tapering to a point at the inner end and bent near the outer end, which is rounded, l.~>0/t to 230 /u long X 12/t to 45/u thick. The thicker spicules arc the commoner. The triradiates at the cdue have an oral angle of nearly 180°. LKI i AM'iiA niP.r.nxA.* (Plate XXXI., Kiu-. 57 58.) There are two specimens of this new species in the collection, one straight, vase- shaped, 7 mm. x 1^ mm., the other bent through at right aii-h-. C. mm. x 1 mm. In colour they are dull yellow as preserved in spirits, and appear minutely hispid to the naked eye. The structure of the body wall, which surrounds a large gastral cavity, is shown in * Most of the specimens wore collected at the • Discovery's ' Winter (.Huirters. 20 C. F. JENKIN. Fif. 57. The gastral skeleton consists of quadriradiates with the basal ray pointing downwards : the body skeleton consists of sub-gastral triradiates and the inner ends of the projecting oxea. Among the sub-gastral triradiates there are a very few quadriradiates exactly like the triradiates, except for the development of the apical ray, which is roughly perpendicular to the plane of -the other rays, and does not project into the gastral cavity. The dermal skeleton consists of a thin layer of triradiates with the basal ray pointing downwards. The space between gastral and, dermal membranes is filled up with three or four layers of spherical flagellated chambers between which arc small iucurrent and excurrent canals. There are no large incurrent chambers as in Leucandra cirrata. The oscular skeleton consists of quadriradiates with an oral angle of nearly 180° and oxea. The dermal triradiates do not reach quite up to the edge. The thin oxea which form the fringe are straight, with hastate ends. Just below the oscule there are a few very short stout projecting oxea, similar in form to the longer ones lower down. Spicules (Fig. 58). The Oxea are of one sort : — (n) Large projecting oxea, bluntly pointed at the inner end, hastate and sharply pointed at the outer end, nearly straight for about three-quarters of their length, then bent at the outer end, 260 M to 670 M long x 12 M to 24 fj. thick at the thickest point. The thickness varies irregularly along the length. Triradiates. — There are two sorts of triradiates :— (ft) Sub-gastral alate triradiates. Basal ray straight, tapering uniformly to a sharp point, 160/x to 200 M long x 6 M thick. Paired rays equal, more or less bent downwards, 80 M long x 6 /u. to 8 ^ thick, nearly uniform in thickness all along, then bluntly pointed. Oral angle 135° to 150°. (c) Dermal alate triradiates. Basal ray straight, occasionally shorter than the paired rays, 60 /x to 200 P. long x 8 M to 11 M thick, tapering slightly, then bluntly pointed. Paired rays usually differing slightly in shape and size ; bent upwards in a wide sweep at the centre and then usually slightly downwards near the points. 100/u to 140 M long x 9/u to 12ju, thick. Oral angle 105° to 115°. The Quadriradiates are of one sort :— (/I) Gastral alate quadriradiates. Basal ray straight, tapering uniformly to a sharp point. 100 /j. to 300 /u long X 8 ^ to 12 /A thick. Paired rays equal, bending upwards in a wide sweep at the centre, outer half straight, 80 ^ to CAT.('AT?EA. 21 180/i long X 9/1 to ]:\IJL thick. < >ral angle l'JO°. Apical ray curved slightly orally, sharply pointed, 80 p. long X 8 p. thick. (r) Fringe oxca, slender, hastate, straight except for a slight bend at junction of the spear-head. IGO/i to 240 p long x 7 /u. to 9 ju. thick. The maximum thickness is just below the spear-head. (/) Stumpy, stout, hastate oxea. from just below the edge, similar to (a) 140 ju, to 160 /A long X 1 4 p to lf> p thick. (//) Small quadriradiates from the oscular edge. Basal ray 180ft or less x 8 p. to 10 p. Paired rays equal, sharply pointed, bending slightly down ward •;. 70 /A to 100 p. long x 8/x to 10 p. thick. Ural angle 155° to 160°. Apical ray short, sharply pointed, bent slightly orally. DERMATRETON. Gran tikis in which the radial chambers are "linked" so as to form a reticulated pattern round the large inter-canals, and are covered with a continuous reticulated cortex. The definition of this new genus in the family Grantiidae corresponds to that of '1',-iitlii'i-innli-n in the family Sycettidae. The remarkable reticulated cortices of the two species in this genus are shown in Figs. Gl and 71. The importance of the " linking " of the flagellated chambers as a generic characteristic is emphasised by the fact that it produces a corresponding type of cortex. The cortical spicules have developed from the distal spicules of the tubar skeleton. In drantid the inter-canals are small, and the skeleton bridges over them. In Dermatri'ton the inter-canals are too large to be bridged over, and a reticulated cortex results. In both the species in this genus the sponge is in the form of a tube more or less bent, of circular cross-section, the maximum diameter being near the middle. The tube tapers gradually to the base, which is very small, and also to the upper end, which terminates in the oscule. The interior of the tube forms the gastral cavity. The inner or gastral layer is supported by a special skeleton of large quadriradiates regularly arranged, with the basal ray pointing downwards and the apical ray projecting into the gastral cavity. Outside the gastral layer stand the ilagdlated chambers, pointing radially outwards and linked into a meshwork pattern. They communicate with the gastral cavity either independently (D. chartaceum] or in groups through excurrent chambers (D. /i»iti). The distal ends of the flagellated chambers are covered by a reticulated cortex, which follows the " linked " pattern of the chambers. Many of the dermal triradjates lie in inclined positions, more or less embracing the rounded tops of the flagellated chambers. 1 1 thus happens not 22 C. F. JEXKIX. infrequently that spicules may be found with one of the paired rays pointing almost radially inwards, and at first sight suggesting that sub-dermal triradiates are present (cf. Fig. 59). The peculiar shape of the dermal triradiates, however, makes it easy to prove that it is always a paired ray, and not the basal ray, which is ceutripetally directed. DERMATRETOX CHARTACEUM. (Plate XXVIL, Fig. 5, and Plates XXXI. aud XXXII., Figs. 59-G4.) There is only one specimen of this new species in the collection. It was found at a depth of 180 fathoms. It is nearly straight, 23 mm. long x 3 mm. maximum diameter, quite wrhite as preserved in alcohol, and has the appearance of a delicate paper tube (see Fig. 5). The walls are only 0' 32 mm. thick at their thickest point. The reticulated pattern on the surface is too small to be readily seen with the naked eye. The structure of the body wall is shown in Fig. 59. The flagellated chambers open directly into the gastral cavity through contractile apopylcs (see Fig. GO). The skeleton of the flagellated chambers consists normally of a single row of sub-gastral triradiates, but there is occasionally a smaller triradiate half-way between the gastral and dermal layers. There are also fine hair oxea, not shown in the figure, surrounding the flagellated chambers. The distal ends of the flagellated chamber skeletons are strengthened by oxea. which project a short distance beyond the dermis. The distal ends of the chambers are covered by a reticulated cortex with a skeleton formed of curved triradiates (see Fig. 63). The gastral skeleton (Fig. 62) is formed of large quadriradiates, among which there are a very few which appear to have no apical ray. The oscular skeleton is shown in Fig. 61. The edge, which is slightly everted, is formed of small quadriradiates. There is a very short fringe of hair oxea, amongst which are a few stout oxea similar to those in the body wall. The dermal triradiates extend up to the edge. Spicules (Fig. G4). O.fi.'ti. — There are two sorts of oxea : — (a) Projecting oxea, slightly crooked, slightly hastate, 130yu to 270 n long x 11 M to 16 M thick. (/>) Hair oxea about 1 M thick. Trii'adiates. — The triradiates are of two sorts : — (c) Alate sub-gastral triradiates forming the tubar skeleton. Basal ray straight, tapering to a moderately sharp point, 320 p. to 700 n long x 9 /* to 10/u thick. Paired rays nearly equal, slightly crooked, lOO/x to 160// long x 9/x to 12 fj. thick, bluntly pointed. Oral angle variable from 170° to 120°; strongly folded; angle of fold 120° to 130°. CALCARKA. 23 ('/) Alate triradiates from the dermal cortex. Basal ray nearly straight, bluntly pointed, 80 M to 140 M long X 9 /* to 10 M thick. Paired rays unequal, slightly curved upwards, often longer than the basal ray, 65 M to 150 n long x SM to 10 M thick. Oral angle 100° to 110°. The Quadriradiates are of one sort :— (>') Alatc quadriradiates from the gastral layer. Basal ray straight, tapering uniformly to a sharp point, 500 M to 700 M long x 10 M thick. Paired ravs usually equal, slightly bent in either direction, 100 M to 230 /u long x 8 /* to II fj. thick. Oral angle 130°. Apical ray nearly straight, sharply pointed, 70 ^ to 100 M long x 6/x thick. Oscular spiculcs. — The fringe is formed of oxea of types (a) and (f>). The oscular edge is formed of small quadriradiates similar to (c), but smaller. Basal ray 100/u long X 8 p. thick. Paired rays about lOO/u long. DERMATRETON HODGSON:.* (Plate XXVIL, Fig. 1, and Plat.- XXXII., Figs. 05-74). There is only one specimen of this new species in the collection. It is bent and irregularly swollen (see Fig. 1), the length being GO mm. and the maximum diaim-tiT 14 mm., tapering at both ends to about 3 mm. It is quite white as preserved in alcohol. To the naked eye the surface appears to be smooth and minutely reticulated The walls are delicate, only 1 mm. thick at their thickest point. The structure of the body wall is partly shown in Fig. 73. The flagellated chambers open through contractile apopyles into excurrent chambers, three or four into each, and these in turn communicate with the gastral cavity through large irregular ports. The excurreut chambers have no proper skeleton, but are merely spaces left between the proximal ends of the chambers and the gastral layer. Four of the flagellated chambers opening into an exriirrenf chamber are shown in Fig. 66. The skeletons are drawn and the interior linings indicated by dotted line-;. A cross, section of the same excurreut chamber is shown diagrammatically in Fig. f>7. The form of the excurreut chambers varies widely, they are often much deeper than the one illustrated. The flagellated chambers have ordinary articulated skeletons of manv joints, strengthened at the distal ends by oxea, which project a short distance beyond the dermis, and also by long hair oxea, which project with the thicker o.xca and extend inwards nearly to the gastral layer. The " linked " arrangement of the flagellated chambers is shown in Figs. 68, 69 and 70. Fig. 68 shows the ports iu the. gastral layer, Fig. 69 the flagellated chambers just above the gastral layer, and Fig. 70 the same chambers higher up, arranged in a "linked" pattern. All three figures are drawn * The author ventures to name this species after Mr. T. V. Hodgson, the biologist of the Expedition, to whose untiring industry and ingenuity the magnitude of the collection is due. VOL. iv. ~ 1- 24 C. F. JENKIN. from corresponding portions of a series of tangential sections. Several of the chambers are numbered, and may be traced from one section to another. The distal ends of the flagellated chambers are covered by a reticulated cortex with a skeleton formed of curved triradiates (see Fig. 71). The gastral skeleton, formed of large quadriradiates, is shown in Fig. 72. The oscular skeleton is shown in Fig. 65. The quadriradiates at the edge are smaller than the gastral quadriradiates. There are a few stout oxea and hair oxea projecting. The dermal spicules extend to the edge. Spicules (Fig. 74). Oxea. — There are two sorts of oxea :— (a) Projecting hastate oxea, slightly crooked, 150 /A to 240 /A long x 12 /A to 16 /A thick, bluntly pointed at each end. (b) Hair oxea of considerable length. Triradiates. — The triradiates are of two sorts : — (c) Alate triradiates from the tubar skeleton, of very variable size. The largest are in the proximal joint of the skeleton, and they diminish towards the distal end, where they change into type (d). Basal ray straight, sharply pointed, 330 p. long x 9 /A thick. Paired rays equal, straight, 120 /A long x 10 /t thick. Oral angle of sub-gastral spicules 160°. Oral angle of spicules from the middle of the tubar skeleton 125°. (d) Alate triradiates from dermal cortex. Basal ray straight, bluntly pointed, 70 /A to 130 ju. long x 10 /A thick, often shorter than the paired rays. Paired rays equal, straight or slightly curved upwards, bluntly pointed, forming a short curve in the centre where they join the basal ray, 130 /x to 140 /A long x 10/t thick. Oral angle 105° to 110°, strongly folded; angle of fold 116° to 130°. The Quadriradiates are of one sort :— (f) Alate quadriradiates from the gastral layer. Basal ray straight, tapering uniformly to a sharp point, 500 /A to 850 /A long X 10 /A to 11 /A thick. Paired rays sometimes very unequal in length, straight, or slightly curved downwards, 150 /A to 400 /A long X 9 /u. to 12 /A thick, bluntly pointed. Oral angle, 135° to 145°. Apical ray sharply pointed, nearly perpendicular to the facial rays, slightly bent orally near the point, 7 /A or 8 /A thick. FAMILY CHIPHORID^E. nov. Definition. — Flagellated chambers elongated, arranged radially around a central gastral cavity, their ends projecting more or less on the dermal surface and not CALCAREA. 25 covered over by a continuous dermal cortex. The tubar skeleton is articulate, ///<• //'/•*/ joint lifini/ formed of chiactines. The above only differs from Deudy's definition of Syci'ttidse by the addition of the words in italics. STREPTOCONUS. Chiphorids in which the radial chambers are usually more or less united at places where they come in contact with one another, and are always crowned at the distal extremity with tufts of oxeote spicules. The tubar skeleton is articulate, the first joint being formed of chiactines. The definition of this new genus in the Chiphoridse corresponds to that of Sycon in the Sycettidse. STREPTOCONUS AUSTRAIJS. (Plate XXVII., Fig. 3, and Plates XXXII. and XXXIII. , Figs. 75-80.) There are three specimens of this new species in the collection ; all are small, shaped like a Florence flask and covered with long projecting oxea, see Fig. 3. They are white as preserved in spirits. Their dimensions are between 7 mm. x 3 mm. and 10 mm. x 4 mm. The gastral cavity terminates in a long oscular collar 2 mm. to 3 mm. long, with slightly everted edge crowned with a fringe of slender hastate oxea. The body wall is made up of the radial flagellated chambers (see Fig. 75 ), which touch each other for most of their length and have large projecting distal cones crowned by tufts of long slightly bent hastate oxea ; these oxea converge in cones over the chambers, and then, crossing spirally, spread out and interlace. Each chamber opens separately into the gastral cavity. In tangential section the chambers appear more or less regularly arranged as hexagons with triangular intercauals. The Skeleton. — The whole gastral cavity and oscular tube is lined with a sparse layer of large quadriradiates (see Figs. 77 and 79), regularly arranged with the basal ray pointing downwards and the apical ray projecting into the gastral cavity ; the apical ray is slightly bent orally. A few of these large radiates appear to lack the apical ray. The radial chambers have articulated skeletons (see Fig. 75), the proximal joint consisting of chiactines, all of which have their apical rays turned towards the flagellated chamber, so that when looking at the gastral surface the apical ravs appear to form a protection to the apopyle (see Fig. 79). The upper joints of the articulated skeleton of the flagellated chamber consist of triradiates of ordinary form. The unpaired rays of the outermost triradiates project, with the oxea, forming the bases of the large distal tufts. The oscular collar has a very fragile skeleton consisting of large quadriradiates widely spaced (see Fig. 77). On the outside it is thinly covered with long oxea which project downwards and outwards at an angle of about -la from the axis. 2 L 2 26 C. F. JENKIN. The rim of the tube is formed by a ring of small quadriradiates regularly aud closely packed, with the impaired ray downwards and apical ray inwards. The rim is crowned by a fringe of long nearly straight hastate oxea. (Bee Fig. 78.) The sharply defined line of the small quadriradiates forming the rim of the collar, standing above the widely spaced quadriradiates which form the lower part of the skeleton, produces the effect of a vacant space with no spicules between the two. The space is however no wider than between other rows of the collar skeleton, and occasionally one of the big quadriradiates is found in the rim itself. No diaphragm can be seen. Fig. 80 represents a longitudinal section through the junction between .the oscular collar and body. The gastral skeleton is continuous and the flagellated chambers grow outside it. The first is very minute, with no skeleton ; the second is larger, with a primitive skeleton. The length of the chambers continues to increase down to the base of the sponge. Spicules (Fig. 76). O.eea. There are three sorts of oxea : — (a) Stout projecting hastate oxea, usually straight, but occasionally bent sharply through an angle of about 120°, varying irregularly in thickness ; 300 M to 1,250 p- long x 9 n to 15 p.. (b) Thin projecting oxea, quite straight, faintly hastate, maximum size 1,020 /A x Gn. (c) Small hastate oxea 140/« x 8 /*. Triradiates. There are two sorts of triradiates :— (d) Large alate triradiates from the gastral layer. Basal rays straight, tapewng uniformly to a sharp point from 190/u to 300 M long x 6 M to 8 /u thick. The paired rays are nearly equal, nearly straight, from 80 /A to 150 /x long X 6 p. to 8 p. thick. Oral angle 130° to 140°. (/) Small alate triradiates from the tubar skeleton. Basal ray straight, 100/u x 6 p., tapering to a sharp point. Paired rays irregularly bent, 7 OP. x 6/«. Oral angle 120° to 135°. Considerably folded. Quadriradiates, There are two sorts of quadriradiates : — (g) Large alate quadriradiates from the gastral layer. Basal ray straight, tapering uniformly to a sharp point, 230 // to 430 M long x 6/«to 12/u thick ; the larger sizes occur in the oscular collar. Paired rays bracket- shaped, nearly equal in length, 140^ to 215^ long x 8 M to 10 M thick. Apical ray thin and sharply pointed, bent orally. Apparent size seen facially, 32 M x 4^- Oral angle varying from 110 M in body to 150° in oscular collar. (h) Small chiactines from the tubar skeleton. Basal ray, 140/« to 220 p. long x 4 p. to 6 M thick, tapering uniformly to a sharp point, appearing «'. \LOARE A. 27 straight in facial view, but often slightly bent in side view at a point a short distance from the junction with the paired rays. This bend is connected with the close manner in which pairs of these spienles lie together. Paired rays bent slightly downwards, nearly equal in length, sharply pointed, 70 M to 110/z, long X 3 p. to 5 p. thick. Oral angle 140° to 150°. Folding considerable, angle of fold 115° to 125°. Apical ray thin, 50 p. to G5;u, x 3 fi, considerably set over out of line with the basal ray. Angle between apical and basal ray about 170°. Oscular spicuh's. The fringe consists of :— (/) Hastate oxea, nearly straight, 240 p, to 700 /A long x 5 p. to 8 p. thick. The edge consists of :— (k) Small quadriradiates. Basal ray straight, uniformly tapering to a sharp point, 110/x to 17 Op. long x 5 p. to 8 p, thick. Paired rays equal, considerably curved downwards, sharply pointed, 60 p. to lOOju. long x 8 M thick. Oral angle about 160°. HYPODICTYON. Chiphorids in which the radial chambers with freely projecting distal cones are linked so as to form a reticulated pattern round the large intercauals. The tubar skeleton is articulate, the first joint being wholly or partially formed of chiactines. This new genus in the family Chiphoridse corresponds to the genus Tenthrenodes in the family Syccttidse. There is only one species in this genus. HYPODIOTYON LONGSTAFFI. (Plate XXVII., Fig. 10, and Plates XXXIII. and XXXIV., Figs. 81-97.) There are four specimens of this new species in the collection. All are in the form of longish tubes more or less bent, stouter in the middle and tapering towards each end ; the upper ends terminate in short, smooth, oscular collars, and the lower ends are rounded off. The whole sponge, except the oscular collar, is covered by a meshwork of projecting spicules which give the surface a bristly honeycombed appearance (see Figs. 10 and 81). The dimensions of the four specimens are as follows :— Length. Maximum iluiiwtrr. 60 mm. . . . . 15 mm. 37 mm. .... 7 mm. 50 mm. .... 5 mm. 37 mm. .... 9 mm. All the specimens are white in colour as preserved in spirits. s C. F. JENKIN. The body walls are formed of the long branching flagellated chambers (see Fig. 89), which are roughly oval at their proximal ends and are packed closely together on the gastral cortex ; each chamber opens directly into the gastral cavity through an irregular apopyle. Following the flagellated chambers outwards by means of serial tangential sections (Figs. 83 to 87 and 92-97), it will be seen that the chambers usually divide into two branches close above the gastral layer, and that these branches often divide a second time near their distal ends. At the same time it will be seen that the irregular arrangement of the flagellated chambers on the gastral layer gradually changes till at the outer surface it assumes the regular linked pattern which is typical of the genus. The Skeleton. — The gastral skeleton consists almost entirely of large tri- and quadriradiates irregularly arranged, with the basal ray pointing more or less down- wards (see Fig. 91). In addition to these there are the paired rays of the chiactines which occur occasionally round the apopyles. The gastral skeleton continues into the oscular collar and is modified near the oscular rim, as shown in Fig. 88. The junction of the oscular collar and body wall is shown in Fig. 82, in which the gradual growth of the flagellated chambers may be seen. Near the rim the triradiates almost or entirely disappear, and the quadriradiates are much smaller. There is a fringe of hair oxea (these are absent in one specimen) amongst which are a few stout oxea, apparently of the same sort as those on the distal ends of the flagellated chambers. There are a few thin bent oxea scattered irregularly near the edge. The skeleton of the flagellated chambers is of the ordinary articulated type, consisting of small triradiates, which converge at the top of the chamber to form a point which is strengthened by a bundle of oxea of two types which project freely. Every here and there in the proximal joint a chiactine may be found replacing one of the ordinary triradiates; its apical ray projects diagonally into the gastral cavity and across the apopyle. It is the presence of these chiactines which has made it necessary to form the genus Hypodictyon for this species instead of putting it in the genus Tenthrenodes. Spicules (Fig. 90). Oxea. — There are two sorts of oxea : — ('/) Projecting oxea from the distal cones, slightly irregularly bent, some slightly hastate, from 100 M long x 12 M thick to 900 v long x 26 M thick. (b) Hair oxea projecting with (a). Triradiates. — There are two forms of triradiates : — (c) Large alate triradiates from the gastral layer. Basal ray straight, tapering uniformly to a sharp point, maximum size, 800 M X 10 fj.. Paired rays, nearly straight, of uniform thickness all along, bluntly pointed, usually CALCAREA. 29 of unequal lengths, 180 p. to 430 M long X 10 M to 16 M thick. Oral angle about 135°. (d) Smaller alate triradiates from the tubar skeleton. Basal ray straight, tapering to a sharp point, 140 /" to 260 /u long x 8 p. to 10 p. thick. Paired rays nearly equal and straight, 80 /A to 150 p. long x 8 p. to 10 p, thick, slightly folded. Oral angle 130°. Quadriradiates. — There are two sorts of quadriradiates : — (<') Large quadriradiates from the gastral layer. Basal ray straight, tapering uniformly to a sharp point, maximum length 1,000 /A x 9 p. to 12 p.. Paired rays of unequal length, often slightly crooked, of irregular thick- ness, bluntly pointed, 220 p, to 420 p. long x 1 1 p. to 13 p. thick. Apical ray sharply pointed, bent orally, about 80 p- x 12/x. Oral angle 128° to 138°. (/) Chiactines. Similar to (d) with the addition of an apical ray 90 p. long x G p. thick, sharply pointed. These are not shown in the drawing of spicules. Oscular spiculi's : — ( 400 p. lung x 15 /A thick. Paired rays equal, 130 p. to 180 p. long x 16 p. thick, bent slightly irregularly. Oral angle, 145° to 165°. Angle of fold, 150° VOL. IV, 2 M 32 C. F. JENKIN. to 160°. Apical rays sharply pointed, slightly irregularly bent, 70 /A to 100 /A long x I2p. thick; set-off slight; angle between apical ray and basal ray 165°. Oscular Sj^ioules. — The fringe consists of hair spicules, and stout oxea of types (c) and (a) :— (/") Small quadriradiates from the oscular edge. Basal ray straight, tapering, and rather bluntly pointed, 100 /A to 120 /A long /x X 9 /u, to 10 /A thick. Paired rays about equal, bent downwards, 50 /A to 100 /a long x 7 /A to 8 n thick. Ural angle about 150°. (g) The quadriradiates from the oscular collar are similar to (/), but much larger. Basal rays 220 /n or more long ; paired rays up to 200 //, long ; apical rays up to 120 yu, long. ACHRAMORPHA GRANDINIS. (Plate XXVIL, Fig. 4, and Plates XXXIV. and XXXV., Figs. 103-104.) There is only one broken specimen of this new species in the collection ; it consists of the upper part and oscular collar of a sponge which probably was of considerable size, judging by the size of the oscule (see Fig. 4). The specimen is straight, 18 mm. long, and circular in section, tapering from 4^ to 3 mm. in diameter at the oscular end. The lower part is covered by long oxea, which lie along the surface pointing downwards ; the upper part is smooth and transparent. There is no fringe. The structure of the body wall is the same as in the other species of this genus. There are no hair oxea, but there are a few small prickly hastate oxea in the dermis. The oscule (see Fig. 104) differs considerably from the other two species. There is no fringe of hair oxea and no special ring of quadriradiates at the edge, the skeleton being made up of both tri- and quadriradiates lying tangentially. The transition from tangential quadriradiates to chiactines occurs in the same way as in the other species. The basal rays of the chiactines project a long way outside the dermis. Spicules (Fig. 103). Oxea. There are two sorts of Oxea : — (a) Very large straight projecting oxea, size of longest fragments 3' 5 mm. x 23 /A. Very sharply pointed at the inner end. (!>} Small hastate oxea, from the dermis. Slightly irregularly bent, some spined, some smooth, 65 /a to 120 yu, long, 3 p. to 6 p thick. The Triradiates are of one sort : — (c) Large, alate triradiates from the dermal cortex. Basal rays straight, tapering uniformly to a sharp point, 420 p- to 500 /* long X 12 /A to 15 /A thick. Paired rays usually equal, straight or bent slightly downwards, CALCAREA. bluntly pointed, 220 p. to 260 p. long, x 12 p. to 14 p. thick. Oral angle ]30° to 100°. (d) Chiactines. Basal rays straight, tapering to a more or less sharp point, 450 p. to 550 p. long x 12 p. to 16 p. thick. Paired rays equal, straight, 240 p. to 270 p. long x 12 p. to 14 p. thick. Ural angle, 155° to 160°. Apical ray sharply pointed, maximum length 1GO p. long x 14 p. to 16 p. thick. Angle between apical ray and basal ray, 165° to 180°. Oscular spicules. (c) (li.i